1 /* MIPS-specific support for ELF
2    Copyright 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
3    2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 
5    Most of the information added by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support,
6    <ian@cygnus.com>.
7    N32/64 ABI support added by Mark Mitchell, CodeSourcery, LLC.
8    <mark@codesourcery.com>
9    Traditional MIPS targets support added by Koundinya.K, Dansk Data
10    Elektronik & Operations Research Group. <kk@ddeorg.soft.net>
11 
12    This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
13 
14    This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
15    it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
16    the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
17    (at your option) any later version.
18 
19    This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
20    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
21    MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
22    GNU General Public License for more details.
23 
24    You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
25    along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
26    Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.  */
27 
28 /* This file handles functionality common to the different MIPS ABI's.  */
29 
30 #include "sysdep.h"
31 #include "bfd.h"
32 #include "libbfd.h"
33 #include "libiberty.h"
34 #include "elf-bfd.h"
35 #include "elfxx-mips.h"
36 #include "elf/mips.h"
37 #include "elf-vxworks.h"
38 
39 /* Get the ECOFF swapping routines.  */
40 #include "coff/sym.h"
41 #include "coff/symconst.h"
42 #include "coff/ecoff.h"
43 #include "coff/mips.h"
44 
45 #include "hashtab.h"
46 
47 /* This structure is used to hold information about one GOT entry.
48    There are three types of entry:
49 
50       (1) absolute addresses
51 	    (abfd == NULL)
52       (2) SYMBOL + OFFSET addresses, where SYMBOL is local to an input bfd
53 	    (abfd != NULL, symndx >= 0)
54       (3) global and forced-local symbols
55 	    (abfd != NULL, symndx == -1)
56 
57    Type (3) entries are treated differently for different types of GOT.
58    In the "master" GOT -- i.e.  the one that describes every GOT
59    reference needed in the link -- the mips_got_entry is keyed on both
60    the symbol and the input bfd that references it.  If it turns out
61    that we need multiple GOTs, we can then use this information to
62    create separate GOTs for each input bfd.
63 
64    However, we want each of these separate GOTs to have at most one
65    entry for a given symbol, so their type (3) entries are keyed only
66    on the symbol.  The input bfd given by the "abfd" field is somewhat
67    arbitrary in this case.
68 
69    This means that when there are multiple GOTs, each GOT has a unique
70    mips_got_entry for every symbol within it.  We can therefore use the
71    mips_got_entry fields (tls_type and gotidx) to track the symbol's
72    GOT index.
73 
74    However, if it turns out that we need only a single GOT, we continue
75    to use the master GOT to describe it.  There may therefore be several
76    mips_got_entries for the same symbol, each with a different input bfd.
77    We want to make sure that each symbol gets a unique GOT entry, so when
78    there's a single GOT, we use the symbol's hash entry, not the
79    mips_got_entry fields, to track a symbol's GOT index.  */
80 struct mips_got_entry
81 {
82   /* The input bfd in which the symbol is defined.  */
83   bfd *abfd;
84   /* The index of the symbol, as stored in the relocation r_info, if
85      we have a local symbol; -1 otherwise.  */
86   long symndx;
87   union
88   {
89     /* If abfd == NULL, an address that must be stored in the got.  */
90     bfd_vma address;
91     /* If abfd != NULL && symndx != -1, the addend of the relocation
92        that should be added to the symbol value.  */
93     bfd_vma addend;
94     /* If abfd != NULL && symndx == -1, the hash table entry
95        corresponding to a global symbol in the got (or, local, if
96        h->forced_local).  */
97     struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
98   } d;
99 
100   /* The TLS types included in this GOT entry (specifically, GD and
101      IE).  The GD and IE flags can be added as we encounter new
102      relocations.  LDM can also be set; it will always be alone, not
103      combined with any GD or IE flags.  An LDM GOT entry will be
104      a local symbol entry with r_symndx == 0.  */
105   unsigned char tls_type;
106 
107   /* The offset from the beginning of the .got section to the entry
108      corresponding to this symbol+addend.  If it's a global symbol
109      whose offset is yet to be decided, it's going to be -1.  */
110   long gotidx;
111 };
112 
113 /* This structure is used to hold .got information when linking.  */
114 
115 struct mips_got_info
116 {
117   /* The global symbol in the GOT with the lowest index in the dynamic
118      symbol table.  */
119   struct elf_link_hash_entry *global_gotsym;
120   /* The number of global .got entries.  */
121   unsigned int global_gotno;
122   /* The number of .got slots used for TLS.  */
123   unsigned int tls_gotno;
124   /* The first unused TLS .got entry.  Used only during
125      mips_elf_initialize_tls_index.  */
126   unsigned int tls_assigned_gotno;
127   /* The number of local .got entries.  */
128   unsigned int local_gotno;
129   /* The number of local .got entries we have used.  */
130   unsigned int assigned_gotno;
131   /* A hash table holding members of the got.  */
132   struct htab *got_entries;
133   /* A hash table mapping input bfds to other mips_got_info.  NULL
134      unless multi-got was necessary.  */
135   struct htab *bfd2got;
136   /* In multi-got links, a pointer to the next got (err, rather, most
137      of the time, it points to the previous got).  */
138   struct mips_got_info *next;
139   /* This is the GOT index of the TLS LDM entry for the GOT, MINUS_ONE
140      for none, or MINUS_TWO for not yet assigned.  This is needed
141      because a single-GOT link may have multiple hash table entries
142      for the LDM.  It does not get initialized in multi-GOT mode.  */
143   bfd_vma tls_ldm_offset;
144 };
145 
146 /* Map an input bfd to a got in a multi-got link.  */
147 
148 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash {
149   bfd *bfd;
150   struct mips_got_info *g;
151 };
152 
153 /* Structure passed when traversing the bfd2got hash table, used to
154    create and merge bfd's gots.  */
155 
156 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg
157 {
158   /* A hashtable that maps bfds to gots.  */
159   htab_t bfd2got;
160   /* The output bfd.  */
161   bfd *obfd;
162   /* The link information.  */
163   struct bfd_link_info *info;
164   /* A pointer to the primary got, i.e., the one that's going to get
165      the implicit relocations from DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO and
166      DT_MIPS_GOTSYM.  */
167   struct mips_got_info *primary;
168   /* A non-primary got we're trying to merge with other input bfd's
169      gots.  */
170   struct mips_got_info *current;
171   /* The maximum number of got entries that can be addressed with a
172      16-bit offset.  */
173   unsigned int max_count;
174   /* The number of local and global entries in the primary got.  */
175   unsigned int primary_count;
176   /* The number of local and global entries in the current got.  */
177   unsigned int current_count;
178   /* The total number of global entries which will live in the
179      primary got and be automatically relocated.  This includes
180      those not referenced by the primary GOT but included in
181      the "master" GOT.  */
182   unsigned int global_count;
183 };
184 
185 /* Another structure used to pass arguments for got entries traversal.  */
186 
187 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg
188 {
189   struct mips_got_info *g;
190   int value;
191   unsigned int needed_relocs;
192   struct bfd_link_info *info;
193 };
194 
195 /* A structure used to count TLS relocations or GOT entries, for GOT
196    entry or ELF symbol table traversal.  */
197 
198 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg
199 {
200   struct bfd_link_info *info;
201   unsigned int needed;
202 };
203 
204 struct _mips_elf_section_data
205 {
206   struct bfd_elf_section_data elf;
207   union
208   {
209     struct mips_got_info *got_info;
210     bfd_byte *tdata;
211   } u;
212 };
213 
214 #define mips_elf_section_data(sec) \
215   ((struct _mips_elf_section_data *) elf_section_data (sec))
216 
217 /* This structure is passed to mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f when sorting
218    the dynamic symbols.  */
219 
220 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data
221 {
222   /* The symbol in the global GOT with the lowest dynamic symbol table
223      index.  */
224   struct elf_link_hash_entry *low;
225   /* The least dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a non-TLS
226      symbol with a GOT entry.  */
227   long min_got_dynindx;
228   /* The greatest dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a symbol
229      with a GOT entry that is not referenced (e.g., a dynamic symbol
230      with dynamic relocations pointing to it from non-primary GOTs).  */
231   long max_unref_got_dynindx;
232   /* The greatest dynamic symbol table index not corresponding to a
233      symbol without a GOT entry.  */
234   long max_non_got_dynindx;
235 };
236 
237 /* The MIPS ELF linker needs additional information for each symbol in
238    the global hash table.  */
239 
240 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry
241 {
242   struct elf_link_hash_entry root;
243 
244   /* External symbol information.  */
245   EXTR esym;
246 
247   /* Number of R_MIPS_32, R_MIPS_REL32, or R_MIPS_64 relocs against
248      this symbol.  */
249   unsigned int possibly_dynamic_relocs;
250 
251   /* If the R_MIPS_32, R_MIPS_REL32, or R_MIPS_64 reloc is against
252      a readonly section.  */
253   bfd_boolean readonly_reloc;
254 
255   /* We must not create a stub for a symbol that has relocations
256      related to taking the function's address, i.e. any but
257      R_MIPS_CALL*16 ones -- see "MIPS ABI Supplement, 3rd Edition",
258      p. 4-20.  */
259   bfd_boolean no_fn_stub;
260 
261   /* If there is a stub that 32 bit functions should use to call this
262      16 bit function, this points to the section containing the stub.  */
263   asection *fn_stub;
264 
265   /* Whether we need the fn_stub; this is set if this symbol appears
266      in any relocs other than a 16 bit call.  */
267   bfd_boolean need_fn_stub;
268 
269   /* If there is a stub that 16 bit functions should use to call this
270      32 bit function, this points to the section containing the stub.  */
271   asection *call_stub;
272 
273   /* This is like the call_stub field, but it is used if the function
274      being called returns a floating point value.  */
275   asection *call_fp_stub;
276 
277   /* Are we forced local?  This will only be set if we have converted
278      the initial global GOT entry to a local GOT entry.  */
279   bfd_boolean forced_local;
280 
281   /* Are we referenced by some kind of relocation?  */
282   bfd_boolean is_relocation_target;
283 
284   /* Are we referenced by branch relocations?  */
285   bfd_boolean is_branch_target;
286 
287 #define GOT_NORMAL	0
288 #define GOT_TLS_GD	1
289 #define GOT_TLS_LDM	2
290 #define GOT_TLS_IE	4
291 #define GOT_TLS_OFFSET_DONE    0x40
292 #define GOT_TLS_DONE    0x80
293   unsigned char tls_type;
294   /* This is only used in single-GOT mode; in multi-GOT mode there
295      is one mips_got_entry per GOT entry, so the offset is stored
296      there.  In single-GOT mode there may be many mips_got_entry
297      structures all referring to the same GOT slot.  It might be
298      possible to use root.got.offset instead, but that field is
299      overloaded already.  */
300   bfd_vma tls_got_offset;
301 };
302 
303 /* MIPS ELF linker hash table.  */
304 
305 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table
306 {
307   struct elf_link_hash_table root;
308 #if 0
309   /* We no longer use this.  */
310   /* String section indices for the dynamic section symbols.  */
311   bfd_size_type dynsym_sec_strindex[SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES];
312 #endif
313   /* The number of .rtproc entries.  */
314   bfd_size_type procedure_count;
315   /* The size of the .compact_rel section (if SGI_COMPAT).  */
316   bfd_size_type compact_rel_size;
317   /* This flag indicates that the value of DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP dynamic
318      entry is set to the address of __rld_obj_head as in IRIX5.  */
319   bfd_boolean use_rld_obj_head;
320   /* This is the value of the __rld_map or __rld_obj_head symbol.  */
321   bfd_vma rld_value;
322   /* This is set if we see any mips16 stub sections.  */
323   bfd_boolean mips16_stubs_seen;
324   /* True if we're generating code for VxWorks.  */
325   bfd_boolean is_vxworks;
326   /* Shortcuts to some dynamic sections, or NULL if they are not
327      being used.  */
328   asection *srelbss;
329   asection *sdynbss;
330   asection *srelplt;
331   asection *srelplt2;
332   asection *sgotplt;
333   asection *splt;
334   /* The size of the PLT header in bytes (VxWorks only).  */
335   bfd_vma plt_header_size;
336   /* The size of a PLT entry in bytes (VxWorks only).  */
337   bfd_vma plt_entry_size;
338   /* The size of a function stub entry in bytes.  */
339   bfd_vma function_stub_size;
340 };
341 
342 #define TLS_RELOC_P(r_type) \
343   (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32		\
344    || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64		\
345    || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32		\
346    || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64		\
347    || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD			\
348    || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM			\
349    || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16		\
350    || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16		\
351    || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL		\
352    || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32		\
353    || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64		\
354    || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16		\
355    || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16)
356 
357 /* Structure used to pass information to mips_elf_output_extsym.  */
358 
359 struct extsym_info
360 {
361   bfd *abfd;
362   struct bfd_link_info *info;
363   struct ecoff_debug_info *debug;
364   const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
365   bfd_boolean failed;
366 };
367 
368 /* The names of the runtime procedure table symbols used on IRIX5.  */
369 
370 static const char * const mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[] =
371 {
372   "_procedure_table",
373   "_procedure_string_table",
374   "_procedure_table_size",
375   NULL
376 };
377 
378 /* These structures are used to generate the .compact_rel section on
379    IRIX5.  */
380 
381 typedef struct
382 {
383   unsigned long id1;		/* Always one?  */
384   unsigned long num;		/* Number of compact relocation entries.  */
385   unsigned long id2;		/* Always two?  */
386   unsigned long offset;		/* The file offset of the first relocation.  */
387   unsigned long reserved0;	/* Zero?  */
388   unsigned long reserved1;	/* Zero?  */
389 } Elf32_compact_rel;
390 
391 typedef struct
392 {
393   bfd_byte id1[4];
394   bfd_byte num[4];
395   bfd_byte id2[4];
396   bfd_byte offset[4];
397   bfd_byte reserved0[4];
398   bfd_byte reserved1[4];
399 } Elf32_External_compact_rel;
400 
401 typedef struct
402 {
403   unsigned int ctype : 1;	/* 1: long 0: short format. See below.  */
404   unsigned int rtype : 4;	/* Relocation types. See below.  */
405   unsigned int dist2to : 8;
406   unsigned int relvaddr : 19;	/* (VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry)/ 4 */
407   unsigned long konst;		/* KONST field. See below.  */
408   unsigned long vaddr;		/* VADDR to be relocated.  */
409 } Elf32_crinfo;
410 
411 typedef struct
412 {
413   unsigned int ctype : 1;	/* 1: long 0: short format. See below.  */
414   unsigned int rtype : 4;	/* Relocation types. See below.  */
415   unsigned int dist2to : 8;
416   unsigned int relvaddr : 19;	/* (VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry)/ 4 */
417   unsigned long konst;		/* KONST field. See below.  */
418 } Elf32_crinfo2;
419 
420 typedef struct
421 {
422   bfd_byte info[4];
423   bfd_byte konst[4];
424   bfd_byte vaddr[4];
425 } Elf32_External_crinfo;
426 
427 typedef struct
428 {
429   bfd_byte info[4];
430   bfd_byte konst[4];
431 } Elf32_External_crinfo2;
432 
433 /* These are the constants used to swap the bitfields in a crinfo.  */
434 
435 #define CRINFO_CTYPE (0x1)
436 #define CRINFO_CTYPE_SH (31)
437 #define CRINFO_RTYPE (0xf)
438 #define CRINFO_RTYPE_SH (27)
439 #define CRINFO_DIST2TO (0xff)
440 #define CRINFO_DIST2TO_SH (19)
441 #define CRINFO_RELVADDR (0x7ffff)
442 #define CRINFO_RELVADDR_SH (0)
443 
444 /* A compact relocation info has long (3 words) or short (2 words)
445    formats.  A short format doesn't have VADDR field and relvaddr
446    fields contains ((VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry) >> 2).  */
447 #define CRF_MIPS_LONG			1
448 #define CRF_MIPS_SHORT			0
449 
450 /* There are 4 types of compact relocation at least. The value KONST
451    has different meaning for each type:
452 
453    (type)		(konst)
454    CT_MIPS_REL32	Address in data
455    CT_MIPS_WORD		Address in word (XXX)
456    CT_MIPS_GPHI_LO	GP - vaddr
457    CT_MIPS_JMPAD	Address to jump
458    */
459 
460 #define CRT_MIPS_REL32			0xa
461 #define CRT_MIPS_WORD			0xb
462 #define CRT_MIPS_GPHI_LO		0xc
463 #define CRT_MIPS_JMPAD			0xd
464 
465 #define mips_elf_set_cr_format(x,format)	((x).ctype = (format))
466 #define mips_elf_set_cr_type(x,type)		((x).rtype = (type))
467 #define mips_elf_set_cr_dist2to(x,v)		((x).dist2to = (v))
468 #define mips_elf_set_cr_relvaddr(x,d)		((x).relvaddr = (d)<<2)
469 
470 /* The structure of the runtime procedure descriptor created by the
471    loader for use by the static exception system.  */
472 
473 typedef struct runtime_pdr {
474 	bfd_vma	adr;		/* Memory address of start of procedure.  */
475 	long	regmask;	/* Save register mask.  */
476 	long	regoffset;	/* Save register offset.  */
477 	long	fregmask;	/* Save floating point register mask.  */
478 	long	fregoffset;	/* Save floating point register offset.  */
479 	long	frameoffset;	/* Frame size.  */
480 	short	framereg;	/* Frame pointer register.  */
481 	short	pcreg;		/* Offset or reg of return pc.  */
482 	long	irpss;		/* Index into the runtime string table.  */
483 	long	reserved;
484 	struct exception_info *exception_info;/* Pointer to exception array.  */
485 } RPDR, *pRPDR;
486 #define cbRPDR sizeof (RPDR)
487 #define rpdNil ((pRPDR) 0)
488 
489 static struct mips_got_entry *mips_elf_create_local_got_entry
490   (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, bfd *, struct mips_got_info *, asection *,
491    bfd_vma, unsigned long, struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, int);
492 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f
493   (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, void *);
494 static bfd_vma mips_elf_high
495   (bfd_vma);
496 static bfd_boolean mips16_stub_section_p
497   (bfd *, asection *);
498 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
499   (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, const Elf_Internal_Rela *,
500    struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, asection *, bfd_vma,
501    bfd_vma *, asection *);
502 static hashval_t mips_elf_got_entry_hash
503   (const void *);
504 static bfd_vma mips_elf_adjust_gp
505   (bfd *, struct mips_got_info *, bfd *);
506 static struct mips_got_info *mips_elf_got_for_ibfd
507   (struct mips_got_info *, bfd *);
508 
509 /* This will be used when we sort the dynamic relocation records.  */
510 static bfd *reldyn_sorting_bfd;
511 
512 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using the N32 ABI.  */
513 #define ABI_N32_P(abfd) \
514   ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI2) != 0)
515 
516 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using the N64 ABI.  */
517 #define ABI_64_P(abfd) \
518   (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64)
519 
520 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using NewABI conventions.  */
521 #define NEWABI_P(abfd) (ABI_N32_P (abfd) || ABI_64_P (abfd))
522 
523 /* The IRIX compatibility level we are striving for.  */
524 #define IRIX_COMPAT(abfd) \
525   (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_mips_irix_compat (abfd))
526 
527 /* Whether we are trying to be compatible with IRIX at all.  */
528 #define SGI_COMPAT(abfd) \
529   (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) != ict_none)
530 
531 /* The name of the options section.  */
532 #define MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME(abfd) \
533   (NEWABI_P (abfd) ? ".MIPS.options" : ".options")
534 
535 /* True if NAME is the recognized name of any SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS section.
536    Some IRIX system files do not use MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME.  */
537 #define MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P(NAME) \
538   (strcmp (NAME, ".MIPS.options") == 0 || strcmp (NAME, ".options") == 0)
539 
540 /* Whether the section is readonly.  */
541 #define MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION(sec) \
542   ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY))		\
543    == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY))
544 
545 /* The name of the stub section.  */
546 #define MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME(abfd) ".MIPS.stubs"
547 
548 /* The size of an external REL relocation.  */
549 #define MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE(abfd) \
550   (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_rel)
551 
552 /* The size of an external RELA relocation.  */
553 #define MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE(abfd) \
554   (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_rela)
555 
556 /* The size of an external dynamic table entry.  */
557 #define MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE(abfd) \
558   (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn)
559 
560 /* The size of a GOT entry.  */
561 #define MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE(abfd) \
562   (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->arch_size / 8)
563 
564 /* The size of a symbol-table entry.  */
565 #define MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE(abfd) \
566   (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym)
567 
568 /* The default alignment for sections, as a power of two.  */
569 #define MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN(abfd)				\
570   (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->log_file_align)
571 
572 /* Get word-sized data.  */
573 #define MIPS_ELF_GET_WORD(abfd, ptr) \
574   (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? bfd_get_64 (abfd, ptr) : bfd_get_32 (abfd, ptr))
575 
576 /* Put out word-sized data.  */
577 #define MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD(abfd, val, ptr)	\
578   (ABI_64_P (abfd) 				\
579    ? bfd_put_64 (abfd, val, ptr) 		\
580    : bfd_put_32 (abfd, val, ptr))
581 
582 /* Add a dynamic symbol table-entry.  */
583 #define MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY(info, tag, val)	\
584   _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, tag, val)
585 
586 #define MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO(abfd, rtype, rela)			\
587   (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_mips_rtype_to_howto (rtype, rela))
588 
589 /* Determine whether the internal relocation of index REL_IDX is REL
590    (zero) or RELA (non-zero).  The assumption is that, if there are
591    two relocation sections for this section, one of them is REL and
592    the other is RELA.  If the index of the relocation we're testing is
593    in range for the first relocation section, check that the external
594    relocation size is that for RELA.  It is also assumed that, if
595    rel_idx is not in range for the first section, and this first
596    section contains REL relocs, then the relocation is in the second
597    section, that is RELA.  */
598 #define MIPS_RELOC_RELA_P(abfd, sec, rel_idx)				\
599   ((NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (&elf_section_data (sec)->rel_hdr)			\
600     * get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel		\
601     > (bfd_vma)(rel_idx))						\
602    == (elf_section_data (sec)->rel_hdr.sh_entsize			\
603        == (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela)		\
604 	   : sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela))))
605 
606 /* The name of the dynamic relocation section.  */
607 #define MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME(INFO) \
608   (mips_elf_hash_table (INFO)->is_vxworks ? ".rela.dyn" : ".rel.dyn")
609 
610 /* In case we're on a 32-bit machine, construct a 64-bit "-1" value
611    from smaller values.  Start with zero, widen, *then* decrement.  */
612 #define MINUS_ONE	(((bfd_vma)0) - 1)
613 #define MINUS_TWO	(((bfd_vma)0) - 2)
614 
615 /* The number of local .got entries we reserve.  */
616 #define MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO(INFO) \
617   (mips_elf_hash_table (INFO)->is_vxworks ? 3 : 2)
618 
619 /* The offset of $gp from the beginning of the .got section.  */
620 #define ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET(INFO) \
621   (mips_elf_hash_table (INFO)->is_vxworks ? 0x0 : 0x7ff0)
622 
623 /* The maximum size of the GOT for it to be addressable using 16-bit
624    offsets from $gp.  */
625 #define MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE(INFO) (ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET (INFO) + 0x7fff)
626 
627 /* Instructions which appear in a stub.  */
628 #define STUB_LW(abfd)							\
629   ((ABI_64_P (abfd)							\
630     ? 0xdf998010				/* ld t9,0x8010(gp) */	\
631     : 0x8f998010))              		/* lw t9,0x8010(gp) */
632 #define STUB_MOVE(abfd)							\
633    ((ABI_64_P (abfd)							\
634      ? 0x03e0782d				/* daddu t7,ra */	\
635      : 0x03e07821))				/* addu t7,ra */
636 #define STUB_LUI(VAL) (0x3c180000 + (VAL))	/* lui t8,VAL */
637 #define STUB_JALR 0x0320f809			/* jalr t9,ra */
638 #define STUB_ORI(VAL) (0x37180000 + (VAL))	/* ori t8,t8,VAL */
639 #define STUB_LI16U(VAL) (0x34180000 + (VAL))	/* ori t8,zero,VAL unsigned */
640 #define STUB_LI16S(abfd, VAL)						\
641    ((ABI_64_P (abfd)							\
642     ? (0x64180000 + (VAL))	/* daddiu t8,zero,VAL sign extended */	\
643     : (0x24180000 + (VAL))))	/* addiu t8,zero,VAL sign extended */
644 
645 #define MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_NORMAL_SIZE 16
646 #define MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE 20
647 
648 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter.  This is put in the .interp
649    section.  */
650 
651 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER(abfd) 		\
652    (ABI_N32_P (abfd) ? "/usr/lib32/libc.so.1" 	\
653     : ABI_64_P (abfd) ? "/usr/lib64/libc.so.1" 	\
654     : "/usr/lib/libc.so.1")
655 
656 #ifdef BFD64
657 #define MNAME(bfd,pre,pos) \
658   (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? CONCAT4 (pre,64,_,pos) : CONCAT4 (pre,32,_,pos))
659 #define ELF_R_SYM(bfd, i)					\
660   (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_R_SYM (i) : ELF32_R_SYM (i))
661 #define ELF_R_TYPE(bfd, i)					\
662   (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_MIPS_R_TYPE (i) : ELF32_R_TYPE (i))
663 #define ELF_R_INFO(bfd, s, t)					\
664   (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_R_INFO (s, t) : ELF32_R_INFO (s, t))
665 #else
666 #define MNAME(bfd,pre,pos) CONCAT4 (pre,32,_,pos)
667 #define ELF_R_SYM(bfd, i)					\
668   (ELF32_R_SYM (i))
669 #define ELF_R_TYPE(bfd, i)					\
670   (ELF32_R_TYPE (i))
671 #define ELF_R_INFO(bfd, s, t)					\
672   (ELF32_R_INFO (s, t))
673 #endif
674 
675   /* The mips16 compiler uses a couple of special sections to handle
676      floating point arguments.
677 
678      Section names that look like .mips16.fn.FNNAME contain stubs that
679      copy floating point arguments from the fp regs to the gp regs and
680      then jump to FNNAME.  If any 32 bit function calls FNNAME, the
681      call should be redirected to the stub instead.  If no 32 bit
682      function calls FNNAME, the stub should be discarded.  We need to
683      consider any reference to the function, not just a call, because
684      if the address of the function is taken we will need the stub,
685      since the address might be passed to a 32 bit function.
686 
687      Section names that look like .mips16.call.FNNAME contain stubs
688      that copy floating point arguments from the gp regs to the fp
689      regs and then jump to FNNAME.  If FNNAME is a 32 bit function,
690      then any 16 bit function that calls FNNAME should be redirected
691      to the stub instead.  If FNNAME is not a 32 bit function, the
692      stub should be discarded.
693 
694      .mips16.call.fp.FNNAME sections are similar, but contain stubs
695      which call FNNAME and then copy the return value from the fp regs
696      to the gp regs.  These stubs store the return value in $18 while
697      calling FNNAME; any function which might call one of these stubs
698      must arrange to save $18 around the call.  (This case is not
699      needed for 32 bit functions that call 16 bit functions, because
700      16 bit functions always return floating point values in both
701      $f0/$f1 and $2/$3.)
702 
703      Note that in all cases FNNAME might be defined statically.
704      Therefore, FNNAME is not used literally.  Instead, the relocation
705      information will indicate which symbol the section is for.
706 
707      We record any stubs that we find in the symbol table.  */
708 
709 #define FN_STUB ".mips16.fn."
710 #define CALL_STUB ".mips16.call."
711 #define CALL_FP_STUB ".mips16.call.fp."
712 
713 #define FN_STUB_P(name) CONST_STRNEQ (name, FN_STUB)
714 #define CALL_STUB_P(name) CONST_STRNEQ (name, CALL_STUB)
715 #define CALL_FP_STUB_P(name) CONST_STRNEQ (name, CALL_FP_STUB)
716 
717 /* The format of the first PLT entry in a VxWorks executable.  */
718 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry[] = {
719   0x3c190000,	/* lui t9, %hi(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_)		*/
720   0x27390000,	/* addiu t9, t9, %lo(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_)	*/
721   0x8f390008,	/* lw t9, 8(t9)					*/
722   0x00000000,	/* nop						*/
723   0x03200008,	/* jr t9					*/
724   0x00000000	/* nop						*/
725 };
726 
727 /* The format of subsequent PLT entries.  */
728 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_exec_plt_entry[] = {
729   0x10000000,	/* b .PLT_resolver			*/
730   0x24180000,	/* li t8, <pltindex>			*/
731   0x3c190000,	/* lui t9, %hi(<.got.plt slot>)		*/
732   0x27390000,	/* addiu t9, t9, %lo(<.got.plt slot>)	*/
733   0x8f390000,	/* lw t9, 0(t9)				*/
734   0x00000000,	/* nop					*/
735   0x03200008,	/* jr t9				*/
736   0x00000000	/* nop					*/
737 };
738 
739 /* The format of the first PLT entry in a VxWorks shared object.  */
740 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry[] = {
741   0x8f990008,	/* lw t9, 8(gp)		*/
742   0x00000000,	/* nop			*/
743   0x03200008,	/* jr t9		*/
744   0x00000000,	/* nop			*/
745   0x00000000,	/* nop			*/
746   0x00000000	/* nop			*/
747 };
748 
749 /* The format of subsequent PLT entries.  */
750 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_shared_plt_entry[] = {
751   0x10000000,	/* b .PLT_resolver	*/
752   0x24180000	/* li t8, <pltindex>	*/
753 };
754 
755 /* Look up an entry in a MIPS ELF linker hash table.  */
756 
757 #define mips_elf_link_hash_lookup(table, string, create, copy, follow)	\
758   ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)					\
759    elf_link_hash_lookup (&(table)->root, (string), (create),		\
760 			 (copy), (follow)))
761 
762 /* Traverse a MIPS ELF linker hash table.  */
763 
764 #define mips_elf_link_hash_traverse(table, func, info)			\
765   (elf_link_hash_traverse						\
766    (&(table)->root,							\
767     (bfd_boolean (*) (struct elf_link_hash_entry *, void *)) (func),	\
768     (info)))
769 
770 /* Get the MIPS ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure.  */
771 
772 #define mips_elf_hash_table(p) \
773   ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash))
774 
775 /* Find the base offsets for thread-local storage in this object,
776    for GD/LD and IE/LE respectively.  */
777 
778 #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
779 #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
780 
781 static bfd_vma
dtprel_base(struct bfd_link_info * info)782 dtprel_base (struct bfd_link_info *info)
783 {
784   /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already.  */
785   if (elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec == NULL)
786     return 0;
787   return elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
788 }
789 
790 static bfd_vma
tprel_base(struct bfd_link_info * info)791 tprel_base (struct bfd_link_info *info)
792 {
793   /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already.  */
794   if (elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec == NULL)
795     return 0;
796   return elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
797 }
798 
799 /* Create an entry in a MIPS ELF linker hash table.  */
800 
801 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc(struct bfd_hash_entry * entry,struct bfd_hash_table * table,const char * string)802 mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
803 			    struct bfd_hash_table *table, const char *string)
804 {
805   struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *ret =
806     (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) entry;
807 
808   /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
809      subclass.  */
810   if (ret == NULL)
811     ret = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry));
812   if (ret == NULL)
813     return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret;
814 
815   /* Call the allocation method of the superclass.  */
816   ret = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
817 	 _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc ((struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret,
818 				     table, string));
819   if (ret != NULL)
820     {
821       /* Set local fields.  */
822       memset (&ret->esym, 0, sizeof (EXTR));
823       /* We use -2 as a marker to indicate that the information has
824 	 not been set.  -1 means there is no associated ifd.  */
825       ret->esym.ifd = -2;
826       ret->possibly_dynamic_relocs = 0;
827       ret->readonly_reloc = FALSE;
828       ret->no_fn_stub = FALSE;
829       ret->fn_stub = NULL;
830       ret->need_fn_stub = FALSE;
831       ret->call_stub = NULL;
832       ret->call_fp_stub = NULL;
833       ret->forced_local = FALSE;
834       ret->is_branch_target = FALSE;
835       ret->is_relocation_target = FALSE;
836       ret->tls_type = GOT_NORMAL;
837     }
838 
839   return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret;
840 }
841 
842 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_new_section_hook(bfd * abfd,asection * sec)843 _bfd_mips_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
844 {
845   if (!sec->used_by_bfd)
846     {
847       struct _mips_elf_section_data *sdata;
848       bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*sdata);
849 
850       sdata = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
851       if (sdata == NULL)
852 	return FALSE;
853       sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
854     }
855 
856   return _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
857 }
858 
859 /* Read ECOFF debugging information from a .mdebug section into a
860    ecoff_debug_info structure.  */
861 
862 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info(bfd * abfd,asection * section,struct ecoff_debug_info * debug)863 _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (bfd *abfd, asection *section,
864 			       struct ecoff_debug_info *debug)
865 {
866   HDRR *symhdr;
867   const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
868   char *ext_hdr;
869 
870   swap = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
871   memset (debug, 0, sizeof (*debug));
872 
873   ext_hdr = bfd_malloc (swap->external_hdr_size);
874   if (ext_hdr == NULL && swap->external_hdr_size != 0)
875     goto error_return;
876 
877   if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, section, ext_hdr, 0,
878 				  swap->external_hdr_size))
879     goto error_return;
880 
881   symhdr = &debug->symbolic_header;
882   (*swap->swap_hdr_in) (abfd, ext_hdr, symhdr);
883 
884   /* The symbolic header contains absolute file offsets and sizes to
885      read.  */
886 #define READ(ptr, offset, count, size, type)				\
887   if (symhdr->count == 0)						\
888     debug->ptr = NULL;							\
889   else									\
890     {									\
891       bfd_size_type amt = (bfd_size_type) size * symhdr->count;		\
892       debug->ptr = bfd_malloc (amt);					\
893       if (debug->ptr == NULL)						\
894 	goto error_return;						\
895       if (bfd_seek (abfd, symhdr->offset, SEEK_SET) != 0		\
896 	  || bfd_bread (debug->ptr, amt, abfd) != amt)			\
897 	goto error_return;						\
898     }
899 
900   READ (line, cbLineOffset, cbLine, sizeof (unsigned char), unsigned char *);
901   READ (external_dnr, cbDnOffset, idnMax, swap->external_dnr_size, void *);
902   READ (external_pdr, cbPdOffset, ipdMax, swap->external_pdr_size, void *);
903   READ (external_sym, cbSymOffset, isymMax, swap->external_sym_size, void *);
904   READ (external_opt, cbOptOffset, ioptMax, swap->external_opt_size, void *);
905   READ (external_aux, cbAuxOffset, iauxMax, sizeof (union aux_ext),
906 	union aux_ext *);
907   READ (ss, cbSsOffset, issMax, sizeof (char), char *);
908   READ (ssext, cbSsExtOffset, issExtMax, sizeof (char), char *);
909   READ (external_fdr, cbFdOffset, ifdMax, swap->external_fdr_size, void *);
910   READ (external_rfd, cbRfdOffset, crfd, swap->external_rfd_size, void *);
911   READ (external_ext, cbExtOffset, iextMax, swap->external_ext_size, void *);
912 #undef READ
913 
914   debug->fdr = NULL;
915 
916   return TRUE;
917 
918  error_return:
919   if (ext_hdr != NULL)
920     free (ext_hdr);
921   if (debug->line != NULL)
922     free (debug->line);
923   if (debug->external_dnr != NULL)
924     free (debug->external_dnr);
925   if (debug->external_pdr != NULL)
926     free (debug->external_pdr);
927   if (debug->external_sym != NULL)
928     free (debug->external_sym);
929   if (debug->external_opt != NULL)
930     free (debug->external_opt);
931   if (debug->external_aux != NULL)
932     free (debug->external_aux);
933   if (debug->ss != NULL)
934     free (debug->ss);
935   if (debug->ssext != NULL)
936     free (debug->ssext);
937   if (debug->external_fdr != NULL)
938     free (debug->external_fdr);
939   if (debug->external_rfd != NULL)
940     free (debug->external_rfd);
941   if (debug->external_ext != NULL)
942     free (debug->external_ext);
943   return FALSE;
944 }
945 
946 /* Swap RPDR (runtime procedure table entry) for output.  */
947 
948 static void
ecoff_swap_rpdr_out(bfd * abfd,const RPDR * in,struct rpdr_ext * ex)949 ecoff_swap_rpdr_out (bfd *abfd, const RPDR *in, struct rpdr_ext *ex)
950 {
951   H_PUT_S32 (abfd, in->adr, ex->p_adr);
952   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->regmask, ex->p_regmask);
953   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->regoffset, ex->p_regoffset);
954   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->fregmask, ex->p_fregmask);
955   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->fregoffset, ex->p_fregoffset);
956   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->frameoffset, ex->p_frameoffset);
957 
958   H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->framereg, ex->p_framereg);
959   H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->pcreg, ex->p_pcreg);
960 
961   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->irpss, ex->p_irpss);
962 }
963 
964 /* Create a runtime procedure table from the .mdebug section.  */
965 
966 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_create_procedure_table(void * handle,bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,asection * s,struct ecoff_debug_info * debug)967 mips_elf_create_procedure_table (void *handle, bfd *abfd,
968 				 struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *s,
969 				 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug)
970 {
971   const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
972   HDRR *hdr = &debug->symbolic_header;
973   RPDR *rpdr, *rp;
974   struct rpdr_ext *erp;
975   void *rtproc;
976   struct pdr_ext *epdr;
977   struct sym_ext *esym;
978   char *ss, **sv;
979   char *str;
980   bfd_size_type size;
981   bfd_size_type count;
982   unsigned long sindex;
983   unsigned long i;
984   PDR pdr;
985   SYMR sym;
986   const char *no_name_func = _("static procedure (no name)");
987 
988   epdr = NULL;
989   rpdr = NULL;
990   esym = NULL;
991   ss = NULL;
992   sv = NULL;
993 
994   swap = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
995 
996   sindex = strlen (no_name_func) + 1;
997   count = hdr->ipdMax;
998   if (count > 0)
999     {
1000       size = swap->external_pdr_size;
1001 
1002       epdr = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1003       if (epdr == NULL)
1004 	goto error_return;
1005 
1006       if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_pdr (handle, (bfd_byte *) epdr))
1007 	goto error_return;
1008 
1009       size = sizeof (RPDR);
1010       rp = rpdr = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1011       if (rpdr == NULL)
1012 	goto error_return;
1013 
1014       size = sizeof (char *);
1015       sv = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1016       if (sv == NULL)
1017 	goto error_return;
1018 
1019       count = hdr->isymMax;
1020       size = swap->external_sym_size;
1021       esym = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1022       if (esym == NULL)
1023 	goto error_return;
1024 
1025       if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_sym (handle, (bfd_byte *) esym))
1026 	goto error_return;
1027 
1028       count = hdr->issMax;
1029       ss = bfd_malloc (count);
1030       if (ss == NULL)
1031 	goto error_return;
1032       if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_ss (handle, (bfd_byte *) ss))
1033 	goto error_return;
1034 
1035       count = hdr->ipdMax;
1036       for (i = 0; i < (unsigned long) count; i++, rp++)
1037 	{
1038 	  (*swap->swap_pdr_in) (abfd, epdr + i, &pdr);
1039 	  (*swap->swap_sym_in) (abfd, &esym[pdr.isym], &sym);
1040 	  rp->adr = sym.value;
1041 	  rp->regmask = pdr.regmask;
1042 	  rp->regoffset = pdr.regoffset;
1043 	  rp->fregmask = pdr.fregmask;
1044 	  rp->fregoffset = pdr.fregoffset;
1045 	  rp->frameoffset = pdr.frameoffset;
1046 	  rp->framereg = pdr.framereg;
1047 	  rp->pcreg = pdr.pcreg;
1048 	  rp->irpss = sindex;
1049 	  sv[i] = ss + sym.iss;
1050 	  sindex += strlen (sv[i]) + 1;
1051 	}
1052     }
1053 
1054   size = sizeof (struct rpdr_ext) * (count + 2) + sindex;
1055   size = BFD_ALIGN (size, 16);
1056   rtproc = bfd_alloc (abfd, size);
1057   if (rtproc == NULL)
1058     {
1059       mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count = 0;
1060       goto error_return;
1061     }
1062 
1063   mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count = count + 2;
1064 
1065   erp = rtproc;
1066   memset (erp, 0, sizeof (struct rpdr_ext));
1067   erp++;
1068   str = (char *) rtproc + sizeof (struct rpdr_ext) * (count + 2);
1069   strcpy (str, no_name_func);
1070   str += strlen (no_name_func) + 1;
1071   for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
1072     {
1073       ecoff_swap_rpdr_out (abfd, rpdr + i, erp + i);
1074       strcpy (str, sv[i]);
1075       str += strlen (sv[i]) + 1;
1076     }
1077   H_PUT_S32 (abfd, -1, (erp + count)->p_adr);
1078 
1079   /* Set the size and contents of .rtproc section.  */
1080   s->size = size;
1081   s->contents = rtproc;
1082 
1083   /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
1084      matters, but someday it might).  */
1085   s->map_head.link_order = NULL;
1086 
1087   if (epdr != NULL)
1088     free (epdr);
1089   if (rpdr != NULL)
1090     free (rpdr);
1091   if (esym != NULL)
1092     free (esym);
1093   if (ss != NULL)
1094     free (ss);
1095   if (sv != NULL)
1096     free (sv);
1097 
1098   return TRUE;
1099 
1100  error_return:
1101   if (epdr != NULL)
1102     free (epdr);
1103   if (rpdr != NULL)
1104     free (rpdr);
1105   if (esym != NULL)
1106     free (esym);
1107   if (ss != NULL)
1108     free (ss);
1109   if (sv != NULL)
1110     free (sv);
1111   return FALSE;
1112 }
1113 
1114 /* Check the mips16 stubs for a particular symbol, and see if we can
1115    discard them.  */
1116 
1117 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs(struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)1118 mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
1119 			     void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1120 {
1121   if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
1122     h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
1123 
1124   if (h->fn_stub != NULL
1125       && ! h->need_fn_stub)
1126     {
1127       /* We don't need the fn_stub; the only references to this symbol
1128          are 16 bit calls.  Clobber the size to 0 to prevent it from
1129          being included in the link.  */
1130       h->fn_stub->size = 0;
1131       h->fn_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1132       h->fn_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1133       h->fn_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1134     }
1135 
1136   if (h->call_stub != NULL
1137       && h->root.other == STO_MIPS16)
1138     {
1139       /* We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit function, so
1140          calls from other 16 bit functions are OK.  Clobber the size
1141          to 0 to prevent it from being included in the link.  */
1142       h->call_stub->size = 0;
1143       h->call_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1144       h->call_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1145       h->call_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1146     }
1147 
1148   if (h->call_fp_stub != NULL
1149       && h->root.other == STO_MIPS16)
1150     {
1151       /* We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit function, so
1152          calls from other 16 bit functions are OK.  Clobber the size
1153          to 0 to prevent it from being included in the link.  */
1154       h->call_fp_stub->size = 0;
1155       h->call_fp_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1156       h->call_fp_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1157       h->call_fp_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1158     }
1159 
1160   return TRUE;
1161 }
1162 
1163 /* R_MIPS16_26 is used for the mips16 jal and jalx instructions.
1164    Most mips16 instructions are 16 bits, but these instructions
1165    are 32 bits.
1166 
1167    The format of these instructions is:
1168 
1169    +--------------+--------------------------------+
1170    |     JALX     | X|   Imm 20:16  |   Imm 25:21  |
1171    +--------------+--------------------------------+
1172    |                Immediate  15:0                |
1173    +-----------------------------------------------+
1174 
1175    JALX is the 5-bit value 00011.  X is 0 for jal, 1 for jalx.
1176    Note that the immediate value in the first word is swapped.
1177 
1178    When producing a relocatable object file, R_MIPS16_26 is
1179    handled mostly like R_MIPS_26.  In particular, the addend is
1180    stored as a straight 26-bit value in a 32-bit instruction.
1181    (gas makes life simpler for itself by never adjusting a
1182    R_MIPS16_26 reloc to be against a section, so the addend is
1183    always zero).  However, the 32 bit instruction is stored as 2
1184    16-bit values, rather than a single 32-bit value.  In a
1185    big-endian file, the result is the same; in a little-endian
1186    file, the two 16-bit halves of the 32 bit value are swapped.
1187    This is so that a disassembler can recognize the jal
1188    instruction.
1189 
1190    When doing a final link, R_MIPS16_26 is treated as a 32 bit
1191    instruction stored as two 16-bit values.  The addend A is the
1192    contents of the targ26 field.  The calculation is the same as
1193    R_MIPS_26.  When storing the calculated value, reorder the
1194    immediate value as shown above, and don't forget to store the
1195    value as two 16-bit values.
1196 
1197    To put it in MIPS ABI terms, the relocation field is T-targ26-16,
1198    defined as
1199 
1200    big-endian:
1201    +--------+----------------------+
1202    |        |                      |
1203    |        |    targ26-16         |
1204    |31    26|25                   0|
1205    +--------+----------------------+
1206 
1207    little-endian:
1208    +----------+------+-------------+
1209    |          |      |             |
1210    |  sub1    |      |     sub2    |
1211    |0        9|10  15|16         31|
1212    +----------+--------------------+
1213    where targ26-16 is sub1 followed by sub2 (i.e., the addend field A is
1214    ((sub1 << 16) | sub2)).
1215 
1216    When producing a relocatable object file, the calculation is
1217    (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2)
1218    When producing a fully linked file, the calculation is
1219    let R = (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2)
1220    ((R & 0x1f0000) << 5) | ((R & 0x3e00000) >> 5) | (R & 0xffff)
1221 
1222    R_MIPS16_GPREL is used for GP-relative addressing in mips16
1223    mode.  A typical instruction will have a format like this:
1224 
1225    +--------------+--------------------------------+
1226    |    EXTEND    |     Imm 10:5    |   Imm 15:11  |
1227    +--------------+--------------------------------+
1228    |    Major     |   rx   |   ry   |   Imm  4:0   |
1229    +--------------+--------------------------------+
1230 
1231    EXTEND is the five bit value 11110.  Major is the instruction
1232    opcode.
1233 
1234    This is handled exactly like R_MIPS_GPREL16, except that the
1235    addend is retrieved and stored as shown in this diagram; that
1236    is, the Imm fields above replace the V-rel16 field.
1237 
1238    All we need to do here is shuffle the bits appropriately.  As
1239    above, the two 16-bit halves must be swapped on a
1240    little-endian system.
1241 
1242    R_MIPS16_HI16 and R_MIPS16_LO16 are used in mips16 mode to
1243    access data when neither GP-relative nor PC-relative addressing
1244    can be used.  They are handled like R_MIPS_HI16 and R_MIPS_LO16,
1245    except that the addend is retrieved and stored as shown above
1246    for R_MIPS16_GPREL.
1247   */
1248 void
_bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle(bfd * abfd,int r_type,bfd_boolean jal_shuffle,bfd_byte * data)1249 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (bfd *abfd, int r_type,
1250 				 bfd_boolean jal_shuffle, bfd_byte *data)
1251 {
1252   bfd_vma extend, insn, val;
1253 
1254   if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26 && r_type != R_MIPS16_GPREL
1255       && r_type != R_MIPS16_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS16_LO16)
1256     return;
1257 
1258   /* Pick up the mips16 extend instruction and the real instruction.  */
1259   extend = bfd_get_16 (abfd, data);
1260   insn = bfd_get_16 (abfd, data + 2);
1261   if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
1262     {
1263       if (jal_shuffle)
1264 	val = ((extend & 0xfc00) << 16) | ((extend & 0x3e0) << 11)
1265 	      | ((extend & 0x1f) << 21) | insn;
1266       else
1267 	val = extend << 16 | insn;
1268     }
1269   else
1270     val = ((extend & 0xf800) << 16) | ((insn & 0xffe0) << 11)
1271 	  | ((extend & 0x1f) << 11) | (extend & 0x7e0) | (insn & 0x1f);
1272   bfd_put_32 (abfd, val, data);
1273 }
1274 
1275 void
_bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle(bfd * abfd,int r_type,bfd_boolean jal_shuffle,bfd_byte * data)1276 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (bfd *abfd, int r_type,
1277 			       bfd_boolean jal_shuffle, bfd_byte *data)
1278 {
1279   bfd_vma extend, insn, val;
1280 
1281   if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26 && r_type != R_MIPS16_GPREL
1282       && r_type != R_MIPS16_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS16_LO16)
1283     return;
1284 
1285   val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, data);
1286   if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
1287     {
1288       if (jal_shuffle)
1289 	{
1290 	  insn = val & 0xffff;
1291 	  extend = ((val >> 16) & 0xfc00) | ((val >> 11) & 0x3e0)
1292 		   | ((val >> 21) & 0x1f);
1293 	}
1294       else
1295 	{
1296 	  insn = val & 0xffff;
1297 	  extend = val >> 16;
1298 	}
1299     }
1300   else
1301     {
1302       insn = ((val >> 11) & 0xffe0) | (val & 0x1f);
1303       extend = ((val >> 16) & 0xf800) | ((val >> 11) & 0x1f) | (val & 0x7e0);
1304     }
1305   bfd_put_16 (abfd, insn, data + 2);
1306   bfd_put_16 (abfd, extend, data);
1307 }
1308 
1309 bfd_reloc_status_type
_bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp(bfd * abfd,asymbol * symbol,arelent * reloc_entry,asection * input_section,bfd_boolean relocatable,void * data,bfd_vma gp)1310 _bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
1311 			       arelent *reloc_entry, asection *input_section,
1312 			       bfd_boolean relocatable, void *data, bfd_vma gp)
1313 {
1314   bfd_vma relocation;
1315   bfd_signed_vma val;
1316   bfd_reloc_status_type status;
1317 
1318   if (bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1319     relocation = 0;
1320   else
1321     relocation = symbol->value;
1322 
1323   relocation += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1324   relocation += symbol->section->output_offset;
1325 
1326   if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1327     return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1328 
1329   /* Set val to the offset into the section or symbol.  */
1330   val = reloc_entry->addend;
1331 
1332   _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (val, 16);
1333 
1334   /* Adjust val for the final section location and GP value.  If we
1335      are producing relocatable output, we don't want to do this for
1336      an external symbol.  */
1337   if (! relocatable
1338       || (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0)
1339     val += relocation - gp;
1340 
1341   if (reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace)
1342     {
1343       status = _bfd_relocate_contents (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, val,
1344 				       (bfd_byte *) data
1345 				       + reloc_entry->address);
1346       if (status != bfd_reloc_ok)
1347 	return status;
1348     }
1349   else
1350     reloc_entry->addend = val;
1351 
1352   if (relocatable)
1353     reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1354 
1355   return bfd_reloc_ok;
1356 }
1357 
1358 /* Used to store a REL high-part relocation such as R_MIPS_HI16 or
1359    R_MIPS_GOT16.  REL is the relocation, INPUT_SECTION is the section
1360    that contains the relocation field and DATA points to the start of
1361    INPUT_SECTION.  */
1362 
1363 struct mips_hi16
1364 {
1365   struct mips_hi16 *next;
1366   bfd_byte *data;
1367   asection *input_section;
1368   arelent rel;
1369 };
1370 
1371 /* FIXME: This should not be a static variable.  */
1372 
1373 static struct mips_hi16 *mips_hi16_list;
1374 
1375 /* A howto special_function for REL *HI16 relocations.  We can only
1376    calculate the correct value once we've seen the partnering
1377    *LO16 relocation, so just save the information for later.
1378 
1379    The ABI requires that the *LO16 immediately follow the *HI16.
1380    However, as a GNU extension, we permit an arbitrary number of
1381    *HI16s to be associated with a single *LO16.  This significantly
1382    simplies the relocation handling in gcc.  */
1383 
1384 bfd_reloc_status_type
_bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,arelent * reloc_entry,asymbol * symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,void * data,asection * input_section,bfd * output_bfd,char ** error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)1385 _bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *reloc_entry,
1386 			  asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, void *data,
1387 			  asection *input_section, bfd *output_bfd,
1388 			  char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1389 {
1390   struct mips_hi16 *n;
1391 
1392   if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1393     return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1394 
1395   n = bfd_malloc (sizeof *n);
1396   if (n == NULL)
1397     return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1398 
1399   n->next = mips_hi16_list;
1400   n->data = data;
1401   n->input_section = input_section;
1402   n->rel = *reloc_entry;
1403   mips_hi16_list = n;
1404 
1405   if (output_bfd != NULL)
1406     reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1407 
1408   return bfd_reloc_ok;
1409 }
1410 
1411 /* A howto special_function for REL R_MIPS_GOT16 relocations.  This is just
1412    like any other 16-bit relocation when applied to global symbols, but is
1413    treated in the same as R_MIPS_HI16 when applied to local symbols.  */
1414 
1415 bfd_reloc_status_type
_bfd_mips_elf_got16_reloc(bfd * abfd,arelent * reloc_entry,asymbol * symbol,void * data,asection * input_section,bfd * output_bfd,char ** error_message)1416 _bfd_mips_elf_got16_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1417 			   void *data, asection *input_section,
1418 			   bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1419 {
1420   if ((symbol->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK)) != 0
1421       || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (symbol))
1422       || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (symbol)))
1423     /* The relocation is against a global symbol.  */
1424     return _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1425 					input_section, output_bfd,
1426 					error_message);
1427 
1428   return _bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1429 				   input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1430 }
1431 
1432 /* A howto special_function for REL *LO16 relocations.  The *LO16 itself
1433    is a straightforward 16 bit inplace relocation, but we must deal with
1434    any partnering high-part relocations as well.  */
1435 
1436 bfd_reloc_status_type
_bfd_mips_elf_lo16_reloc(bfd * abfd,arelent * reloc_entry,asymbol * symbol,void * data,asection * input_section,bfd * output_bfd,char ** error_message)1437 _bfd_mips_elf_lo16_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1438 			  void *data, asection *input_section,
1439 			  bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1440 {
1441   bfd_vma vallo;
1442   bfd_byte *location = (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address;
1443 
1444   if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1445     return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1446 
1447   _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
1448 				   location);
1449   vallo = bfd_get_32 (abfd, location);
1450   _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
1451 				 location);
1452 
1453   while (mips_hi16_list != NULL)
1454     {
1455       bfd_reloc_status_type ret;
1456       struct mips_hi16 *hi;
1457 
1458       hi = mips_hi16_list;
1459 
1460       /* R_MIPS_GOT16 relocations are something of a special case.  We
1461 	 want to install the addend in the same way as for a R_MIPS_HI16
1462 	 relocation (with a rightshift of 16).  However, since GOT16
1463 	 relocations can also be used with global symbols, their howto
1464 	 has a rightshift of 0.  */
1465       if (hi->rel.howto->type == R_MIPS_GOT16)
1466 	hi->rel.howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, R_MIPS_HI16, FALSE);
1467 
1468       /* VALLO is a signed 16-bit number.  Bias it by 0x8000 so that any
1469 	 carry or borrow will induce a change of +1 or -1 in the high part.  */
1470       hi->rel.addend += (vallo + 0x8000) & 0xffff;
1471 
1472       ret = _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, &hi->rel, symbol, hi->data,
1473 					 hi->input_section, output_bfd,
1474 					 error_message);
1475       if (ret != bfd_reloc_ok)
1476 	return ret;
1477 
1478       mips_hi16_list = hi->next;
1479       free (hi);
1480     }
1481 
1482   return _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1483 				      input_section, output_bfd,
1484 				      error_message);
1485 }
1486 
1487 /* A generic howto special_function.  This calculates and installs the
1488    relocation itself, thus avoiding the oft-discussed problems in
1489    bfd_perform_relocation and bfd_install_relocation.  */
1490 
1491 bfd_reloc_status_type
_bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,arelent * reloc_entry,asymbol * symbol,void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection * input_section,bfd * output_bfd,char ** error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)1492 _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *reloc_entry,
1493 			     asymbol *symbol, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1494 			     asection *input_section, bfd *output_bfd,
1495 			     char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1496 {
1497   bfd_signed_vma val;
1498   bfd_reloc_status_type status;
1499   bfd_boolean relocatable;
1500 
1501   relocatable = (output_bfd != NULL);
1502 
1503   if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1504     return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1505 
1506   /* Build up the field adjustment in VAL.  */
1507   val = 0;
1508   if (!relocatable || (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0)
1509     {
1510       /* Either we're calculating the final field value or we have a
1511 	 relocation against a section symbol.  Add in the section's
1512 	 offset or address.  */
1513       val += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1514       val += symbol->section->output_offset;
1515     }
1516 
1517   if (!relocatable)
1518     {
1519       /* We're calculating the final field value.  Add in the symbol's value
1520 	 and, if pc-relative, subtract the address of the field itself.  */
1521       val += symbol->value;
1522       if (reloc_entry->howto->pc_relative)
1523 	{
1524 	  val -= input_section->output_section->vma;
1525 	  val -= input_section->output_offset;
1526 	  val -= reloc_entry->address;
1527 	}
1528     }
1529 
1530   /* VAL is now the final adjustment.  If we're keeping this relocation
1531      in the output file, and if the relocation uses a separate addend,
1532      we just need to add VAL to that addend.  Otherwise we need to add
1533      VAL to the relocation field itself.  */
1534   if (relocatable && !reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace)
1535     reloc_entry->addend += val;
1536   else
1537     {
1538       bfd_byte *location = (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address;
1539 
1540       /* Add in the separate addend, if any.  */
1541       val += reloc_entry->addend;
1542 
1543       /* Add VAL to the relocation field.  */
1544       _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
1545 				       location);
1546       status = _bfd_relocate_contents (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, val,
1547 				       location);
1548       _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
1549 				     location);
1550 
1551       if (status != bfd_reloc_ok)
1552 	return status;
1553     }
1554 
1555   if (relocatable)
1556     reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1557 
1558   return bfd_reloc_ok;
1559 }
1560 
1561 /* Swap an entry in a .gptab section.  Note that these routines rely
1562    on the equivalence of the two elements of the union.  */
1563 
1564 static void
bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in(bfd * abfd,const Elf32_External_gptab * ex,Elf32_gptab * in)1565 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_External_gptab *ex,
1566 			      Elf32_gptab *in)
1567 {
1568   in->gt_entry.gt_g_value = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->gt_entry.gt_g_value);
1569   in->gt_entry.gt_bytes = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->gt_entry.gt_bytes);
1570 }
1571 
1572 static void
bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out(bfd * abfd,const Elf32_gptab * in,Elf32_External_gptab * ex)1573 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_gptab *in,
1574 			       Elf32_External_gptab *ex)
1575 {
1576   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->gt_entry.gt_g_value, ex->gt_entry.gt_g_value);
1577   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->gt_entry.gt_bytes, ex->gt_entry.gt_bytes);
1578 }
1579 
1580 static void
bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out(bfd * abfd,const Elf32_compact_rel * in,Elf32_External_compact_rel * ex)1581 bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_compact_rel *in,
1582 				Elf32_External_compact_rel *ex)
1583 {
1584   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->id1, ex->id1);
1585   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->num, ex->num);
1586   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->id2, ex->id2);
1587   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->offset, ex->offset);
1588   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->reserved0, ex->reserved0);
1589   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->reserved1, ex->reserved1);
1590 }
1591 
1592 static void
bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out(bfd * abfd,const Elf32_crinfo * in,Elf32_External_crinfo * ex)1593 bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_crinfo *in,
1594 			   Elf32_External_crinfo *ex)
1595 {
1596   unsigned long l;
1597 
1598   l = (((in->ctype & CRINFO_CTYPE) << CRINFO_CTYPE_SH)
1599        | ((in->rtype & CRINFO_RTYPE) << CRINFO_RTYPE_SH)
1600        | ((in->dist2to & CRINFO_DIST2TO) << CRINFO_DIST2TO_SH)
1601        | ((in->relvaddr & CRINFO_RELVADDR) << CRINFO_RELVADDR_SH));
1602   H_PUT_32 (abfd, l, ex->info);
1603   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->konst, ex->konst);
1604   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->vaddr, ex->vaddr);
1605 }
1606 
1607 /* A .reginfo section holds a single Elf32_RegInfo structure.  These
1608    routines swap this structure in and out.  They are used outside of
1609    BFD, so they are globally visible.  */
1610 
1611 void
bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in(bfd * abfd,const Elf32_External_RegInfo * ex,Elf32_RegInfo * in)1612 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_External_RegInfo *ex,
1613 				Elf32_RegInfo *in)
1614 {
1615   in->ri_gprmask = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gprmask);
1616   in->ri_cprmask[0] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1617   in->ri_cprmask[1] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1618   in->ri_cprmask[2] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1619   in->ri_cprmask[3] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1620   in->ri_gp_value = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gp_value);
1621 }
1622 
1623 void
bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out(bfd * abfd,const Elf32_RegInfo * in,Elf32_External_RegInfo * ex)1624 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_RegInfo *in,
1625 				 Elf32_External_RegInfo *ex)
1626 {
1627   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gprmask, ex->ri_gprmask);
1628   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[0], ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1629   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[1], ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1630   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[2], ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1631   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[3], ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1632   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gp_value, ex->ri_gp_value);
1633 }
1634 
1635 /* In the 64 bit ABI, the .MIPS.options section holds register
1636    information in an Elf64_Reginfo structure.  These routines swap
1637    them in and out.  They are globally visible because they are used
1638    outside of BFD.  These routines are here so that gas can call them
1639    without worrying about whether the 64 bit ABI has been included.  */
1640 
1641 void
bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in(bfd * abfd,const Elf64_External_RegInfo * ex,Elf64_Internal_RegInfo * in)1642 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf64_External_RegInfo *ex,
1643 				Elf64_Internal_RegInfo *in)
1644 {
1645   in->ri_gprmask = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gprmask);
1646   in->ri_pad = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_pad);
1647   in->ri_cprmask[0] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1648   in->ri_cprmask[1] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1649   in->ri_cprmask[2] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1650   in->ri_cprmask[3] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1651   in->ri_gp_value = H_GET_64 (abfd, ex->ri_gp_value);
1652 }
1653 
1654 void
bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_out(bfd * abfd,const Elf64_Internal_RegInfo * in,Elf64_External_RegInfo * ex)1655 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf64_Internal_RegInfo *in,
1656 				 Elf64_External_RegInfo *ex)
1657 {
1658   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gprmask, ex->ri_gprmask);
1659   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_pad, ex->ri_pad);
1660   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[0], ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1661   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[1], ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1662   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[2], ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1663   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[3], ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1664   H_PUT_64 (abfd, in->ri_gp_value, ex->ri_gp_value);
1665 }
1666 
1667 /* Swap in an options header.  */
1668 
1669 void
bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in(bfd * abfd,const Elf_External_Options * ex,Elf_Internal_Options * in)1670 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf_External_Options *ex,
1671 			      Elf_Internal_Options *in)
1672 {
1673   in->kind = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->kind);
1674   in->size = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->size);
1675   in->section = H_GET_16 (abfd, ex->section);
1676   in->info = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->info);
1677 }
1678 
1679 /* Swap out an options header.  */
1680 
1681 void
bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_out(bfd * abfd,const Elf_Internal_Options * in,Elf_External_Options * ex)1682 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf_Internal_Options *in,
1683 			       Elf_External_Options *ex)
1684 {
1685   H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->kind, ex->kind);
1686   H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->size, ex->size);
1687   H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->section, ex->section);
1688   H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->info, ex->info);
1689 }
1690 
1691 /* This function is called via qsort() to sort the dynamic relocation
1692    entries by increasing r_symndx value.  */
1693 
1694 static int
sort_dynamic_relocs(const void * arg1,const void * arg2)1695 sort_dynamic_relocs (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
1696 {
1697   Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc1;
1698   Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc2;
1699   int diff;
1700 
1701   bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg1, &int_reloc1);
1702   bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg2, &int_reloc2);
1703 
1704   diff = ELF32_R_SYM (int_reloc1.r_info) - ELF32_R_SYM (int_reloc2.r_info);
1705   if (diff != 0)
1706     return diff;
1707 
1708   if (int_reloc1.r_offset < int_reloc2.r_offset)
1709     return -1;
1710   if (int_reloc1.r_offset > int_reloc2.r_offset)
1711     return 1;
1712   return 0;
1713 }
1714 
1715 /* Like sort_dynamic_relocs, but used for elf64 relocations.  */
1716 
1717 static int
sort_dynamic_relocs_64(const void * arg1 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const void * arg2 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)1718 sort_dynamic_relocs_64 (const void *arg1 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1719 			const void *arg2 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1720 {
1721 #ifdef BFD64
1722   Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc1[3];
1723   Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc2[3];
1724 
1725   (*get_elf_backend_data (reldyn_sorting_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_in)
1726     (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg1, int_reloc1);
1727   (*get_elf_backend_data (reldyn_sorting_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_in)
1728     (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg2, int_reloc2);
1729 
1730   if (ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc1[0].r_info) < ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc2[0].r_info))
1731     return -1;
1732   if (ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc1[0].r_info) > ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc2[0].r_info))
1733     return 1;
1734 
1735   if (int_reloc1[0].r_offset < int_reloc2[0].r_offset)
1736     return -1;
1737   if (int_reloc1[0].r_offset > int_reloc2[0].r_offset)
1738     return 1;
1739   return 0;
1740 #else
1741   abort ();
1742 #endif
1743 }
1744 
1745 
1746 /* This routine is used to write out ECOFF debugging external symbol
1747    information.  It is called via mips_elf_link_hash_traverse.  The
1748    ECOFF external symbol information must match the ELF external
1749    symbol information.  Unfortunately, at this point we don't know
1750    whether a symbol is required by reloc information, so the two
1751    tables may wind up being different.  We must sort out the external
1752    symbol information before we can set the final size of the .mdebug
1753    section, and we must set the size of the .mdebug section before we
1754    can relocate any sections, and we can't know which symbols are
1755    required by relocation until we relocate the sections.
1756    Fortunately, it is relatively unlikely that any symbol will be
1757    stripped but required by a reloc.  In particular, it can not happen
1758    when generating a final executable.  */
1759 
1760 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_output_extsym(struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,void * data)1761 mips_elf_output_extsym (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
1762 {
1763   struct extsym_info *einfo = data;
1764   bfd_boolean strip;
1765   asection *sec, *output_section;
1766 
1767   if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
1768     h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
1769 
1770   if (h->root.indx == -2)
1771     strip = FALSE;
1772   else if ((h->root.def_dynamic
1773 	    || h->root.ref_dynamic
1774 	    || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
1775 	   && !h->root.def_regular
1776 	   && !h->root.ref_regular)
1777     strip = TRUE;
1778   else if (einfo->info->strip == strip_all
1779 	   || (einfo->info->strip == strip_some
1780 	       && bfd_hash_lookup (einfo->info->keep_hash,
1781 				   h->root.root.root.string,
1782 				   FALSE, FALSE) == NULL))
1783     strip = TRUE;
1784   else
1785     strip = FALSE;
1786 
1787   if (strip)
1788     return TRUE;
1789 
1790   if (h->esym.ifd == -2)
1791     {
1792       h->esym.jmptbl = 0;
1793       h->esym.cobol_main = 0;
1794       h->esym.weakext = 0;
1795       h->esym.reserved = 0;
1796       h->esym.ifd = ifdNil;
1797       h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1798       h->esym.asym.st = stGlobal;
1799 
1800       if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
1801 	  || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
1802 	{
1803 	  const char *name;
1804 
1805 	  /* Use undefined class.  Also, set class and type for some
1806              special symbols.  */
1807 	  name = h->root.root.root.string;
1808 	  if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[0]) == 0
1809 	      || strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[1]) == 0)
1810 	    {
1811 	      h->esym.asym.sc = scData;
1812 	      h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
1813 	      h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1814 	    }
1815 	  else if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[2]) == 0)
1816 	    {
1817 	      h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1818 	      h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
1819 	      h->esym.asym.value =
1820 		mips_elf_hash_table (einfo->info)->procedure_count;
1821 	    }
1822 	  else if (strcmp (name, "_gp_disp") == 0 && ! NEWABI_P (einfo->abfd))
1823 	    {
1824 	      h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1825 	      h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
1826 	      h->esym.asym.value = elf_gp (einfo->abfd);
1827 	    }
1828 	  else
1829 	    h->esym.asym.sc = scUndefined;
1830 	}
1831       else if (h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
1832 	  && h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
1833 	h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1834       else
1835 	{
1836 	  const char *name;
1837 
1838 	  sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
1839 	  output_section = sec->output_section;
1840 
1841 	  /* When making a shared library and symbol h is the one from
1842 	     the another shared library, OUTPUT_SECTION may be null.  */
1843 	  if (output_section == NULL)
1844 	    h->esym.asym.sc = scUndefined;
1845 	  else
1846 	    {
1847 	      name = bfd_section_name (output_section->owner, output_section);
1848 
1849 	      if (strcmp (name, ".text") == 0)
1850 		h->esym.asym.sc = scText;
1851 	      else if (strcmp (name, ".data") == 0)
1852 		h->esym.asym.sc = scData;
1853 	      else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0)
1854 		h->esym.asym.sc = scSData;
1855 	      else if (strcmp (name, ".rodata") == 0
1856 		       || strcmp (name, ".rdata") == 0)
1857 		h->esym.asym.sc = scRData;
1858 	      else if (strcmp (name, ".bss") == 0)
1859 		h->esym.asym.sc = scBss;
1860 	      else if (strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
1861 		h->esym.asym.sc = scSBss;
1862 	      else if (strcmp (name, ".init") == 0)
1863 		h->esym.asym.sc = scInit;
1864 	      else if (strcmp (name, ".fini") == 0)
1865 		h->esym.asym.sc = scFini;
1866 	      else
1867 		h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1868 	    }
1869 	}
1870 
1871       h->esym.asym.reserved = 0;
1872       h->esym.asym.index = indexNil;
1873     }
1874 
1875   if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_common)
1876     h->esym.asym.value = h->root.root.u.c.size;
1877   else if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
1878 	   || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
1879     {
1880       if (h->esym.asym.sc == scCommon)
1881 	h->esym.asym.sc = scBss;
1882       else if (h->esym.asym.sc == scSCommon)
1883 	h->esym.asym.sc = scSBss;
1884 
1885       sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
1886       output_section = sec->output_section;
1887       if (output_section != NULL)
1888 	h->esym.asym.value = (h->root.root.u.def.value
1889 			      + sec->output_offset
1890 			      + output_section->vma);
1891       else
1892 	h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1893     }
1894   else if (h->root.needs_plt)
1895     {
1896       struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hd = h;
1897       bfd_boolean no_fn_stub = h->no_fn_stub;
1898 
1899       while (hd->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
1900 	{
1901 	  hd = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h->root.root.u.i.link;
1902 	  no_fn_stub = no_fn_stub || hd->no_fn_stub;
1903 	}
1904 
1905       if (!no_fn_stub)
1906 	{
1907 	  /* Set type and value for a symbol with a function stub.  */
1908 	  h->esym.asym.st = stProc;
1909 	  sec = hd->root.root.u.def.section;
1910 	  if (sec == NULL)
1911 	    h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1912 	  else
1913 	    {
1914 	      output_section = sec->output_section;
1915 	      if (output_section != NULL)
1916 		h->esym.asym.value = (hd->root.plt.offset
1917 				      + sec->output_offset
1918 				      + output_section->vma);
1919 	      else
1920 		h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1921 	    }
1922 	}
1923     }
1924 
1925   if (! bfd_ecoff_debug_one_external (einfo->abfd, einfo->debug, einfo->swap,
1926 				      h->root.root.root.string,
1927 				      &h->esym))
1928     {
1929       einfo->failed = TRUE;
1930       return FALSE;
1931     }
1932 
1933   return TRUE;
1934 }
1935 
1936 /* A comparison routine used to sort .gptab entries.  */
1937 
1938 static int
gptab_compare(const void * p1,const void * p2)1939 gptab_compare (const void *p1, const void *p2)
1940 {
1941   const Elf32_gptab *a1 = p1;
1942   const Elf32_gptab *a2 = p2;
1943 
1944   return a1->gt_entry.gt_g_value - a2->gt_entry.gt_g_value;
1945 }
1946 
1947 /* Functions to manage the got entry hash table.  */
1948 
1949 /* Use all 64 bits of a bfd_vma for the computation of a 32-bit
1950    hash number.  */
1951 
1952 static INLINE hashval_t
mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma(bfd_vma addr)1953 mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (bfd_vma addr)
1954 {
1955 #ifdef BFD64
1956   return addr + (addr >> 32);
1957 #else
1958   return addr;
1959 #endif
1960 }
1961 
1962 /* got_entries only match if they're identical, except for gotidx, so
1963    use all fields to compute the hash, and compare the appropriate
1964    union members.  */
1965 
1966 static hashval_t
mips_elf_got_entry_hash(const void * entry_)1967 mips_elf_got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
1968 {
1969   const struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry_;
1970 
1971   return entry->symndx
1972     + ((entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM) << 17)
1973     + (! entry->abfd ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.address)
1974        : entry->abfd->id
1975          + (entry->symndx >= 0 ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.addend)
1976 	    : entry->d.h->root.root.root.hash));
1977 }
1978 
1979 static int
mips_elf_got_entry_eq(const void * entry1,const void * entry2)1980 mips_elf_got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
1981 {
1982   const struct mips_got_entry *e1 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry1;
1983   const struct mips_got_entry *e2 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry2;
1984 
1985   /* An LDM entry can only match another LDM entry.  */
1986   if ((e1->tls_type ^ e2->tls_type) & GOT_TLS_LDM)
1987     return 0;
1988 
1989   return e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->symndx == e2->symndx
1990     && (! e1->abfd ? e1->d.address == e2->d.address
1991 	: e1->symndx >= 0 ? e1->d.addend == e2->d.addend
1992 	: e1->d.h == e2->d.h);
1993 }
1994 
1995 /* multi_got_entries are still a match in the case of global objects,
1996    even if the input bfd in which they're referenced differs, so the
1997    hash computation and compare functions are adjusted
1998    accordingly.  */
1999 
2000 static hashval_t
mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash(const void * entry_)2001 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
2002 {
2003   const struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry_;
2004 
2005   return entry->symndx
2006     + (! entry->abfd
2007        ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.address)
2008        : entry->symndx >= 0
2009        ? ((entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2010 	  ? (GOT_TLS_LDM << 17)
2011 	  : (entry->abfd->id
2012 	     + mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.addend)))
2013        : entry->d.h->root.root.root.hash);
2014 }
2015 
2016 static int
mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq(const void * entry1,const void * entry2)2017 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
2018 {
2019   const struct mips_got_entry *e1 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry1;
2020   const struct mips_got_entry *e2 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry2;
2021 
2022   /* Any two LDM entries match.  */
2023   if (e1->tls_type & e2->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2024     return 1;
2025 
2026   /* Nothing else matches an LDM entry.  */
2027   if ((e1->tls_type ^ e2->tls_type) & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2028     return 0;
2029 
2030   return e1->symndx == e2->symndx
2031     && (e1->symndx >= 0 ? e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->d.addend == e2->d.addend
2032 	: e1->abfd == NULL || e2->abfd == NULL
2033 	? e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->d.address == e2->d.address
2034 	: e1->d.h == e2->d.h);
2035 }
2036 
2037 /* Return the dynamic relocation section.  If it doesn't exist, try to
2038    create a new it if CREATE_P, otherwise return NULL.  Also return NULL
2039    if creation fails.  */
2040 
2041 static asection *
mips_elf_rel_dyn_section(struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd_boolean create_p)2042 mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd_boolean create_p)
2043 {
2044   const char *dname;
2045   asection *sreloc;
2046   bfd *dynobj;
2047 
2048   dname = MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info);
2049   dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
2050   sreloc = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, dname);
2051   if (sreloc == NULL && create_p)
2052     {
2053       sreloc = bfd_make_section_with_flags (dynobj, dname,
2054 					    (SEC_ALLOC
2055 					     | SEC_LOAD
2056 					     | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2057 					     | SEC_IN_MEMORY
2058 					     | SEC_LINKER_CREATED
2059 					     | SEC_READONLY));
2060       if (sreloc == NULL
2061 	  || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, sreloc,
2062 					  MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (dynobj)))
2063 	return NULL;
2064     }
2065   return sreloc;
2066 }
2067 
2068 /* Returns the GOT section for ABFD.  */
2069 
2070 static asection *
mips_elf_got_section(bfd * abfd,bfd_boolean maybe_excluded)2071 mips_elf_got_section (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean maybe_excluded)
2072 {
2073   asection *sgot = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
2074   if (sgot == NULL
2075       || (! maybe_excluded && (sgot->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0))
2076     return NULL;
2077   return sgot;
2078 }
2079 
2080 /* Returns the GOT information associated with the link indicated by
2081    INFO.  If SGOTP is non-NULL, it is filled in with the GOT
2082    section.  */
2083 
2084 static struct mips_got_info *
mips_elf_got_info(bfd * abfd,asection ** sgotp)2085 mips_elf_got_info (bfd *abfd, asection **sgotp)
2086 {
2087   asection *sgot;
2088   struct mips_got_info *g;
2089 
2090   sgot = mips_elf_got_section (abfd, TRUE);
2091   BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL);
2092   BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
2093   g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
2094   BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
2095 
2096   if (sgotp)
2097     *sgotp = (sgot->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0 ? sgot : NULL;
2098 
2099   return g;
2100 }
2101 
2102 /* Count the number of relocations needed for a TLS GOT entry, with
2103    access types from TLS_TYPE, and symbol H (or a local symbol if H
2104    is NULL).  */
2105 
2106 static int
mips_tls_got_relocs(struct bfd_link_info * info,unsigned char tls_type,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)2107 mips_tls_got_relocs (struct bfd_link_info *info, unsigned char tls_type,
2108 		     struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
2109 {
2110   int indx = 0;
2111   int ret = 0;
2112   bfd_boolean need_relocs = FALSE;
2113   bfd_boolean dyn = elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created;
2114 
2115   if (h && WILL_CALL_FINISH_DYNAMIC_SYMBOL (dyn, info->shared, h)
2116       && (!info->shared || !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)))
2117     indx = h->dynindx;
2118 
2119   if ((info->shared || indx != 0)
2120       && (h == NULL
2121 	  || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT
2122 	  || h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
2123     need_relocs = TRUE;
2124 
2125   if (!need_relocs)
2126     return FALSE;
2127 
2128   if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
2129     {
2130       ret++;
2131       if (indx != 0)
2132 	ret++;
2133     }
2134 
2135   if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
2136     ret++;
2137 
2138   if ((tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM) && info->shared)
2139     ret++;
2140 
2141   return ret;
2142 }
2143 
2144 /* Count the number of TLS relocations required for the GOT entry in
2145    ARG1, if it describes a local symbol.  */
2146 
2147 static int
mips_elf_count_local_tls_relocs(void ** arg1,void * arg2)2148 mips_elf_count_local_tls_relocs (void **arg1, void *arg2)
2149 {
2150   struct mips_got_entry *entry = * (struct mips_got_entry **) arg1;
2151   struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg *arg = arg2;
2152 
2153   if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx != -1)
2154     arg->needed += mips_tls_got_relocs (arg->info, entry->tls_type, NULL);
2155 
2156   return 1;
2157 }
2158 
2159 /* Count the number of TLS GOT entries required for the global (or
2160    forced-local) symbol in ARG1.  */
2161 
2162 static int
mips_elf_count_global_tls_entries(void * arg1,void * arg2)2163 mips_elf_count_global_tls_entries (void *arg1, void *arg2)
2164 {
2165   struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hm
2166     = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) arg1;
2167   struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg *arg = arg2;
2168 
2169   if (hm->tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
2170     arg->needed += 2;
2171   if (hm->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
2172     arg->needed += 1;
2173 
2174   return 1;
2175 }
2176 
2177 /* Count the number of TLS relocations required for the global (or
2178    forced-local) symbol in ARG1.  */
2179 
2180 static int
mips_elf_count_global_tls_relocs(void * arg1,void * arg2)2181 mips_elf_count_global_tls_relocs (void *arg1, void *arg2)
2182 {
2183   struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hm
2184     = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) arg1;
2185   struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg *arg = arg2;
2186 
2187   arg->needed += mips_tls_got_relocs (arg->info, hm->tls_type, &hm->root);
2188 
2189   return 1;
2190 }
2191 
2192 /* Output a simple dynamic relocation into SRELOC.  */
2193 
2194 static void
mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation(bfd * output_bfd,asection * sreloc,unsigned long indx,int r_type,bfd_vma offset)2195 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation (bfd *output_bfd,
2196 				    asection *sreloc,
2197 				    unsigned long indx,
2198 				    int r_type,
2199 				    bfd_vma offset)
2200 {
2201   Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
2202 
2203   memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
2204 
2205   rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, indx, r_type);
2206   rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset = offset;
2207 
2208   if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
2209     {
2210       (*get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_out)
2211 	(output_bfd, &rel[0],
2212 	 (sreloc->contents
2213 	  + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)));
2214     }
2215   else
2216     bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out
2217       (output_bfd, &rel[0],
2218        (sreloc->contents
2219 	+ sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
2220   ++sreloc->reloc_count;
2221 }
2222 
2223 /* Initialize a set of TLS GOT entries for one symbol.  */
2224 
2225 static void
mips_elf_initialize_tls_slots(bfd * abfd,bfd_vma got_offset,unsigned char * tls_type_p,struct bfd_link_info * info,struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,bfd_vma value)2226 mips_elf_initialize_tls_slots (bfd *abfd, bfd_vma got_offset,
2227 			       unsigned char *tls_type_p,
2228 			       struct bfd_link_info *info,
2229 			       struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2230 			       bfd_vma value)
2231 {
2232   int indx;
2233   asection *sreloc, *sgot;
2234   bfd_vma offset, offset2;
2235   bfd *dynobj;
2236   bfd_boolean need_relocs = FALSE;
2237 
2238   dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
2239   sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
2240 
2241   indx = 0;
2242   if (h != NULL)
2243     {
2244       bfd_boolean dyn = elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created;
2245 
2246       if (WILL_CALL_FINISH_DYNAMIC_SYMBOL (dyn, info->shared, &h->root)
2247 	  && (!info->shared || !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->root)))
2248 	indx = h->root.dynindx;
2249     }
2250 
2251   if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_DONE)
2252     return;
2253 
2254   if ((info->shared || indx != 0)
2255       && (h == NULL
2256 	  || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT
2257 	  || h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
2258     need_relocs = TRUE;
2259 
2260   /* MINUS_ONE means the symbol is not defined in this object.  It may not
2261      be defined at all; assume that the value doesn't matter in that
2262      case.  Otherwise complain if we would use the value.  */
2263   BFD_ASSERT (value != MINUS_ONE || (indx != 0 && need_relocs)
2264 	      || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak);
2265 
2266   /* Emit necessary relocations.  */
2267   sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
2268 
2269   /* General Dynamic.  */
2270   if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_GD)
2271     {
2272       offset = got_offset;
2273       offset2 = offset + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
2274 
2275       if (need_relocs)
2276 	{
2277 	  mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2278 	    (abfd, sreloc, indx,
2279 	     ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32,
2280 	     sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + offset);
2281 
2282 	  if (indx)
2283 	    mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2284 	      (abfd, sreloc, indx,
2285 	       ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32,
2286 	       sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + offset2);
2287 	  else
2288 	    MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - dtprel_base (info),
2289 			       sgot->contents + offset2);
2290 	}
2291       else
2292 	{
2293 	  MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 1,
2294 			     sgot->contents + offset);
2295 	  MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - dtprel_base (info),
2296 			     sgot->contents + offset2);
2297 	}
2298 
2299       got_offset += 2 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
2300     }
2301 
2302   /* Initial Exec model.  */
2303   if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_IE)
2304     {
2305       offset = got_offset;
2306 
2307       if (need_relocs)
2308 	{
2309 	  if (indx == 0)
2310 	    MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma,
2311 			       sgot->contents + offset);
2312 	  else
2313 	    MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 0,
2314 			       sgot->contents + offset);
2315 
2316 	  mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2317 	    (abfd, sreloc, indx,
2318 	     ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64 : R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32,
2319 	     sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + offset);
2320 	}
2321       else
2322 	MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - tprel_base (info),
2323 			   sgot->contents + offset);
2324     }
2325 
2326   if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2327     {
2328       /* The initial offset is zero, and the LD offsets will include the
2329 	 bias by DTP_OFFSET.  */
2330       MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 0,
2331 			 sgot->contents + got_offset
2332 			 + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd));
2333 
2334       if (!info->shared)
2335 	MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 1,
2336 			   sgot->contents + got_offset);
2337       else
2338 	mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2339 	  (abfd, sreloc, indx,
2340 	   ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32,
2341 	   sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + got_offset);
2342     }
2343 
2344   *tls_type_p |= GOT_TLS_DONE;
2345 }
2346 
2347 /* Return the GOT index to use for a relocation of type R_TYPE against
2348    a symbol accessed using TLS_TYPE models.  The GOT entries for this
2349    symbol in this GOT start at GOT_INDEX.  This function initializes the
2350    GOT entries and corresponding relocations.  */
2351 
2352 static bfd_vma
mips_tls_got_index(bfd * abfd,bfd_vma got_index,unsigned char * tls_type,int r_type,struct bfd_link_info * info,struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,bfd_vma symbol)2353 mips_tls_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd_vma got_index, unsigned char *tls_type,
2354 		    int r_type, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2355 		    struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, bfd_vma symbol)
2356 {
2357   BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD
2358 	      || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM);
2359 
2360   mips_elf_initialize_tls_slots (abfd, got_index, tls_type, info, h, symbol);
2361 
2362   if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL)
2363     {
2364       BFD_ASSERT (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE);
2365       if (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
2366 	return got_index + 2 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
2367       else
2368 	return got_index;
2369     }
2370 
2371   if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD)
2372     {
2373       BFD_ASSERT (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD);
2374       return got_index;
2375     }
2376 
2377   if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
2378     {
2379       BFD_ASSERT (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM);
2380       return got_index;
2381     }
2382 
2383   return got_index;
2384 }
2385 
2386 /* Return the offset from _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ of the .got.plt entry
2387    for global symbol H.  .got.plt comes before the GOT, so the offset
2388    will be negative.  */
2389 
2390 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_gotplt_index(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)2391 mips_elf_gotplt_index (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2392 		       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
2393 {
2394   bfd_vma plt_index, got_address, got_value;
2395   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2396 
2397   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
2398   BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1);
2399 
2400   /* Calculate the index of the symbol's PLT entry.  */
2401   plt_index = (h->plt.offset - htab->plt_header_size) / htab->plt_entry_size;
2402 
2403   /* Calculate the address of the associated .got.plt entry.  */
2404   got_address = (htab->sgotplt->output_section->vma
2405 		 + htab->sgotplt->output_offset
2406 		 + plt_index * 4);
2407 
2408   /* Calculate the value of _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_.  */
2409   got_value = (htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
2410 	       + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_offset
2411 	       + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.value);
2412 
2413   return got_address - got_value;
2414 }
2415 
2416 /* Return the GOT offset for address VALUE.   If there is not yet a GOT
2417    entry for this value, create one.  If R_SYMNDX refers to a TLS symbol,
2418    create a TLS GOT entry instead.  Return -1 if no satisfactory GOT
2419    offset can be found.  */
2420 
2421 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_local_got_index(bfd * abfd,bfd * ibfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd_vma value,unsigned long r_symndx,struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,int r_type)2422 mips_elf_local_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2423 			  bfd_vma value, unsigned long r_symndx,
2424 			  struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, int r_type)
2425 {
2426   asection *sgot;
2427   struct mips_got_info *g;
2428   struct mips_got_entry *entry;
2429 
2430   g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot);
2431 
2432   entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, info, ibfd, g, sgot,
2433 					   value, r_symndx, h, r_type);
2434   if (!entry)
2435     return MINUS_ONE;
2436 
2437   if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2438     {
2439       if (entry->symndx == -1 && g->next == NULL)
2440 	/* A type (3) entry in the single-GOT case.  We use the symbol's
2441 	   hash table entry to track the index.  */
2442 	return mips_tls_got_index (abfd, h->tls_got_offset, &h->tls_type,
2443 				   r_type, info, h, value);
2444       else
2445 	return mips_tls_got_index (abfd, entry->gotidx, &entry->tls_type,
2446 				   r_type, info, h, value);
2447     }
2448   else
2449     return entry->gotidx;
2450 }
2451 
2452 /* Returns the GOT index for the global symbol indicated by H.  */
2453 
2454 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_global_got_index(bfd * abfd,bfd * ibfd,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,int r_type,struct bfd_link_info * info)2455 mips_elf_global_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2456 			   int r_type, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2457 {
2458   bfd_vma index;
2459   asection *sgot;
2460   struct mips_got_info *g, *gg;
2461   long global_got_dynindx = 0;
2462 
2463   gg = g = mips_elf_got_info (abfd, &sgot);
2464   if (g->bfd2got && ibfd)
2465     {
2466       struct mips_got_entry e, *p;
2467 
2468       BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx >= 0);
2469 
2470       g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (g, ibfd);
2471       if (g->next != gg || TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2472 	{
2473 	  e.abfd = ibfd;
2474 	  e.symndx = -1;
2475 	  e.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h;
2476 	  e.tls_type = 0;
2477 
2478 	  p = htab_find (g->got_entries, &e);
2479 
2480 	  BFD_ASSERT (p->gotidx > 0);
2481 
2482 	  if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2483 	    {
2484 	      bfd_vma value = MINUS_ONE;
2485 	      if ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
2486 		   || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
2487 		  && h->root.u.def.section->output_section)
2488 		value = (h->root.u.def.value
2489 			 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
2490 			 + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma);
2491 
2492 	      return mips_tls_got_index (abfd, p->gotidx, &p->tls_type, r_type,
2493 					 info, e.d.h, value);
2494 	    }
2495 	  else
2496 	    return p->gotidx;
2497 	}
2498     }
2499 
2500   if (gg->global_gotsym != NULL)
2501     global_got_dynindx = gg->global_gotsym->dynindx;
2502 
2503   if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2504     {
2505       struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hm
2506 	= (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2507       bfd_vma value = MINUS_ONE;
2508 
2509       if ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
2510 	   || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
2511 	  && h->root.u.def.section->output_section)
2512 	value = (h->root.u.def.value
2513 		 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
2514 		 + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma);
2515 
2516       index = mips_tls_got_index (abfd, hm->tls_got_offset, &hm->tls_type,
2517 				  r_type, info, hm, value);
2518     }
2519   else
2520     {
2521       /* Once we determine the global GOT entry with the lowest dynamic
2522 	 symbol table index, we must put all dynamic symbols with greater
2523 	 indices into the GOT.  That makes it easy to calculate the GOT
2524 	 offset.  */
2525       BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx >= global_got_dynindx);
2526       index = ((h->dynindx - global_got_dynindx + g->local_gotno)
2527 	       * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd));
2528     }
2529   BFD_ASSERT (index < sgot->size);
2530 
2531   return index;
2532 }
2533 
2534 /* Find a GOT page entry that points to within 32KB of VALUE.  These
2535    entries are supposed to be placed at small offsets in the GOT, i.e.,
2536    within 32KB of GP.  Return the index of the GOT entry, or -1 if no
2537    entry could be created.  If OFFSETP is nonnull, use it to return the
2538    offset of the GOT entry from VALUE.  */
2539 
2540 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_got_page(bfd * abfd,bfd * ibfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd_vma value,bfd_vma * offsetp)2541 mips_elf_got_page (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2542 		   bfd_vma value, bfd_vma *offsetp)
2543 {
2544   asection *sgot;
2545   struct mips_got_info *g;
2546   bfd_vma page, index;
2547   struct mips_got_entry *entry;
2548 
2549   g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot);
2550 
2551   page = (value + 0x8000) & ~(bfd_vma) 0xffff;
2552   entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, info, ibfd, g, sgot,
2553 					   page, 0, NULL, R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE);
2554 
2555   if (!entry)
2556     return MINUS_ONE;
2557 
2558   index = entry->gotidx;
2559 
2560   if (offsetp)
2561     *offsetp = value - entry->d.address;
2562 
2563   return index;
2564 }
2565 
2566 /* Find a local GOT entry for an R_MIPS_GOT16 relocation against VALUE.
2567    EXTERNAL is true if the relocation was against a global symbol
2568    that has been forced local.  */
2569 
2570 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_got16_entry(bfd * abfd,bfd * ibfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd_vma value,bfd_boolean external)2571 mips_elf_got16_entry (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2572 		      bfd_vma value, bfd_boolean external)
2573 {
2574   asection *sgot;
2575   struct mips_got_info *g;
2576   struct mips_got_entry *entry;
2577 
2578   /* GOT16 relocations against local symbols are followed by a LO16
2579      relocation; those against global symbols are not.  Thus if the
2580      symbol was originally local, the GOT16 relocation should load the
2581      equivalent of %hi(VALUE), otherwise it should load VALUE itself.  */
2582   if (! external)
2583     value = mips_elf_high (value) << 16;
2584 
2585   g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot);
2586 
2587   entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, info, ibfd, g, sgot,
2588 					   value, 0, NULL, R_MIPS_GOT16);
2589   if (entry)
2590     return entry->gotidx;
2591   else
2592     return MINUS_ONE;
2593 }
2594 
2595 /* Returns the offset for the entry at the INDEXth position
2596    in the GOT.  */
2597 
2598 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_got_offset_from_index(bfd * dynobj,bfd * output_bfd,bfd * input_bfd,bfd_vma index)2599 mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (bfd *dynobj, bfd *output_bfd,
2600 				bfd *input_bfd, bfd_vma index)
2601 {
2602   asection *sgot;
2603   bfd_vma gp;
2604   struct mips_got_info *g;
2605 
2606   g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot);
2607   gp = _bfd_get_gp_value (output_bfd)
2608     + mips_elf_adjust_gp (output_bfd, g, input_bfd);
2609 
2610   return sgot->output_section->vma + sgot->output_offset + index - gp;
2611 }
2612 
2613 /* Create and return a local GOT entry for VALUE, which was calculated
2614    from a symbol belonging to INPUT_SECTON.  Return NULL if it could not
2615    be created.  If R_SYMNDX refers to a TLS symbol, create a TLS entry
2616    instead.  */
2617 
2618 static struct mips_got_entry *
mips_elf_create_local_got_entry(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd * ibfd,struct mips_got_info * gg,asection * sgot,bfd_vma value,unsigned long r_symndx,struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,int r_type)2619 mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2620 				 bfd *ibfd, struct mips_got_info *gg,
2621 				 asection *sgot, bfd_vma value,
2622 				 unsigned long r_symndx,
2623 				 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2624 				 int r_type)
2625 {
2626   struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
2627   struct mips_got_info *g;
2628   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2629 
2630   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
2631 
2632   entry.abfd = NULL;
2633   entry.symndx = -1;
2634   entry.d.address = value;
2635   entry.tls_type = 0;
2636 
2637   g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, ibfd);
2638   if (g == NULL)
2639     {
2640       g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, abfd);
2641       BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
2642     }
2643 
2644   /* We might have a symbol, H, if it has been forced local.  Use the
2645      global entry then.  It doesn't matter whether an entry is local
2646      or global for TLS, since the dynamic linker does not
2647      automatically relocate TLS GOT entries.  */
2648   BFD_ASSERT (h == NULL || h->root.forced_local);
2649   if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2650     {
2651       struct mips_got_entry *p;
2652 
2653       entry.abfd = ibfd;
2654       if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
2655 	{
2656 	  entry.tls_type = GOT_TLS_LDM;
2657 	  entry.symndx = 0;
2658 	  entry.d.addend = 0;
2659 	}
2660       else if (h == NULL)
2661 	{
2662 	  entry.symndx = r_symndx;
2663 	  entry.d.addend = 0;
2664 	}
2665       else
2666 	entry.d.h = h;
2667 
2668       p = (struct mips_got_entry *)
2669 	htab_find (g->got_entries, &entry);
2670 
2671       BFD_ASSERT (p);
2672       return p;
2673     }
2674 
2675   loc = (struct mips_got_entry **) htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry,
2676 						   INSERT);
2677   if (*loc)
2678     return *loc;
2679 
2680   entry.gotidx = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd) * g->assigned_gotno++;
2681   entry.tls_type = 0;
2682 
2683   *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
2684 
2685   if (! *loc)
2686     return NULL;
2687 
2688   memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
2689 
2690   if (g->assigned_gotno >= g->local_gotno)
2691     {
2692       (*loc)->gotidx = -1;
2693       /* We didn't allocate enough space in the GOT.  */
2694       (*_bfd_error_handler)
2695 	(_("not enough GOT space for local GOT entries"));
2696       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2697       return NULL;
2698     }
2699 
2700   MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value,
2701 		     (sgot->contents + entry.gotidx));
2702 
2703   /* These GOT entries need a dynamic relocation on VxWorks.  */
2704   if (htab->is_vxworks)
2705     {
2706       Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
2707       asection *s;
2708       bfd_byte *loc;
2709       bfd_vma got_address;
2710 
2711       s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
2712       got_address = (sgot->output_section->vma
2713 		     + sgot->output_offset
2714 		     + entry.gotidx);
2715 
2716       loc = s->contents + (s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
2717       outrel.r_offset = got_address;
2718       outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_MIPS_32);
2719       outrel.r_addend = value;
2720       bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (abfd, &outrel, loc);
2721     }
2722 
2723   return *loc;
2724 }
2725 
2726 /* Sort the dynamic symbol table so that symbols that need GOT entries
2727    appear towards the end.  This reduces the amount of GOT space
2728    required.  MAX_LOCAL is used to set the number of local symbols
2729    known to be in the dynamic symbol table.  During
2730    _bfd_mips_elf_size_dynamic_sections, this value is 1.  Afterward, the
2731    section symbols are added and the count is higher.  */
2732 
2733 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_sort_hash_table(struct bfd_link_info * info,unsigned long max_local)2734 mips_elf_sort_hash_table (struct bfd_link_info *info, unsigned long max_local)
2735 {
2736   struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data hsd;
2737   struct mips_got_info *g;
2738   bfd *dynobj;
2739 
2740   dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
2741 
2742   g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL);
2743 
2744   hsd.low = NULL;
2745   hsd.max_unref_got_dynindx =
2746   hsd.min_got_dynindx = elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount
2747     /* In the multi-got case, assigned_gotno of the master got_info
2748        indicate the number of entries that aren't referenced in the
2749        primary GOT, but that must have entries because there are
2750        dynamic relocations that reference it.  Since they aren't
2751        referenced, we move them to the end of the GOT, so that they
2752        don't prevent other entries that are referenced from getting
2753        too large offsets.  */
2754     - (g->next ? g->assigned_gotno : 0);
2755   hsd.max_non_got_dynindx = max_local;
2756   mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (((struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *)
2757 				elf_hash_table (info)),
2758 			       mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f,
2759 			       &hsd);
2760 
2761   /* There should have been enough room in the symbol table to
2762      accommodate both the GOT and non-GOT symbols.  */
2763   BFD_ASSERT (hsd.max_non_got_dynindx <= hsd.min_got_dynindx);
2764   BFD_ASSERT ((unsigned long)hsd.max_unref_got_dynindx
2765 	      <= elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount);
2766 
2767   /* Now we know which dynamic symbol has the lowest dynamic symbol
2768      table index in the GOT.  */
2769   g->global_gotsym = hsd.low;
2770 
2771   return TRUE;
2772 }
2773 
2774 /* If H needs a GOT entry, assign it the highest available dynamic
2775    index.  Otherwise, assign it the lowest available dynamic
2776    index.  */
2777 
2778 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f(struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,void * data)2779 mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
2780 {
2781   struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data *hsd = data;
2782 
2783   if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2784     h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
2785 
2786   /* Symbols without dynamic symbol table entries aren't interesting
2787      at all.  */
2788   if (h->root.dynindx == -1)
2789     return TRUE;
2790 
2791   /* Global symbols that need GOT entries that are not explicitly
2792      referenced are marked with got offset 2.  Those that are
2793      referenced get a 1, and those that don't need GOT entries get
2794      -1.  */
2795   if (h->root.got.offset == 2)
2796     {
2797       BFD_ASSERT (h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL);
2798 
2799       if (hsd->max_unref_got_dynindx == hsd->min_got_dynindx)
2800 	hsd->low = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2801       h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_unref_got_dynindx++;
2802     }
2803   else if (h->root.got.offset != 1)
2804     h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_non_got_dynindx++;
2805   else
2806     {
2807       BFD_ASSERT (h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL);
2808 
2809       h->root.dynindx = --hsd->min_got_dynindx;
2810       hsd->low = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2811     }
2812 
2813   return TRUE;
2814 }
2815 
2816 /* If H is a symbol that needs a global GOT entry, but has a dynamic
2817    symbol table index lower than any we've seen to date, record it for
2818    posterity.  */
2819 
2820 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol(struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,struct mips_got_info * g,unsigned char tls_flag)2821 mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2822 				   bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2823 				   struct mips_got_info *g,
2824 				   unsigned char tls_flag)
2825 {
2826   struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
2827 
2828   /* A global symbol in the GOT must also be in the dynamic symbol
2829      table.  */
2830   if (h->dynindx == -1)
2831     {
2832       switch (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other))
2833 	{
2834 	case STV_INTERNAL:
2835 	case STV_HIDDEN:
2836 	  _bfd_mips_elf_hide_symbol (info, h, TRUE);
2837 	  break;
2838 	}
2839       if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
2840 	return FALSE;
2841     }
2842 
2843   /* Make sure we have a GOT to put this entry into.  */
2844   BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
2845 
2846   entry.abfd = abfd;
2847   entry.symndx = -1;
2848   entry.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2849   entry.tls_type = 0;
2850 
2851   loc = (struct mips_got_entry **) htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry,
2852 						   INSERT);
2853 
2854   /* If we've already marked this entry as needing GOT space, we don't
2855      need to do it again.  */
2856   if (*loc)
2857     {
2858       (*loc)->tls_type |= tls_flag;
2859       return TRUE;
2860     }
2861 
2862   *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
2863 
2864   if (! *loc)
2865     return FALSE;
2866 
2867   entry.gotidx = -1;
2868   entry.tls_type = tls_flag;
2869 
2870   memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
2871 
2872   if (h->got.offset != MINUS_ONE)
2873     return TRUE;
2874 
2875   /* By setting this to a value other than -1, we are indicating that
2876      there needs to be a GOT entry for H.  Avoid using zero, as the
2877      generic ELF copy_indirect_symbol tests for <= 0.  */
2878   if (tls_flag == 0)
2879     h->got.offset = 1;
2880 
2881   return TRUE;
2882 }
2883 
2884 /* Reserve space in G for a GOT entry containing the value of symbol
2885    SYMNDX in input bfd ABDF, plus ADDEND.  */
2886 
2887 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol(bfd * abfd,long symndx,bfd_vma addend,struct mips_got_info * g,unsigned char tls_flag)2888 mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (bfd *abfd, long symndx, bfd_vma addend,
2889 				  struct mips_got_info *g,
2890 				  unsigned char tls_flag)
2891 {
2892   struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
2893 
2894   entry.abfd = abfd;
2895   entry.symndx = symndx;
2896   entry.d.addend = addend;
2897   entry.tls_type = tls_flag;
2898   loc = (struct mips_got_entry **)
2899     htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry, INSERT);
2900 
2901   if (*loc)
2902     {
2903       if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_GD && !((*loc)->tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD))
2904 	{
2905 	  g->tls_gotno += 2;
2906 	  (*loc)->tls_type |= tls_flag;
2907 	}
2908       else if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_IE && !((*loc)->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE))
2909 	{
2910 	  g->tls_gotno += 1;
2911 	  (*loc)->tls_type |= tls_flag;
2912 	}
2913       return TRUE;
2914     }
2915 
2916   if (tls_flag != 0)
2917     {
2918       entry.gotidx = -1;
2919       entry.tls_type = tls_flag;
2920       if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_IE)
2921 	g->tls_gotno += 1;
2922       else if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_GD)
2923 	g->tls_gotno += 2;
2924       else if (g->tls_ldm_offset == MINUS_ONE)
2925 	{
2926 	  g->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_TWO;
2927 	  g->tls_gotno += 2;
2928 	}
2929     }
2930   else
2931     {
2932       entry.gotidx = g->local_gotno++;
2933       entry.tls_type = 0;
2934     }
2935 
2936   *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
2937 
2938   if (! *loc)
2939     return FALSE;
2940 
2941   memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
2942 
2943   return TRUE;
2944 }
2945 
2946 /* Compute the hash value of the bfd in a bfd2got hash entry.  */
2947 
2948 static hashval_t
mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash(const void * entry_)2949 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
2950 {
2951   const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *entry
2952     = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry_;
2953 
2954   return entry->bfd->id;
2955 }
2956 
2957 /* Check whether two hash entries have the same bfd.  */
2958 
2959 static int
mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq(const void * entry1,const void * entry2)2960 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
2961 {
2962   const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *e1
2963     = (const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry1;
2964   const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *e2
2965     = (const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry2;
2966 
2967   return e1->bfd == e2->bfd;
2968 }
2969 
2970 /* In a multi-got link, determine the GOT to be used for IBFD.  G must
2971    be the master GOT data.  */
2972 
2973 static struct mips_got_info *
mips_elf_got_for_ibfd(struct mips_got_info * g,bfd * ibfd)2974 mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (struct mips_got_info *g, bfd *ibfd)
2975 {
2976   struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash e, *p;
2977 
2978   if (! g->bfd2got)
2979     return g;
2980 
2981   e.bfd = ibfd;
2982   p = htab_find (g->bfd2got, &e);
2983   return p ? p->g : NULL;
2984 }
2985 
2986 /* Create one separate got for each bfd that has entries in the global
2987    got, such that we can tell how many local and global entries each
2988    bfd requires.  */
2989 
2990 static int
mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd(void ** entryp,void * p)2991 mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd (void **entryp, void *p)
2992 {
2993   struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
2994   struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg = (struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *)p;
2995   htab_t bfd2got = arg->bfd2got;
2996   struct mips_got_info *g;
2997   struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash bfdgot_entry, *bfdgot;
2998   void **bfdgotp;
2999 
3000   /* Find the got_info for this GOT entry's input bfd.  Create one if
3001      none exists.  */
3002   bfdgot_entry.bfd = entry->abfd;
3003   bfdgotp = htab_find_slot (bfd2got, &bfdgot_entry, INSERT);
3004   bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)*bfdgotp;
3005 
3006   if (bfdgot != NULL)
3007     g = bfdgot->g;
3008   else
3009     {
3010       bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)bfd_alloc
3011 	(arg->obfd, sizeof (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash));
3012 
3013       if (bfdgot == NULL)
3014 	{
3015 	  arg->obfd = 0;
3016 	  return 0;
3017 	}
3018 
3019       *bfdgotp = bfdgot;
3020 
3021       bfdgot->bfd = entry->abfd;
3022       bfdgot->g = g = (struct mips_got_info *)
3023 	bfd_alloc (arg->obfd, sizeof (struct mips_got_info));
3024       if (g == NULL)
3025 	{
3026 	  arg->obfd = 0;
3027 	  return 0;
3028 	}
3029 
3030       g->global_gotsym = NULL;
3031       g->global_gotno = 0;
3032       g->local_gotno = 0;
3033       g->assigned_gotno = -1;
3034       g->tls_gotno = 0;
3035       g->tls_assigned_gotno = 0;
3036       g->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_ONE;
3037       g->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash,
3038 					mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq, NULL);
3039       if (g->got_entries == NULL)
3040 	{
3041 	  arg->obfd = 0;
3042 	  return 0;
3043 	}
3044 
3045       g->bfd2got = NULL;
3046       g->next = NULL;
3047     }
3048 
3049   /* Insert the GOT entry in the bfd's got entry hash table.  */
3050   entryp = htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, entry, INSERT);
3051   if (*entryp != NULL)
3052     return 1;
3053 
3054   *entryp = entry;
3055 
3056   if (entry->tls_type)
3057     {
3058       if (entry->tls_type & (GOT_TLS_GD | GOT_TLS_LDM))
3059 	g->tls_gotno += 2;
3060       if (entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
3061 	g->tls_gotno += 1;
3062     }
3063   else if (entry->symndx >= 0 || entry->d.h->forced_local)
3064     ++g->local_gotno;
3065   else
3066     ++g->global_gotno;
3067 
3068   return 1;
3069 }
3070 
3071 /* Attempt to merge gots of different input bfds.  Try to use as much
3072    as possible of the primary got, since it doesn't require explicit
3073    dynamic relocations, but don't use bfds that would reference global
3074    symbols out of the addressable range.  Failing the primary got,
3075    attempt to merge with the current got, or finish the current got
3076    and then make make the new got current.  */
3077 
3078 static int
mips_elf_merge_gots(void ** bfd2got_,void * p)3079 mips_elf_merge_gots (void **bfd2got_, void *p)
3080 {
3081   struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *bfd2got
3082     = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)*bfd2got_;
3083   struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg = (struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *)p;
3084   unsigned int lcount = bfd2got->g->local_gotno;
3085   unsigned int gcount = bfd2got->g->global_gotno;
3086   unsigned int tcount = bfd2got->g->tls_gotno;
3087   unsigned int maxcnt = arg->max_count;
3088   bfd_boolean too_many_for_tls = FALSE;
3089 
3090   /* We place TLS GOT entries after both locals and globals.  The globals
3091      for the primary GOT may overflow the normal GOT size limit, so be
3092      sure not to merge a GOT which requires TLS with the primary GOT in that
3093      case.  This doesn't affect non-primary GOTs.  */
3094   if (tcount > 0)
3095     {
3096       unsigned int primary_total = lcount + tcount + arg->global_count;
3097       if (primary_total > maxcnt)
3098 	too_many_for_tls = TRUE;
3099     }
3100 
3101   /* If we don't have a primary GOT and this is not too big, use it as
3102      a starting point for the primary GOT.  */
3103   if (! arg->primary && lcount + gcount + tcount <= maxcnt
3104       && ! too_many_for_tls)
3105     {
3106       arg->primary = bfd2got->g;
3107       arg->primary_count = lcount + gcount;
3108     }
3109   /* If it looks like we can merge this bfd's entries with those of
3110      the primary, merge them.  The heuristics is conservative, but we
3111      don't have to squeeze it too hard.  */
3112   else if (arg->primary && ! too_many_for_tls
3113 	   && (arg->primary_count + lcount + gcount + tcount) <= maxcnt)
3114     {
3115       struct mips_got_info *g = bfd2got->g;
3116       int old_lcount = arg->primary->local_gotno;
3117       int old_gcount = arg->primary->global_gotno;
3118       int old_tcount = arg->primary->tls_gotno;
3119 
3120       bfd2got->g = arg->primary;
3121 
3122       htab_traverse (g->got_entries,
3123 		     mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd,
3124 		     arg);
3125       if (arg->obfd == NULL)
3126 	return 0;
3127 
3128       htab_delete (g->got_entries);
3129       /* We don't have to worry about releasing memory of the actual
3130 	 got entries, since they're all in the master got_entries hash
3131 	 table anyway.  */
3132 
3133       BFD_ASSERT (old_lcount + lcount >= arg->primary->local_gotno);
3134       BFD_ASSERT (old_gcount + gcount >= arg->primary->global_gotno);
3135       BFD_ASSERT (old_tcount + tcount >= arg->primary->tls_gotno);
3136 
3137       arg->primary_count = arg->primary->local_gotno
3138 	+ arg->primary->global_gotno + arg->primary->tls_gotno;
3139     }
3140   /* If we can merge with the last-created got, do it.  */
3141   else if (arg->current
3142 	   && arg->current_count + lcount + gcount + tcount <= maxcnt)
3143     {
3144       struct mips_got_info *g = bfd2got->g;
3145       int old_lcount = arg->current->local_gotno;
3146       int old_gcount = arg->current->global_gotno;
3147       int old_tcount = arg->current->tls_gotno;
3148 
3149       bfd2got->g = arg->current;
3150 
3151       htab_traverse (g->got_entries,
3152 		     mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd,
3153 		     arg);
3154       if (arg->obfd == NULL)
3155 	return 0;
3156 
3157       htab_delete (g->got_entries);
3158 
3159       BFD_ASSERT (old_lcount + lcount >= arg->current->local_gotno);
3160       BFD_ASSERT (old_gcount + gcount >= arg->current->global_gotno);
3161       BFD_ASSERT (old_tcount + tcount >= arg->current->tls_gotno);
3162 
3163       arg->current_count = arg->current->local_gotno
3164 	+ arg->current->global_gotno + arg->current->tls_gotno;
3165     }
3166   /* Well, we couldn't merge, so create a new GOT.  Don't check if it
3167      fits; if it turns out that it doesn't, we'll get relocation
3168      overflows anyway.  */
3169   else
3170     {
3171       bfd2got->g->next = arg->current;
3172       arg->current = bfd2got->g;
3173 
3174       arg->current_count = lcount + gcount + 2 * tcount;
3175     }
3176 
3177   return 1;
3178 }
3179 
3180 /* Set the TLS GOT index for the GOT entry in ENTRYP.  ENTRYP's NEXT field
3181    is null iff there is just a single GOT.  */
3182 
3183 static int
mips_elf_initialize_tls_index(void ** entryp,void * p)3184 mips_elf_initialize_tls_index (void **entryp, void *p)
3185 {
3186   struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
3187   struct mips_got_info *g = p;
3188   bfd_vma next_index;
3189   unsigned char tls_type;
3190 
3191   /* We're only interested in TLS symbols.  */
3192   if (entry->tls_type == 0)
3193     return 1;
3194 
3195   next_index = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (entry->abfd) * (long) g->tls_assigned_gotno;
3196 
3197   if (entry->symndx == -1 && g->next == NULL)
3198     {
3199       /* A type (3) got entry in the single-GOT case.  We use the symbol's
3200 	 hash table entry to track its index.  */
3201       if (entry->d.h->tls_type & GOT_TLS_OFFSET_DONE)
3202 	return 1;
3203       entry->d.h->tls_type |= GOT_TLS_OFFSET_DONE;
3204       entry->d.h->tls_got_offset = next_index;
3205       tls_type = entry->d.h->tls_type;
3206     }
3207   else
3208     {
3209       if (entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
3210 	{
3211 	  /* There are separate mips_got_entry objects for each input bfd
3212 	     that requires an LDM entry.  Make sure that all LDM entries in
3213 	     a GOT resolve to the same index.  */
3214 	  if (g->tls_ldm_offset != MINUS_TWO && g->tls_ldm_offset != MINUS_ONE)
3215 	    {
3216 	      entry->gotidx = g->tls_ldm_offset;
3217 	      return 1;
3218 	    }
3219 	  g->tls_ldm_offset = next_index;
3220 	}
3221       entry->gotidx = next_index;
3222       tls_type = entry->tls_type;
3223     }
3224 
3225   /* Account for the entries we've just allocated.  */
3226   if (tls_type & (GOT_TLS_GD | GOT_TLS_LDM))
3227     g->tls_assigned_gotno += 2;
3228   if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
3229     g->tls_assigned_gotno += 1;
3230 
3231   return 1;
3232 }
3233 
3234 /* If passed a NULL mips_got_info in the argument, set the marker used
3235    to tell whether a global symbol needs a got entry (in the primary
3236    got) to the given VALUE.
3237 
3238    If passed a pointer G to a mips_got_info in the argument (it must
3239    not be the primary GOT), compute the offset from the beginning of
3240    the (primary) GOT section to the entry in G corresponding to the
3241    global symbol.  G's assigned_gotno must contain the index of the
3242    first available global GOT entry in G.  VALUE must contain the size
3243    of a GOT entry in bytes.  For each global GOT entry that requires a
3244    dynamic relocation, NEEDED_RELOCS is incremented, and the symbol is
3245    marked as not eligible for lazy resolution through a function
3246    stub.  */
3247 static int
mips_elf_set_global_got_offset(void ** entryp,void * p)3248 mips_elf_set_global_got_offset (void **entryp, void *p)
3249 {
3250   struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
3251   struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg *arg
3252     = (struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg *)p;
3253   struct mips_got_info *g = arg->g;
3254 
3255   if (g && entry->tls_type != GOT_NORMAL)
3256     arg->needed_relocs +=
3257       mips_tls_got_relocs (arg->info, entry->tls_type,
3258 			   entry->symndx == -1 ? &entry->d.h->root : NULL);
3259 
3260   if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx == -1
3261       && entry->d.h->root.dynindx != -1
3262       && entry->d.h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL)
3263     {
3264       if (g)
3265 	{
3266 	  BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotsym == NULL);
3267 
3268 	  entry->gotidx = arg->value * (long) g->assigned_gotno++;
3269 	  if (arg->info->shared
3270 	      || (elf_hash_table (arg->info)->dynamic_sections_created
3271 		  && entry->d.h->root.def_dynamic
3272 		  && !entry->d.h->root.def_regular))
3273 	    ++arg->needed_relocs;
3274 	}
3275       else
3276 	entry->d.h->root.got.offset = arg->value;
3277     }
3278 
3279   return 1;
3280 }
3281 
3282 /* Mark any global symbols referenced in the GOT we are iterating over
3283    as inelligible for lazy resolution stubs.  */
3284 static int
mips_elf_set_no_stub(void ** entryp,void * p ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)3285 mips_elf_set_no_stub (void **entryp, void *p ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3286 {
3287   struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
3288 
3289   if (entry->abfd != NULL
3290       && entry->symndx == -1
3291       && entry->d.h->root.dynindx != -1)
3292     entry->d.h->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
3293 
3294   return 1;
3295 }
3296 
3297 /* Follow indirect and warning hash entries so that each got entry
3298    points to the final symbol definition.  P must point to a pointer
3299    to the hash table we're traversing.  Since this traversal may
3300    modify the hash table, we set this pointer to NULL to indicate
3301    we've made a potentially-destructive change to the hash table, so
3302    the traversal must be restarted.  */
3303 static int
mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entry(void ** entryp,void * p)3304 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entry (void **entryp, void *p)
3305 {
3306   struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
3307   htab_t got_entries = *(htab_t *)p;
3308 
3309   if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx == -1)
3310     {
3311       struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h = entry->d.h;
3312 
3313       while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3314  	     || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3315 	h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
3316 
3317       if (entry->d.h == h)
3318 	return 1;
3319 
3320       entry->d.h = h;
3321 
3322       /* If we can't find this entry with the new bfd hash, re-insert
3323 	 it, and get the traversal restarted.  */
3324       if (! htab_find (got_entries, entry))
3325 	{
3326 	  htab_clear_slot (got_entries, entryp);
3327 	  entryp = htab_find_slot (got_entries, entry, INSERT);
3328 	  if (! *entryp)
3329 	    *entryp = entry;
3330 	  /* Abort the traversal, since the whole table may have
3331 	     moved, and leave it up to the parent to restart the
3332 	     process.  */
3333 	  *(htab_t *)p = NULL;
3334 	  return 0;
3335 	}
3336       /* We might want to decrement the global_gotno count, but it's
3337 	 either too early or too late for that at this point.  */
3338     }
3339 
3340   return 1;
3341 }
3342 
3343 /* Turn indirect got entries in a got_entries table into their final
3344    locations.  */
3345 static void
mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries(struct mips_got_info * g)3346 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (struct mips_got_info *g)
3347 {
3348   htab_t got_entries;
3349 
3350   do
3351     {
3352       got_entries = g->got_entries;
3353 
3354       htab_traverse (got_entries,
3355 		     mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entry,
3356 		     &got_entries);
3357     }
3358   while (got_entries == NULL);
3359 }
3360 
3361 /* Return the offset of an input bfd IBFD's GOT from the beginning of
3362    the primary GOT.  */
3363 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_adjust_gp(bfd * abfd,struct mips_got_info * g,bfd * ibfd)3364 mips_elf_adjust_gp (bfd *abfd, struct mips_got_info *g, bfd *ibfd)
3365 {
3366   if (g->bfd2got == NULL)
3367     return 0;
3368 
3369   g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (g, ibfd);
3370   if (! g)
3371     return 0;
3372 
3373   BFD_ASSERT (g->next);
3374 
3375   g = g->next;
3376 
3377   return (g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno + g->tls_gotno)
3378     * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
3379 }
3380 
3381 /* Turn a single GOT that is too big for 16-bit addressing into
3382    a sequence of GOTs, each one 16-bit addressable.  */
3383 
3384 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_multi_got(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,struct mips_got_info * g,asection * got,bfd_size_type pages)3385 mips_elf_multi_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3386 		    struct mips_got_info *g, asection *got,
3387 		    bfd_size_type pages)
3388 {
3389   struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg got_per_bfd_arg;
3390   struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg set_got_offset_arg;
3391   struct mips_got_info *gg;
3392   unsigned int assign;
3393 
3394   g->bfd2got = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash,
3395 				mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq, NULL);
3396   if (g->bfd2got == NULL)
3397     return FALSE;
3398 
3399   got_per_bfd_arg.bfd2got = g->bfd2got;
3400   got_per_bfd_arg.obfd = abfd;
3401   got_per_bfd_arg.info = info;
3402 
3403   /* Count how many GOT entries each input bfd requires, creating a
3404      map from bfd to got info while at that.  */
3405   htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd, &got_per_bfd_arg);
3406   if (got_per_bfd_arg.obfd == NULL)
3407     return FALSE;
3408 
3409   got_per_bfd_arg.current = NULL;
3410   got_per_bfd_arg.primary = NULL;
3411   /* Taking out PAGES entries is a worst-case estimate.  We could
3412      compute the maximum number of pages that each separate input bfd
3413      uses, but it's probably not worth it.  */
3414   got_per_bfd_arg.max_count = ((MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (info)
3415 				/ MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd))
3416 			       - MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info) - pages);
3417   /* The number of globals that will be included in the primary GOT.
3418      See the calls to mips_elf_set_global_got_offset below for more
3419      information.  */
3420   got_per_bfd_arg.global_count = g->global_gotno;
3421 
3422   /* Try to merge the GOTs of input bfds together, as long as they
3423      don't seem to exceed the maximum GOT size, choosing one of them
3424      to be the primary GOT.  */
3425   htab_traverse (g->bfd2got, mips_elf_merge_gots, &got_per_bfd_arg);
3426   if (got_per_bfd_arg.obfd == NULL)
3427     return FALSE;
3428 
3429   /* If we do not find any suitable primary GOT, create an empty one.  */
3430   if (got_per_bfd_arg.primary == NULL)
3431     {
3432       g->next = (struct mips_got_info *)
3433 	bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct mips_got_info));
3434       if (g->next == NULL)
3435 	return FALSE;
3436 
3437       g->next->global_gotsym = NULL;
3438       g->next->global_gotno = 0;
3439       g->next->local_gotno = 0;
3440       g->next->tls_gotno = 0;
3441       g->next->assigned_gotno = 0;
3442       g->next->tls_assigned_gotno = 0;
3443       g->next->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_ONE;
3444       g->next->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash,
3445 					      mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq,
3446 					      NULL);
3447       if (g->next->got_entries == NULL)
3448 	return FALSE;
3449       g->next->bfd2got = NULL;
3450     }
3451   else
3452     g->next = got_per_bfd_arg.primary;
3453   g->next->next = got_per_bfd_arg.current;
3454 
3455   /* GG is now the master GOT, and G is the primary GOT.  */
3456   gg = g;
3457   g = g->next;
3458 
3459   /* Map the output bfd to the primary got.  That's what we're going
3460      to use for bfds that use GOT16 or GOT_PAGE relocations that we
3461      didn't mark in check_relocs, and we want a quick way to find it.
3462      We can't just use gg->next because we're going to reverse the
3463      list.  */
3464   {
3465     struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *bfdgot;
3466     void **bfdgotp;
3467 
3468     bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)bfd_alloc
3469       (abfd, sizeof (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash));
3470 
3471     if (bfdgot == NULL)
3472       return FALSE;
3473 
3474     bfdgot->bfd = abfd;
3475     bfdgot->g = g;
3476     bfdgotp = htab_find_slot (gg->bfd2got, bfdgot, INSERT);
3477 
3478     BFD_ASSERT (*bfdgotp == NULL);
3479     *bfdgotp = bfdgot;
3480   }
3481 
3482   /* The IRIX dynamic linker requires every symbol that is referenced
3483      in a dynamic relocation to be present in the primary GOT, so
3484      arrange for them to appear after those that are actually
3485      referenced.
3486 
3487      GNU/Linux could very well do without it, but it would slow down
3488      the dynamic linker, since it would have to resolve every dynamic
3489      symbol referenced in other GOTs more than once, without help from
3490      the cache.  Also, knowing that every external symbol has a GOT
3491      helps speed up the resolution of local symbols too, so GNU/Linux
3492      follows IRIX's practice.
3493 
3494      The number 2 is used by mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f to count
3495      global GOT symbols that are unreferenced in the primary GOT, with
3496      an initial dynamic index computed from gg->assigned_gotno, where
3497      the number of unreferenced global entries in the primary GOT is
3498      preserved.  */
3499   if (1)
3500     {
3501       gg->assigned_gotno = gg->global_gotno - g->global_gotno;
3502       g->global_gotno = gg->global_gotno;
3503       set_got_offset_arg.value = 2;
3504     }
3505   else
3506     {
3507       /* This could be used for dynamic linkers that don't optimize
3508 	 symbol resolution while applying relocations so as to use
3509 	 primary GOT entries or assuming the symbol is locally-defined.
3510 	 With this code, we assign lower dynamic indices to global
3511 	 symbols that are not referenced in the primary GOT, so that
3512 	 their entries can be omitted.  */
3513       gg->assigned_gotno = 0;
3514       set_got_offset_arg.value = -1;
3515     }
3516 
3517   /* Reorder dynamic symbols as described above (which behavior
3518      depends on the setting of VALUE).  */
3519   set_got_offset_arg.g = NULL;
3520   htab_traverse (gg->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
3521 		 &set_got_offset_arg);
3522   set_got_offset_arg.value = 1;
3523   htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
3524 		 &set_got_offset_arg);
3525   if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, 1))
3526     return FALSE;
3527 
3528   /* Now go through the GOTs assigning them offset ranges.
3529      [assigned_gotno, local_gotno[ will be set to the range of local
3530      entries in each GOT.  We can then compute the end of a GOT by
3531      adding local_gotno to global_gotno.  We reverse the list and make
3532      it circular since then we'll be able to quickly compute the
3533      beginning of a GOT, by computing the end of its predecessor.  To
3534      avoid special cases for the primary GOT, while still preserving
3535      assertions that are valid for both single- and multi-got links,
3536      we arrange for the main got struct to have the right number of
3537      global entries, but set its local_gotno such that the initial
3538      offset of the primary GOT is zero.  Remember that the primary GOT
3539      will become the last item in the circular linked list, so it
3540      points back to the master GOT.  */
3541   gg->local_gotno = -g->global_gotno;
3542   gg->global_gotno = g->global_gotno;
3543   gg->tls_gotno = 0;
3544   assign = 0;
3545   gg->next = gg;
3546 
3547   do
3548     {
3549       struct mips_got_info *gn;
3550 
3551       assign += MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info);
3552       g->assigned_gotno = assign;
3553       g->local_gotno += assign + pages;
3554       assign = g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno + g->tls_gotno;
3555 
3556       /* Take g out of the direct list, and push it onto the reversed
3557 	 list that gg points to.  g->next is guaranteed to be nonnull after
3558 	 this operation, as required by mips_elf_initialize_tls_index. */
3559       gn = g->next;
3560       g->next = gg->next;
3561       gg->next = g;
3562 
3563       /* Set up any TLS entries.  We always place the TLS entries after
3564 	 all non-TLS entries.  */
3565       g->tls_assigned_gotno = g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno;
3566       htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_initialize_tls_index, g);
3567 
3568       /* Move onto the next GOT.  It will be a secondary GOT if nonull.  */
3569       g = gn;
3570 
3571       /* Mark global symbols in every non-primary GOT as ineligible for
3572 	 stubs.  */
3573       if (g)
3574 	htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_set_no_stub, NULL);
3575     }
3576   while (g);
3577 
3578   got->size = (gg->next->local_gotno
3579 		    + gg->next->global_gotno
3580 		    + gg->next->tls_gotno) * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
3581 
3582   return TRUE;
3583 }
3584 
3585 
3586 /* Returns the first relocation of type r_type found, beginning with
3587    RELOCATION.  RELEND is one-past-the-end of the relocation table.  */
3588 
3589 static const Elf_Internal_Rela *
mips_elf_next_relocation(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,unsigned int r_type,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocation,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relend)3590 mips_elf_next_relocation (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int r_type,
3591 			  const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
3592 			  const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend)
3593 {
3594   unsigned long r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocation->r_info);
3595 
3596   while (relocation < relend)
3597     {
3598       if (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, relocation->r_info) == r_type
3599 	  && ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocation->r_info) == r_symndx)
3600 	return relocation;
3601 
3602       ++relocation;
3603     }
3604 
3605   /* We didn't find it.  */
3606   return NULL;
3607 }
3608 
3609 /* Return whether a relocation is against a local symbol.  */
3610 
3611 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_local_relocation_p(bfd * input_bfd,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocation,asection ** local_sections,bfd_boolean check_forced)3612 mips_elf_local_relocation_p (bfd *input_bfd,
3613 			     const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
3614 			     asection **local_sections,
3615 			     bfd_boolean check_forced)
3616 {
3617   unsigned long r_symndx;
3618   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3619   struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3620   size_t extsymoff;
3621 
3622   r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
3623   symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
3624   extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3625 
3626   if (r_symndx < extsymoff)
3627     return TRUE;
3628   if (elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd) && local_sections[r_symndx] != NULL)
3629     return TRUE;
3630 
3631   if (check_forced)
3632     {
3633       /* Look up the hash table to check whether the symbol
3634  	 was forced local.  */
3635       h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
3636 	elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff];
3637       /* Find the real hash-table entry for this symbol.  */
3638       while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3639  	     || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3640 	h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
3641       if (h->root.forced_local)
3642 	return TRUE;
3643     }
3644 
3645   return FALSE;
3646 }
3647 
3648 /* Sign-extend VALUE, which has the indicated number of BITS.  */
3649 
3650 bfd_vma
_bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend(bfd_vma value,int bits)3651 _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (bfd_vma value, int bits)
3652 {
3653   if (value & ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bits - 1)))
3654     /* VALUE is negative.  */
3655     value |= ((bfd_vma) - 1) << bits;
3656 
3657   return value;
3658 }
3659 
3660 /* Return non-zero if the indicated VALUE has overflowed the maximum
3661    range expressible by a signed number with the indicated number of
3662    BITS.  */
3663 
3664 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_overflow_p(bfd_vma value,int bits)3665 mips_elf_overflow_p (bfd_vma value, int bits)
3666 {
3667   bfd_signed_vma svalue = (bfd_signed_vma) value;
3668 
3669   if (svalue > (1 << (bits - 1)) - 1)
3670     /* The value is too big.  */
3671     return TRUE;
3672   else if (svalue < -(1 << (bits - 1)))
3673     /* The value is too small.  */
3674     return TRUE;
3675 
3676   /* All is well.  */
3677   return FALSE;
3678 }
3679 
3680 /* Calculate the %high function.  */
3681 
3682 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_high(bfd_vma value)3683 mips_elf_high (bfd_vma value)
3684 {
3685   return ((value + (bfd_vma) 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
3686 }
3687 
3688 /* Calculate the %higher function.  */
3689 
3690 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_higher(bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)3691 mips_elf_higher (bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3692 {
3693 #ifdef BFD64
3694   return ((value + (bfd_vma) 0x80008000) >> 32) & 0xffff;
3695 #else
3696   abort ();
3697   return MINUS_ONE;
3698 #endif
3699 }
3700 
3701 /* Calculate the %highest function.  */
3702 
3703 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_highest(bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)3704 mips_elf_highest (bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3705 {
3706 #ifdef BFD64
3707   return ((value + (((bfd_vma) 0x8000 << 32) | 0x80008000)) >> 48) & 0xffff;
3708 #else
3709   abort ();
3710   return MINUS_ONE;
3711 #endif
3712 }
3713 
3714 /* Create the .compact_rel section.  */
3715 
3716 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)3717 mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section
3718   (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3719 {
3720   flagword flags;
3721   register asection *s;
3722 
3723   if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".compact_rel") == NULL)
3724     {
3725       flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED
3726 	       | SEC_READONLY);
3727 
3728       s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".compact_rel", flags);
3729       if (s == NULL
3730 	  || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
3731 					  MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
3732 	return FALSE;
3733 
3734       s->size = sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel);
3735     }
3736 
3737   return TRUE;
3738 }
3739 
3740 /* Create the .got section to hold the global offset table.  */
3741 
3742 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_create_got_section(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd_boolean maybe_exclude)3743 mips_elf_create_got_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3744 			     bfd_boolean maybe_exclude)
3745 {
3746   flagword flags;
3747   register asection *s;
3748   struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3749   struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
3750   struct mips_got_info *g;
3751   bfd_size_type amt;
3752   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3753 
3754   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3755 
3756   /* This function may be called more than once.  */
3757   s = mips_elf_got_section (abfd, TRUE);
3758   if (s)
3759     {
3760       if (! maybe_exclude)
3761 	s->flags &= ~SEC_EXCLUDE;
3762       return TRUE;
3763     }
3764 
3765   flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
3766 	   | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3767 
3768   if (maybe_exclude)
3769     flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
3770 
3771   /* We have to use an alignment of 2**4 here because this is hardcoded
3772      in the function stub generation and in the linker script.  */
3773   s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".got", flags);
3774   if (s == NULL
3775       || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 4))
3776     return FALSE;
3777 
3778   /* Define the symbol _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_.  We don't do this in the
3779      linker script because we don't want to define the symbol if we
3780      are not creating a global offset table.  */
3781   bh = NULL;
3782   if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
3783 	 (info, abfd, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_", BSF_GLOBAL, s,
3784 	  0, NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
3785     return FALSE;
3786 
3787   h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
3788   h->non_elf = 0;
3789   h->def_regular = 1;
3790   h->type = STT_OBJECT;
3791   elf_hash_table (info)->hgot = h;
3792 
3793   if (info->shared
3794       && ! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
3795     return FALSE;
3796 
3797   amt = sizeof (struct mips_got_info);
3798   g = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
3799   if (g == NULL)
3800     return FALSE;
3801   g->global_gotsym = NULL;
3802   g->global_gotno = 0;
3803   g->tls_gotno = 0;
3804   g->local_gotno = MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info);
3805   g->assigned_gotno = MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info);
3806   g->bfd2got = NULL;
3807   g->next = NULL;
3808   g->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_ONE;
3809   g->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_got_entry_hash,
3810 				    mips_elf_got_entry_eq, NULL);
3811   if (g->got_entries == NULL)
3812     return FALSE;
3813   mips_elf_section_data (s)->u.got_info = g;
3814   mips_elf_section_data (s)->elf.this_hdr.sh_flags
3815     |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
3816 
3817   /* VxWorks also needs a .got.plt section.  */
3818   if (htab->is_vxworks)
3819     {
3820       s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".got.plt",
3821 				       SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
3822 				       | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3823       if (s == NULL || !bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 4))
3824 	return FALSE;
3825 
3826       htab->sgotplt = s;
3827     }
3828   return TRUE;
3829 }
3830 
3831 /* Return true if H refers to the special VxWorks __GOTT_BASE__ or
3832    __GOTT_INDEX__ symbols.  These symbols are only special for
3833    shared objects; they are not used in executables.  */
3834 
3835 static bfd_boolean
is_gott_symbol(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)3836 is_gott_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
3837 {
3838   return (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->is_vxworks
3839 	  && info->shared
3840 	  && (strcmp (h->root.root.string, "__GOTT_BASE__") == 0
3841 	      || strcmp (h->root.root.string, "__GOTT_INDEX__") == 0));
3842 }
3843 
3844 /* Calculate the value produced by the RELOCATION (which comes from
3845    the INPUT_BFD).  The ADDEND is the addend to use for this
3846    RELOCATION; RELOCATION->R_ADDEND is ignored.
3847 
3848    The result of the relocation calculation is stored in VALUEP.
3849    REQUIRE_JALXP indicates whether or not the opcode used with this
3850    relocation must be JALX.
3851 
3852    This function returns bfd_reloc_continue if the caller need take no
3853    further action regarding this relocation, bfd_reloc_notsupported if
3854    something goes dramatically wrong, bfd_reloc_overflow if an
3855    overflow occurs, and bfd_reloc_ok to indicate success.  */
3856 
3857 static bfd_reloc_status_type
mips_elf_calculate_relocation(bfd * abfd,bfd * input_bfd,asection * input_section,struct bfd_link_info * info,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocation,bfd_vma addend,reloc_howto_type * howto,Elf_Internal_Sym * local_syms,asection ** local_sections,bfd_vma * valuep,const char ** namep,bfd_boolean * require_jalxp,bfd_boolean save_addend)3858 mips_elf_calculate_relocation (bfd *abfd, bfd *input_bfd,
3859 			       asection *input_section,
3860 			       struct bfd_link_info *info,
3861 			       const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
3862 			       bfd_vma addend, reloc_howto_type *howto,
3863 			       Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
3864 			       asection **local_sections, bfd_vma *valuep,
3865 			       const char **namep, bfd_boolean *require_jalxp,
3866 			       bfd_boolean save_addend)
3867 {
3868   /* The eventual value we will return.  */
3869   bfd_vma value;
3870   /* The address of the symbol against which the relocation is
3871      occurring.  */
3872   bfd_vma symbol = 0;
3873   /* The final GP value to be used for the relocatable, executable, or
3874      shared object file being produced.  */
3875   bfd_vma gp = MINUS_ONE;
3876   /* The place (section offset or address) of the storage unit being
3877      relocated.  */
3878   bfd_vma p;
3879   /* The value of GP used to create the relocatable object.  */
3880   bfd_vma gp0 = MINUS_ONE;
3881   /* The offset into the global offset table at which the address of
3882      the relocation entry symbol, adjusted by the addend, resides
3883      during execution.  */
3884   bfd_vma g = MINUS_ONE;
3885   /* The section in which the symbol referenced by the relocation is
3886      located.  */
3887   asection *sec = NULL;
3888   struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
3889   /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is a local
3890      symbol.  */
3891   bfd_boolean local_p, was_local_p;
3892   /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is "_gp_disp".  */
3893   bfd_boolean gp_disp_p = FALSE;
3894   /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is
3895      "__gnu_local_gp".  */
3896   bfd_boolean gnu_local_gp_p = FALSE;
3897   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3898   size_t extsymoff;
3899   unsigned long r_symndx;
3900   int r_type;
3901   /* TRUE if overflow occurred during the calculation of the
3902      relocation value.  */
3903   bfd_boolean overflowed_p;
3904   /* TRUE if this relocation refers to a MIPS16 function.  */
3905   bfd_boolean target_is_16_bit_code_p = FALSE;
3906   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3907   bfd *dynobj;
3908 
3909   dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
3910   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3911 
3912   /* Parse the relocation.  */
3913   r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
3914   r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
3915   p = (input_section->output_section->vma
3916        + input_section->output_offset
3917        + relocation->r_offset);
3918 
3919   /* Assume that there will be no overflow.  */
3920   overflowed_p = FALSE;
3921 
3922   /* Figure out whether or not the symbol is local, and get the offset
3923      used in the array of hash table entries.  */
3924   symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
3925   local_p = mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
3926 					 local_sections, FALSE);
3927   was_local_p = local_p;
3928   if (! elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd))
3929     extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3930   else
3931     {
3932       /* The symbol table does not follow the rule that local symbols
3933 	 must come before globals.  */
3934       extsymoff = 0;
3935     }
3936 
3937   /* Figure out the value of the symbol.  */
3938   if (local_p)
3939     {
3940       Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
3941 
3942       sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
3943       sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
3944 
3945       symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
3946       if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) != STT_SECTION
3947 	  || (sec->flags & SEC_MERGE))
3948 	symbol += sym->st_value;
3949       if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
3950 	  && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
3951 	{
3952 	  addend = _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (abfd, sym, &sec, addend);
3953 	  addend -= symbol;
3954 	  addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
3955 	}
3956 
3957       /* MIPS16 text labels should be treated as odd.  */
3958       if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
3959 	++symbol;
3960 
3961       /* Record the name of this symbol, for our caller.  */
3962       *namep = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (input_bfd,
3963 						symtab_hdr->sh_link,
3964 						sym->st_name);
3965       if (*namep == '\0')
3966 	*namep = bfd_section_name (input_bfd, sec);
3967 
3968       target_is_16_bit_code_p = (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16);
3969     }
3970   else
3971     {
3972       /* ??? Could we use RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL here ?  */
3973 
3974       /* For global symbols we look up the symbol in the hash-table.  */
3975       h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
3976 	   elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff]);
3977       /* Find the real hash-table entry for this symbol.  */
3978       while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3979 	     || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3980 	h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
3981 
3982       /* Record the name of this symbol, for our caller.  */
3983       *namep = h->root.root.root.string;
3984 
3985       /* See if this is the special _gp_disp symbol.  Note that such a
3986 	 symbol must always be a global symbol.  */
3987       if (strcmp (*namep, "_gp_disp") == 0
3988 	  && ! NEWABI_P (input_bfd))
3989 	{
3990 	  /* Relocations against _gp_disp are permitted only with
3991 	     R_MIPS_HI16 and R_MIPS_LO16 relocations.  */
3992 	  if (r_type != R_MIPS_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS_LO16
3993 	      && r_type != R_MIPS16_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS16_LO16)
3994 	    return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
3995 
3996 	  gp_disp_p = TRUE;
3997 	}
3998       /* See if this is the special _gp symbol.  Note that such a
3999 	 symbol must always be a global symbol.  */
4000       else if (strcmp (*namep, "__gnu_local_gp") == 0)
4001 	gnu_local_gp_p = TRUE;
4002 
4003 
4004       /* If this symbol is defined, calculate its address.  Note that
4005 	 _gp_disp is a magic symbol, always implicitly defined by the
4006 	 linker, so it's inappropriate to check to see whether or not
4007 	 its defined.  */
4008       else if ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4009 		|| h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4010 	       && h->root.root.u.def.section)
4011 	{
4012 	  sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
4013 	  if (sec->output_section)
4014 	    symbol = (h->root.root.u.def.value
4015 		      + sec->output_section->vma
4016 		      + sec->output_offset);
4017 	  else
4018 	    symbol = h->root.root.u.def.value;
4019 	}
4020       else if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
4021 	/* We allow relocations against undefined weak symbols, giving
4022 	   it the value zero, so that you can undefined weak functions
4023 	   and check to see if they exist by looking at their
4024 	   addresses.  */
4025 	symbol = 0;
4026       else if (info->unresolved_syms_in_objects == RM_IGNORE
4027 	       && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT)
4028 	symbol = 0;
4029       else if (strcmp (*namep, SGI_COMPAT (input_bfd)
4030 		       ? "_DYNAMIC_LINK" : "_DYNAMIC_LINKING") == 0)
4031 	{
4032 	  /* If this is a dynamic link, we should have created a
4033 	     _DYNAMIC_LINK symbol or _DYNAMIC_LINKING(for normal mips) symbol
4034 	     in in _bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections.
4035 	     Otherwise, we should define the symbol with a value of 0.
4036 	     FIXME: It should probably get into the symbol table
4037 	     somehow as well.  */
4038 	  BFD_ASSERT (! info->shared);
4039 	  BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") == NULL);
4040 	  symbol = 0;
4041 	}
4042       else if (ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (h->root.other))
4043 	{
4044 	  /* This is an optional symbol - an Irix specific extension to the
4045 	     ELF spec.  Ignore it for now.
4046 	     XXX - FIXME - there is more to the spec for OPTIONAL symbols
4047 	     than simply ignoring them, but we do not handle this for now.
4048 	     For information see the "64-bit ELF Object File Specification"
4049 	     which is available from here:
4050 	     http://techpubs.sgi.com/library/manuals/4000/007-4658-001/pdf/007-4658-001.pdf  */
4051 	  symbol = 0;
4052 	}
4053       else
4054 	{
4055 	  if (! ((*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol)
4056 		 (info, h->root.root.root.string, input_bfd,
4057 		  input_section, relocation->r_offset,
4058 		  (info->unresolved_syms_in_objects == RM_GENERATE_ERROR)
4059 		   || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other))))
4060 	    return bfd_reloc_undefined;
4061 	  symbol = 0;
4062 	}
4063 
4064       target_is_16_bit_code_p = (h->root.other == STO_MIPS16);
4065     }
4066 
4067   /* If this is a 32- or 64-bit call to a 16-bit function with a stub, we
4068      need to redirect the call to the stub, unless we're already *in*
4069      a stub.  */
4070   if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26 && !info->relocatable
4071       && ((h != NULL && h->fn_stub != NULL)
4072 	  || (local_p
4073 	      && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs != NULL
4074 	      && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx] != NULL))
4075       && !mips16_stub_section_p (input_bfd, input_section))
4076     {
4077       /* This is a 32- or 64-bit call to a 16-bit function.  We should
4078 	 have already noticed that we were going to need the
4079 	 stub.  */
4080       if (local_p)
4081 	sec = elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx];
4082       else
4083 	{
4084 	  BFD_ASSERT (h->need_fn_stub);
4085 	  sec = h->fn_stub;
4086 	}
4087 
4088       symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
4089       /* The target is 16-bit, but the stub isn't.  */
4090       target_is_16_bit_code_p = FALSE;
4091     }
4092   /* If this is a 16-bit call to a 32- or 64-bit function with a stub, we
4093      need to redirect the call to the stub.  */
4094   else if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26 && !info->relocatable
4095 	   && ((h != NULL && (h->call_stub != NULL || h->call_fp_stub != NULL))
4096 	       || (local_p
4097 		   && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_call_stubs != NULL
4098 		   && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_call_stubs[r_symndx] != NULL))
4099 	   && !target_is_16_bit_code_p)
4100     {
4101       if (local_p)
4102 	sec = elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_call_stubs[r_symndx];
4103       else
4104 	{
4105 	  /* If both call_stub and call_fp_stub are defined, we can figure
4106 	     out which one to use by checking which one appears in the input
4107 	     file.  */
4108 	  if (h->call_stub != NULL && h->call_fp_stub != NULL)
4109 	    {
4110 	      asection *o;
4111 
4112 	      sec = NULL;
4113 	      for (o = input_bfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
4114 		{
4115 		  if (CALL_FP_STUB_P (bfd_get_section_name (input_bfd, o)))
4116 		    {
4117 		      sec = h->call_fp_stub;
4118 		      break;
4119 		    }
4120 		}
4121 	      if (sec == NULL)
4122 		sec = h->call_stub;
4123 	    }
4124 	  else if (h->call_stub != NULL)
4125 	    sec = h->call_stub;
4126 	  else
4127 	    sec = h->call_fp_stub;
4128   	}
4129 
4130       BFD_ASSERT (sec->size > 0);
4131       symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
4132     }
4133 
4134   /* Calls from 16-bit code to 32-bit code and vice versa require the
4135      special jalx instruction.  */
4136   *require_jalxp = (!info->relocatable
4137                     && (((r_type == R_MIPS16_26) && !target_is_16_bit_code_p)
4138                         || ((r_type == R_MIPS_26) && target_is_16_bit_code_p)));
4139 
4140   local_p = mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
4141 					 local_sections, TRUE);
4142 
4143   /* If we haven't already determined the GOT offset, or the GP value,
4144      and we're going to need it, get it now.  */
4145   switch (r_type)
4146     {
4147     case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
4148     case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
4149       /* We need to decay to GOT_DISP/addend if the symbol doesn't
4150 	 bind locally.  */
4151       local_p = local_p || _bfd_elf_symbol_refs_local_p (&h->root, info, 1);
4152       if (local_p || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_OFST)
4153 	break;
4154       /* Fall through.  */
4155 
4156     case R_MIPS_CALL16:
4157     case R_MIPS_GOT16:
4158     case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
4159     case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
4160     case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
4161     case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
4162     case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
4163     case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
4164     case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
4165     case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
4166       /* Find the index into the GOT where this value is located.  */
4167       if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
4168 	{
4169 	  g = mips_elf_local_got_index (abfd, input_bfd, info,
4170 					0, 0, NULL, r_type);
4171 	  if (g == MINUS_ONE)
4172 	    return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
4173 	}
4174       else if (!local_p)
4175 	{
4176 	  /* On VxWorks, CALL relocations should refer to the .got.plt
4177 	     entry, which is initialized to point at the PLT stub.  */
4178 	  if (htab->is_vxworks
4179 	      && (r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_HI16
4180 		  || r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_LO16
4181 		  || r_type == R_MIPS_CALL16))
4182 	    {
4183 	      BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0);
4184 	      BFD_ASSERT (h->root.needs_plt);
4185 	      g = mips_elf_gotplt_index (info, &h->root);
4186 	    }
4187 	  else
4188 	    {
4189 	      /* GOT_PAGE may take a non-zero addend, that is ignored in a
4190 		 GOT_PAGE relocation that decays to GOT_DISP because the
4191 		 symbol turns out to be global.  The addend is then added
4192 		 as GOT_OFST.  */
4193 	      BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE);
4194 	      g = mips_elf_global_got_index (dynobj, input_bfd,
4195 					     &h->root, r_type, info);
4196 	      if (h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL
4197 		  && (! elf_hash_table(info)->dynamic_sections_created
4198 		      || (info->shared
4199 			  && (info->symbolic || h->root.forced_local)
4200 			  && h->root.def_regular)))
4201 		{
4202 		  /* This is a static link or a -Bsymbolic link.  The
4203 		     symbol is defined locally, or was forced to be local.
4204 		     We must initialize this entry in the GOT.  */
4205 		  asection *sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
4206 		  MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (dynobj, symbol, sgot->contents + g);
4207 		}
4208 	    }
4209 	}
4210       else if (!htab->is_vxworks
4211 	       && (r_type == R_MIPS_CALL16 || (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16)))
4212 	/* The calculation below does not involve "g".  */
4213 	break;
4214       else
4215 	{
4216 	  g = mips_elf_local_got_index (abfd, input_bfd, info,
4217 					symbol + addend, r_symndx, h, r_type);
4218 	  if (g == MINUS_ONE)
4219 	    return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
4220 	}
4221 
4222       /* Convert GOT indices to actual offsets.  */
4223       g = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (dynobj, abfd, input_bfd, g);
4224       break;
4225 
4226     case R_MIPS_HI16:
4227     case R_MIPS_LO16:
4228     case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
4229     case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
4230     case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
4231     case R_MIPS16_HI16:
4232     case R_MIPS16_LO16:
4233     case R_MIPS16_GPREL:
4234       gp0 = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_bfd);
4235       gp = _bfd_get_gp_value (abfd);
4236       if (dynobj)
4237 	gp += mips_elf_adjust_gp (abfd, mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL),
4238 				  input_bfd);
4239       break;
4240 
4241     default:
4242       break;
4243     }
4244 
4245   if (gnu_local_gp_p)
4246     symbol = gp;
4247 
4248   /* Relocations against the VxWorks __GOTT_BASE__ and __GOTT_INDEX__
4249      symbols are resolved by the loader.  Add them to .rela.dyn.  */
4250   if (h != NULL && is_gott_symbol (info, &h->root))
4251     {
4252       Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
4253       bfd_byte *loc;
4254       asection *s;
4255 
4256       s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
4257       loc = s->contents + s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
4258 
4259       outrel.r_offset = (input_section->output_section->vma
4260 			 + input_section->output_offset
4261 			 + relocation->r_offset);
4262       outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->root.dynindx, r_type);
4263       outrel.r_addend = addend;
4264       bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (abfd, &outrel, loc);
4265 
4266       /* If we've written this relocation for a readonly section,
4267 	 we need to set DF_TEXTREL again, so that we do not delete the
4268 	 DT_TEXTREL tag.  */
4269       if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (input_section))
4270 	info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
4271 
4272       *valuep = 0;
4273       return bfd_reloc_ok;
4274     }
4275 
4276   /* Figure out what kind of relocation is being performed.  */
4277   switch (r_type)
4278     {
4279     case R_MIPS_NONE:
4280       return bfd_reloc_continue;
4281 
4282     case R_MIPS_16:
4283       value = symbol + _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16);
4284       overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4285       break;
4286 
4287     case R_MIPS_32:
4288     case R_MIPS_REL32:
4289     case R_MIPS_64:
4290       if ((info->shared
4291 	   || (!htab->is_vxworks
4292 	       && htab->root.dynamic_sections_created
4293 	       && h != NULL
4294 	       && h->root.def_dynamic
4295 	       && !h->root.def_regular))
4296 	  && r_symndx != 0
4297 	  && (input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
4298 	{
4299 	  /* If we're creating a shared library, or this relocation is
4300 	     against a symbol in a shared library, then we can't know
4301 	     where the symbol will end up.  So, we create a relocation
4302 	     record in the output, and leave the job up to the dynamic
4303 	     linker.
4304 
4305 	     In VxWorks executables, references to external symbols
4306 	     are handled using copy relocs or PLT stubs, so there's
4307 	     no need to add a dynamic relocation here.  */
4308 	  value = addend;
4309 	  if (!mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation (abfd,
4310 						   info,
4311 						   relocation,
4312 						   h,
4313 						   sec,
4314 						   symbol,
4315 						   &value,
4316 						   input_section))
4317 	    return bfd_reloc_undefined;
4318 	}
4319       else
4320 	{
4321 	  if (r_type != R_MIPS_REL32)
4322 	    value = symbol + addend;
4323 	  else
4324 	    value = addend;
4325 	}
4326       value &= howto->dst_mask;
4327       break;
4328 
4329     case R_MIPS_PC32:
4330       value = symbol + addend - p;
4331       value &= howto->dst_mask;
4332       break;
4333 
4334     case R_MIPS16_26:
4335       /* The calculation for R_MIPS16_26 is just the same as for an
4336 	 R_MIPS_26.  It's only the storage of the relocated field into
4337 	 the output file that's different.  That's handled in
4338 	 mips_elf_perform_relocation.  So, we just fall through to the
4339 	 R_MIPS_26 case here.  */
4340     case R_MIPS_26:
4341       if (local_p)
4342 	value = ((addend | ((p + 4) & 0xf0000000)) + symbol) >> 2;
4343       else
4344 	{
4345 	  value = (_bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 28) + symbol) >> 2;
4346 	  if (h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
4347 	    overflowed_p = (value >> 26) != ((p + 4) >> 28);
4348 	}
4349       value &= howto->dst_mask;
4350       break;
4351 
4352     case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16:
4353       value = (mips_elf_high (addend + symbol - dtprel_base (info))
4354 	       & howto->dst_mask);
4355       break;
4356 
4357     case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16:
4358     case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32:
4359     case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64:
4360       value = (symbol + addend - dtprel_base (info)) & howto->dst_mask;
4361       break;
4362 
4363     case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
4364       value = (mips_elf_high (addend + symbol - tprel_base (info))
4365 	       & howto->dst_mask);
4366       break;
4367 
4368     case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
4369       value = (symbol + addend - tprel_base (info)) & howto->dst_mask;
4370       break;
4371 
4372     case R_MIPS_HI16:
4373     case R_MIPS16_HI16:
4374       if (!gp_disp_p)
4375 	{
4376 	  value = mips_elf_high (addend + symbol);
4377 	  value &= howto->dst_mask;
4378 	}
4379       else
4380 	{
4381 	  /* For MIPS16 ABI code we generate this sequence
4382 	        0: li      $v0,%hi(_gp_disp)
4383 	        4: addiupc $v1,%lo(_gp_disp)
4384 	        8: sll     $v0,16
4385 	       12: addu    $v0,$v1
4386 	       14: move    $gp,$v0
4387 	     So the offsets of hi and lo relocs are the same, but the
4388 	     $pc is four higher than $t9 would be, so reduce
4389 	     both reloc addends by 4. */
4390 	  if (r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16)
4391 	    value = mips_elf_high (addend + gp - p - 4);
4392 	  else
4393 	    value = mips_elf_high (addend + gp - p);
4394 	  overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4395 	}
4396       break;
4397 
4398     case R_MIPS_LO16:
4399     case R_MIPS16_LO16:
4400       if (!gp_disp_p)
4401 	value = (symbol + addend) & howto->dst_mask;
4402       else
4403 	{
4404 	  /* See the comment for R_MIPS16_HI16 above for the reason
4405 	     for this conditional.  */
4406 	  if (r_type == R_MIPS16_LO16)
4407 	    value = addend + gp - p;
4408 	  else
4409 	    value = addend + gp - p + 4;
4410 	  /* The MIPS ABI requires checking the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation
4411 	     for overflow.  But, on, say, IRIX5, relocations against
4412 	     _gp_disp are normally generated from the .cpload
4413 	     pseudo-op.  It generates code that normally looks like
4414 	     this:
4415 
4416 	       lui    $gp,%hi(_gp_disp)
4417 	       addiu  $gp,$gp,%lo(_gp_disp)
4418 	       addu   $gp,$gp,$t9
4419 
4420 	     Here $t9 holds the address of the function being called,
4421 	     as required by the MIPS ELF ABI.  The R_MIPS_LO16
4422 	     relocation can easily overflow in this situation, but the
4423 	     R_MIPS_HI16 relocation will handle the overflow.
4424 	     Therefore, we consider this a bug in the MIPS ABI, and do
4425 	     not check for overflow here.  */
4426 	}
4427       break;
4428 
4429     case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
4430       /* Because we don't merge literal sections, we can handle this
4431 	 just like R_MIPS_GPREL16.  In the long run, we should merge
4432 	 shared literals, and then we will need to additional work
4433 	 here.  */
4434 
4435       /* Fall through.  */
4436 
4437     case R_MIPS16_GPREL:
4438       /* The R_MIPS16_GPREL performs the same calculation as
4439 	 R_MIPS_GPREL16, but stores the relocated bits in a different
4440 	 order.  We don't need to do anything special here; the
4441 	 differences are handled in mips_elf_perform_relocation.  */
4442     case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
4443       /* Only sign-extend the addend if it was extracted from the
4444 	 instruction.  If the addend was separate, leave it alone,
4445 	 otherwise we may lose significant bits.  */
4446       if (howto->partial_inplace)
4447 	addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16);
4448       value = symbol + addend - gp;
4449       /* If the symbol was local, any earlier relocatable links will
4450 	 have adjusted its addend with the gp offset, so compensate
4451 	 for that now.  Don't do it for symbols forced local in this
4452 	 link, though, since they won't have had the gp offset applied
4453 	 to them before.  */
4454       if (was_local_p)
4455 	value += gp0;
4456       overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4457       break;
4458 
4459     case R_MIPS_GOT16:
4460     case R_MIPS_CALL16:
4461       /* VxWorks does not have separate local and global semantics for
4462 	 R_MIPS_GOT16; every relocation evaluates to "G".  */
4463       if (!htab->is_vxworks && local_p)
4464 	{
4465 	  bfd_boolean forced;
4466 
4467 	  forced = ! mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
4468 						  local_sections, FALSE);
4469 	  value = mips_elf_got16_entry (abfd, input_bfd, info,
4470 					symbol + addend, forced);
4471 	  if (value == MINUS_ONE)
4472 	    return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
4473 	  value
4474 	    = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (dynobj, abfd, input_bfd, value);
4475 	  overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4476 	  break;
4477 	}
4478 
4479       /* Fall through.  */
4480 
4481     case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
4482     case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
4483     case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
4484     case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
4485     got_disp:
4486       value = g;
4487       overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4488       break;
4489 
4490     case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
4491       value = (addend + symbol + gp0 - gp);
4492       if (!save_addend)
4493 	value &= howto->dst_mask;
4494       break;
4495 
4496     case R_MIPS_PC16:
4497     case R_MIPS_GNU_REL16_S2:
4498       value = symbol + _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 18) - p;
4499       overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 18);
4500       value >>= howto->rightshift;
4501       value &= howto->dst_mask;
4502       break;
4503 
4504     case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
4505     case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
4506       /* We're allowed to handle these two relocations identically.
4507 	 The dynamic linker is allowed to handle the CALL relocations
4508 	 differently by creating a lazy evaluation stub.  */
4509       value = g;
4510       value = mips_elf_high (value);
4511       value &= howto->dst_mask;
4512       break;
4513 
4514     case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
4515     case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
4516       value = g & howto->dst_mask;
4517       break;
4518 
4519     case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
4520       /* GOT_PAGE relocations that reference non-local symbols decay
4521 	 to GOT_DISP.  The corresponding GOT_OFST relocation decays to
4522 	 0.  */
4523       if (! local_p)
4524 	goto got_disp;
4525       value = mips_elf_got_page (abfd, input_bfd, info, symbol + addend, NULL);
4526       if (value == MINUS_ONE)
4527 	return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
4528       value = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (dynobj, abfd, input_bfd, value);
4529       overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4530       break;
4531 
4532     case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
4533       if (local_p)
4534 	mips_elf_got_page (abfd, input_bfd, info, symbol + addend, &value);
4535       else
4536 	value = addend;
4537       overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4538       break;
4539 
4540     case R_MIPS_SUB:
4541       value = symbol - addend;
4542       value &= howto->dst_mask;
4543       break;
4544 
4545     case R_MIPS_HIGHER:
4546       value = mips_elf_higher (addend + symbol);
4547       value &= howto->dst_mask;
4548       break;
4549 
4550     case R_MIPS_HIGHEST:
4551       value = mips_elf_highest (addend + symbol);
4552       value &= howto->dst_mask;
4553       break;
4554 
4555     case R_MIPS_SCN_DISP:
4556       value = symbol + addend - sec->output_offset;
4557       value &= howto->dst_mask;
4558       break;
4559 
4560     case R_MIPS_JALR:
4561       /* This relocation is only a hint.  In some cases, we optimize
4562 	 it into a bal instruction.  But we don't try to optimize
4563 	 branches to the PLT; that will wind up wasting time.  */
4564       if (h != NULL && h->root.plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
4565 	return bfd_reloc_continue;
4566       value = symbol + addend;
4567       break;
4568 
4569     case R_MIPS_PJUMP:
4570     case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
4571     case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
4572       /* We don't do anything with these at present.  */
4573       return bfd_reloc_continue;
4574 
4575     default:
4576       /* An unrecognized relocation type.  */
4577       return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
4578     }
4579 
4580   /* Store the VALUE for our caller.  */
4581   *valuep = value;
4582   return overflowed_p ? bfd_reloc_overflow : bfd_reloc_ok;
4583 }
4584 
4585 /* Obtain the field relocated by RELOCATION.  */
4586 
4587 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_obtain_contents(reloc_howto_type * howto,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocation,bfd * input_bfd,bfd_byte * contents)4588 mips_elf_obtain_contents (reloc_howto_type *howto,
4589 			  const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
4590 			  bfd *input_bfd, bfd_byte *contents)
4591 {
4592   bfd_vma x;
4593   bfd_byte *location = contents + relocation->r_offset;
4594 
4595   /* Obtain the bytes.  */
4596   x = bfd_get ((8 * bfd_get_reloc_size (howto)), input_bfd, location);
4597 
4598   return x;
4599 }
4600 
4601 /* It has been determined that the result of the RELOCATION is the
4602    VALUE.  Use HOWTO to place VALUE into the output file at the
4603    appropriate position.  The SECTION is the section to which the
4604    relocation applies.  If REQUIRE_JALX is TRUE, then the opcode used
4605    for the relocation must be either JAL or JALX, and it is
4606    unconditionally converted to JALX.
4607 
4608    Returns FALSE if anything goes wrong.  */
4609 
4610 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_perform_relocation(struct bfd_link_info * info,reloc_howto_type * howto,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocation,bfd_vma value,bfd * input_bfd,asection * input_section,bfd_byte * contents,bfd_boolean require_jalx)4611 mips_elf_perform_relocation (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4612 			     reloc_howto_type *howto,
4613 			     const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
4614 			     bfd_vma value, bfd *input_bfd,
4615 			     asection *input_section, bfd_byte *contents,
4616 			     bfd_boolean require_jalx)
4617 {
4618   bfd_vma x;
4619   bfd_byte *location;
4620   int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
4621 
4622   /* Figure out where the relocation is occurring.  */
4623   location = contents + relocation->r_offset;
4624 
4625   _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (input_bfd, r_type, FALSE, location);
4626 
4627   /* Obtain the current value.  */
4628   x = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, relocation, input_bfd, contents);
4629 
4630   /* Clear the field we are setting.  */
4631   x &= ~howto->dst_mask;
4632 
4633   /* Set the field.  */
4634   x |= (value & howto->dst_mask);
4635 
4636   /* If required, turn JAL into JALX.  */
4637   if (require_jalx)
4638     {
4639       bfd_boolean ok;
4640       bfd_vma opcode = x >> 26;
4641       bfd_vma jalx_opcode;
4642 
4643       /* Check to see if the opcode is already JAL or JALX.  */
4644       if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
4645 	{
4646 	  ok = ((opcode == 0x6) || (opcode == 0x7));
4647 	  jalx_opcode = 0x7;
4648 	}
4649       else
4650 	{
4651 	  ok = ((opcode == 0x3) || (opcode == 0x1d));
4652 	  jalx_opcode = 0x1d;
4653 	}
4654 
4655       /* If the opcode is not JAL or JALX, there's a problem.  */
4656       if (!ok)
4657 	{
4658 	  (*_bfd_error_handler)
4659 	    (_("%B: %A+0x%lx: jump to stub routine which is not jal"),
4660 	     input_bfd,
4661 	     input_section,
4662 	     (unsigned long) relocation->r_offset);
4663 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4664 	  return FALSE;
4665 	}
4666 
4667       /* Make this the JALX opcode.  */
4668       x = (x & ~(0x3f << 26)) | (jalx_opcode << 26);
4669     }
4670 
4671   /* On the RM9000, bal is faster than jal, because bal uses branch
4672      prediction hardware.  If we are linking for the RM9000, and we
4673      see jal, and bal fits, use it instead.  Note that this
4674      transformation should be safe for all architectures.  */
4675   if (bfd_get_mach (input_bfd) == bfd_mach_mips9000
4676       && !info->relocatable
4677       && !require_jalx
4678       && ((r_type == R_MIPS_26 && (x >> 26) == 0x3)	    /* jal addr */
4679 	  || (r_type == R_MIPS_JALR && x == 0x0320f809)))   /* jalr t9 */
4680     {
4681       bfd_vma addr;
4682       bfd_vma dest;
4683       bfd_signed_vma off;
4684 
4685       addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
4686 	      + input_section->output_offset
4687 	      + relocation->r_offset
4688 	      + 4);
4689       if (r_type == R_MIPS_26)
4690 	dest = (value << 2) | ((addr >> 28) << 28);
4691       else
4692 	dest = value;
4693       off = dest - addr;
4694       if (off <= 0x1ffff && off >= -0x20000)
4695 	x = 0x04110000 | (((bfd_vma) off >> 2) & 0xffff);   /* bal addr */
4696     }
4697 
4698   /* Put the value into the output.  */
4699   bfd_put (8 * bfd_get_reloc_size (howto), input_bfd, x, location);
4700 
4701   _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle(input_bfd, r_type, !info->relocatable,
4702 				location);
4703 
4704   return TRUE;
4705 }
4706 
4707 /* Returns TRUE if SECTION is a MIPS16 stub section.  */
4708 
4709 static bfd_boolean
mips16_stub_section_p(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection * section)4710 mips16_stub_section_p (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section)
4711 {
4712   const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, section);
4713 
4714   return FN_STUB_P (name) || CALL_STUB_P (name) || CALL_FP_STUB_P (name);
4715 }
4716 
4717 /* Add room for N relocations to the .rel(a).dyn section in ABFD.  */
4718 
4719 static void
mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,unsigned int n)4720 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
4721 				       unsigned int n)
4722 {
4723   asection *s;
4724   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4725 
4726   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4727   s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
4728   BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
4729 
4730   if (htab->is_vxworks)
4731     s->size += n * MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE (abfd);
4732   else
4733     {
4734       if (s->size == 0)
4735 	{
4736 	  /* Make room for a null element.  */
4737 	  s->size += MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd);
4738 	  ++s->reloc_count;
4739 	}
4740       s->size += n * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd);
4741     }
4742 }
4743 
4744 /* Create a rel.dyn relocation for the dynamic linker to resolve.  REL
4745    is the original relocation, which is now being transformed into a
4746    dynamic relocation.  The ADDENDP is adjusted if necessary; the
4747    caller should store the result in place of the original addend.  */
4748 
4749 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,const Elf_Internal_Rela * rel,struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,asection * sec,bfd_vma symbol,bfd_vma * addendp,asection * input_section)4750 mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation (bfd *output_bfd,
4751 				    struct bfd_link_info *info,
4752 				    const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4753 				    struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4754 				    asection *sec, bfd_vma symbol,
4755 				    bfd_vma *addendp, asection *input_section)
4756 {
4757   Elf_Internal_Rela outrel[3];
4758   asection *sreloc;
4759   bfd *dynobj;
4760   int r_type;
4761   long indx;
4762   bfd_boolean defined_p;
4763   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4764 
4765   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4766   r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
4767   dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
4768   sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
4769   BFD_ASSERT (sreloc != NULL);
4770   BFD_ASSERT (sreloc->contents != NULL);
4771   BFD_ASSERT (sreloc->reloc_count * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (output_bfd)
4772 	      < sreloc->size);
4773 
4774   outrel[0].r_offset =
4775     _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[0].r_offset);
4776   if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
4777     {
4778       outrel[1].r_offset =
4779 	_bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[1].r_offset);
4780       outrel[2].r_offset =
4781 	_bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[2].r_offset);
4782     }
4783 
4784   if (outrel[0].r_offset == MINUS_ONE)
4785     /* The relocation field has been deleted.  */
4786     return TRUE;
4787 
4788   if (outrel[0].r_offset == MINUS_TWO)
4789     {
4790       /* The relocation field has been converted into a relative value of
4791 	 some sort.  Functions like _bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame expect
4792 	 the field to be fully relocated, so add in the symbol's value.  */
4793       *addendp += symbol;
4794       return TRUE;
4795     }
4796 
4797   /* We must now calculate the dynamic symbol table index to use
4798      in the relocation.  */
4799   if (h != NULL
4800       && (sec == NULL || !h->root.def_regular
4801 	  || (info->shared && !info->symbolic && !h->root.forced_local)))
4802     {
4803       indx = h->root.dynindx;
4804       if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
4805 	defined_p = h->root.def_regular;
4806       else
4807 	/* ??? glibc's ld.so just adds the final GOT entry to the
4808 	   relocation field.  It therefore treats relocs against
4809 	   defined symbols in the same way as relocs against
4810 	   undefined symbols.  */
4811 	defined_p = FALSE;
4812     }
4813   else
4814     {
4815       if (sec != NULL && bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
4816 	indx = 0;
4817       else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
4818 	{
4819 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4820 	  return FALSE;
4821 	}
4822       else
4823 	{
4824 	  indx = elf_section_data (sec->output_section)->dynindx;
4825 	  if (indx == 0)
4826 	    {
4827 	      asection *osec = htab->root.text_index_section;
4828 	      indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
4829 	    }
4830 	  if (indx == 0)
4831 	    abort ();
4832 	}
4833 
4834       /* Instead of generating a relocation using the section
4835 	 symbol, we may as well make it a fully relative
4836 	 relocation.  We want to avoid generating relocations to
4837 	 local symbols because we used to generate them
4838 	 incorrectly, without adding the original symbol value,
4839 	 which is mandated by the ABI for section symbols.  In
4840 	 order to give dynamic loaders and applications time to
4841 	 phase out the incorrect use, we refrain from emitting
4842 	 section-relative relocations.  It's not like they're
4843 	 useful, after all.  This should be a bit more efficient
4844 	 as well.  */
4845       /* ??? Although this behavior is compatible with glibc's ld.so,
4846 	 the ABI says that relocations against STN_UNDEF should have
4847 	 a symbol value of 0.  Irix rld honors this, so relocations
4848 	 against STN_UNDEF have no effect.  */
4849       if (!SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
4850 	indx = 0;
4851       defined_p = TRUE;
4852     }
4853 
4854   /* If the relocation was previously an absolute relocation and
4855      this symbol will not be referred to by the relocation, we must
4856      adjust it by the value we give it in the dynamic symbol table.
4857      Otherwise leave the job up to the dynamic linker.  */
4858   if (defined_p && r_type != R_MIPS_REL32)
4859     *addendp += symbol;
4860 
4861   if (htab->is_vxworks)
4862     /* VxWorks uses non-relative relocations for this.  */
4863     outrel[0].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_MIPS_32);
4864   else
4865     /* The relocation is always an REL32 relocation because we don't
4866        know where the shared library will wind up at load-time.  */
4867     outrel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, (unsigned long) indx,
4868 				   R_MIPS_REL32);
4869 
4870   /* For strict adherence to the ABI specification, we should
4871      generate a R_MIPS_64 relocation record by itself before the
4872      _REL32/_64 record as well, such that the addend is read in as
4873      a 64-bit value (REL32 is a 32-bit relocation, after all).
4874      However, since none of the existing ELF64 MIPS dynamic
4875      loaders seems to care, we don't waste space with these
4876      artificial relocations.  If this turns out to not be true,
4877      mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocation() should be tweaked so
4878      as to make room for a pair of dynamic relocations per
4879      invocation if ABI_64_P, and here we should generate an
4880      additional relocation record with R_MIPS_64 by itself for a
4881      NULL symbol before this relocation record.  */
4882   outrel[1].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0,
4883 				 ABI_64_P (output_bfd)
4884 				 ? R_MIPS_64
4885 				 : R_MIPS_NONE);
4886   outrel[2].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_NONE);
4887 
4888   /* Adjust the output offset of the relocation to reference the
4889      correct location in the output file.  */
4890   outrel[0].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
4891 			 + input_section->output_offset);
4892   outrel[1].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
4893 			 + input_section->output_offset);
4894   outrel[2].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
4895 			 + input_section->output_offset);
4896 
4897   /* Put the relocation back out.  We have to use the special
4898      relocation outputter in the 64-bit case since the 64-bit
4899      relocation format is non-standard.  */
4900   if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
4901     {
4902       (*get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_out)
4903 	(output_bfd, &outrel[0],
4904 	 (sreloc->contents
4905 	  + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)));
4906     }
4907   else if (htab->is_vxworks)
4908     {
4909       /* VxWorks uses RELA rather than REL dynamic relocations.  */
4910       outrel[0].r_addend = *addendp;
4911       bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out
4912 	(output_bfd, &outrel[0],
4913 	 (sreloc->contents
4914 	  + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)));
4915     }
4916   else
4917     bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out
4918       (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
4919        (sreloc->contents + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
4920 
4921   /* We've now added another relocation.  */
4922   ++sreloc->reloc_count;
4923 
4924   /* Make sure the output section is writable.  The dynamic linker
4925      will be writing to it.  */
4926   elf_section_data (input_section->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_flags
4927     |= SHF_WRITE;
4928 
4929   /* On IRIX5, make an entry of compact relocation info.  */
4930   if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix5)
4931     {
4932       asection *scpt = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".compact_rel");
4933       bfd_byte *cr;
4934 
4935       if (scpt)
4936 	{
4937 	  Elf32_crinfo cptrel;
4938 
4939 	  mips_elf_set_cr_format (cptrel, CRF_MIPS_LONG);
4940 	  cptrel.vaddr = (rel->r_offset
4941 			  + input_section->output_section->vma
4942 			  + input_section->output_offset);
4943 	  if (r_type == R_MIPS_REL32)
4944 	    mips_elf_set_cr_type (cptrel, CRT_MIPS_REL32);
4945 	  else
4946 	    mips_elf_set_cr_type (cptrel, CRT_MIPS_WORD);
4947 	  mips_elf_set_cr_dist2to (cptrel, 0);
4948 	  cptrel.konst = *addendp;
4949 
4950 	  cr = (scpt->contents
4951 		+ sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel));
4952 	  mips_elf_set_cr_relvaddr (cptrel, 0);
4953 	  bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out (output_bfd, &cptrel,
4954 				     ((Elf32_External_crinfo *) cr
4955 				      + scpt->reloc_count));
4956 	  ++scpt->reloc_count;
4957 	}
4958     }
4959 
4960   /* If we've written this relocation for a readonly section,
4961      we need to set DF_TEXTREL again, so that we do not delete the
4962      DT_TEXTREL tag.  */
4963   if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (input_section))
4964     info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
4965 
4966   return TRUE;
4967 }
4968 
4969 /* Return the MACH for a MIPS e_flags value.  */
4970 
4971 unsigned long
_bfd_elf_mips_mach(flagword flags)4972 _bfd_elf_mips_mach (flagword flags)
4973 {
4974   switch (flags & EF_MIPS_MACH)
4975     {
4976     case E_MIPS_MACH_3900:
4977       return bfd_mach_mips3900;
4978 
4979     case E_MIPS_MACH_4010:
4980       return bfd_mach_mips4010;
4981 
4982     case E_MIPS_MACH_4100:
4983       return bfd_mach_mips4100;
4984 
4985     case E_MIPS_MACH_4111:
4986       return bfd_mach_mips4111;
4987 
4988     case E_MIPS_MACH_4120:
4989       return bfd_mach_mips4120;
4990 
4991     case E_MIPS_MACH_4650:
4992       return bfd_mach_mips4650;
4993 
4994     case E_MIPS_MACH_5400:
4995       return bfd_mach_mips5400;
4996 
4997     case E_MIPS_MACH_5500:
4998       return bfd_mach_mips5500;
4999 
5000     case E_MIPS_MACH_9000:
5001       return bfd_mach_mips9000;
5002 
5003     case E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON:
5004       return bfd_mach_mips_octeon;
5005 
5006     case E_MIPS_MACH_SB1:
5007       return bfd_mach_mips_sb1;
5008 
5009     default:
5010       switch (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH)
5011 	{
5012 	default:
5013 	case E_MIPS_ARCH_1:
5014 	  return bfd_mach_mips3000;
5015 
5016 	case E_MIPS_ARCH_2:
5017 	  return bfd_mach_mips6000;
5018 
5019 	case E_MIPS_ARCH_3:
5020 	  return bfd_mach_mips4000;
5021 
5022 	case E_MIPS_ARCH_4:
5023 	  return bfd_mach_mips8000;
5024 
5025 	case E_MIPS_ARCH_5:
5026 	  return bfd_mach_mips5;
5027 
5028 	case E_MIPS_ARCH_32:
5029 	  return bfd_mach_mipsisa32;
5030 
5031 	case E_MIPS_ARCH_64:
5032 	  return bfd_mach_mipsisa64;
5033 
5034 	case E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2:
5035 	  return bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2;
5036 
5037 	case E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2:
5038 	  return bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2;
5039 	}
5040     }
5041 
5042   return 0;
5043 }
5044 
5045 /* Return printable name for ABI.  */
5046 
5047 static INLINE char *
elf_mips_abi_name(bfd * abfd)5048 elf_mips_abi_name (bfd *abfd)
5049 {
5050   flagword flags;
5051 
5052   flags = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags;
5053   switch (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI)
5054     {
5055     case 0:
5056       if (ABI_N32_P (abfd))
5057 	return "N32";
5058       else if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
5059 	return "64";
5060       else
5061 	return "none";
5062     case E_MIPS_ABI_O32:
5063       return "O32";
5064     case E_MIPS_ABI_O64:
5065       return "O64";
5066     case E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32:
5067       return "EABI32";
5068     case E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64:
5069       return "EABI64";
5070     default:
5071       return "unknown abi";
5072     }
5073 }
5074 
5075 /* MIPS ELF uses two common sections.  One is the usual one, and the
5076    other is for small objects.  All the small objects are kept
5077    together, and then referenced via the gp pointer, which yields
5078    faster assembler code.  This is what we use for the small common
5079    section.  This approach is copied from ecoff.c.  */
5080 static asection mips_elf_scom_section;
5081 static asymbol mips_elf_scom_symbol;
5082 static asymbol *mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr;
5083 
5084 /* MIPS ELF also uses an acommon section, which represents an
5085    allocated common symbol which may be overridden by a
5086    definition in a shared library.  */
5087 static asection mips_elf_acom_section;
5088 static asymbol mips_elf_acom_symbol;
5089 static asymbol *mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr;
5090 
5091 /* Handle the special MIPS section numbers that a symbol may use.
5092    This is used for both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI.  */
5093 
5094 void
_bfd_mips_elf_symbol_processing(bfd * abfd,asymbol * asym)5095 _bfd_mips_elf_symbol_processing (bfd *abfd, asymbol *asym)
5096 {
5097   elf_symbol_type *elfsym;
5098 
5099   elfsym = (elf_symbol_type *) asym;
5100   switch (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx)
5101     {
5102     case SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON:
5103       /* This section is used in a dynamically linked executable file.
5104 	 It is an allocated common section.  The dynamic linker can
5105 	 either resolve these symbols to something in a shared
5106 	 library, or it can just leave them here.  For our purposes,
5107 	 we can consider these symbols to be in a new section.  */
5108       if (mips_elf_acom_section.name == NULL)
5109 	{
5110 	  /* Initialize the acommon section.  */
5111 	  mips_elf_acom_section.name = ".acommon";
5112 	  mips_elf_acom_section.flags = SEC_ALLOC;
5113 	  mips_elf_acom_section.output_section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
5114 	  mips_elf_acom_section.symbol = &mips_elf_acom_symbol;
5115 	  mips_elf_acom_section.symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr;
5116 	  mips_elf_acom_symbol.name = ".acommon";
5117 	  mips_elf_acom_symbol.flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM;
5118 	  mips_elf_acom_symbol.section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
5119 	  mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr = &mips_elf_acom_symbol;
5120 	}
5121       asym->section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
5122       break;
5123 
5124     case SHN_COMMON:
5125       /* Common symbols less than the GP size are automatically
5126 	 treated as SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON symbols on IRIX5.  */
5127       if (asym->value > elf_gp_size (abfd)
5128 	  || ELF_ST_TYPE (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_info) == STT_TLS
5129 	  || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
5130 	break;
5131       /* Fall through.  */
5132     case SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON:
5133       if (mips_elf_scom_section.name == NULL)
5134 	{
5135 	  /* Initialize the small common section.  */
5136 	  mips_elf_scom_section.name = ".scommon";
5137 	  mips_elf_scom_section.flags = SEC_IS_COMMON;
5138 	  mips_elf_scom_section.output_section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
5139 	  mips_elf_scom_section.symbol = &mips_elf_scom_symbol;
5140 	  mips_elf_scom_section.symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr;
5141 	  mips_elf_scom_symbol.name = ".scommon";
5142 	  mips_elf_scom_symbol.flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM;
5143 	  mips_elf_scom_symbol.section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
5144 	  mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr = &mips_elf_scom_symbol;
5145 	}
5146       asym->section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
5147       asym->value = elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
5148       break;
5149 
5150     case SHN_MIPS_SUNDEFINED:
5151       asym->section = bfd_und_section_ptr;
5152       break;
5153 
5154     case SHN_MIPS_TEXT:
5155       {
5156 	asection *section = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".text");
5157 
5158 	BFD_ASSERT (SGI_COMPAT (abfd));
5159 	if (section != NULL)
5160 	  {
5161 	    asym->section = section;
5162 	    /* MIPS_TEXT is a bit special, the address is not an offset
5163 	       to the base of the .text section.  So substract the section
5164 	       base address to make it an offset.  */
5165 	    asym->value -= section->vma;
5166 	  }
5167       }
5168       break;
5169 
5170     case SHN_MIPS_DATA:
5171       {
5172 	asection *section = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".data");
5173 
5174 	BFD_ASSERT (SGI_COMPAT (abfd));
5175 	if (section != NULL)
5176 	  {
5177 	    asym->section = section;
5178 	    /* MIPS_DATA is a bit special, the address is not an offset
5179 	       to the base of the .data section.  So substract the section
5180 	       base address to make it an offset.  */
5181 	    asym->value -= section->vma;
5182 	  }
5183       }
5184       break;
5185     }
5186 }
5187 
5188 /* Implement elf_backend_eh_frame_address_size.  This differs from
5189    the default in the way it handles EABI64.
5190 
5191    EABI64 was originally specified as an LP64 ABI, and that is what
5192    -mabi=eabi normally gives on a 64-bit target.  However, gcc has
5193    historically accepted the combination of -mabi=eabi and -mlong32,
5194    and this ILP32 variation has become semi-official over time.
5195    Both forms use elf32 and have pointer-sized FDE addresses.
5196 
5197    If an EABI object was generated by GCC 4.0 or above, it will have
5198    an empty .gcc_compiled_longXX section, where XX is the size of longs
5199    in bits.  Unfortunately, ILP32 objects generated by earlier compilers
5200    have no special marking to distinguish them from LP64 objects.
5201 
5202    We don't want users of the official LP64 ABI to be punished for the
5203    existence of the ILP32 variant, but at the same time, we don't want
5204    to mistakenly interpret pre-4.0 ILP32 objects as being LP64 objects.
5205    We therefore take the following approach:
5206 
5207       - If ABFD contains a .gcc_compiled_longXX section, use it to
5208         determine the pointer size.
5209 
5210       - Otherwise check the type of the first relocation.  Assume that
5211         the LP64 ABI is being used if the relocation is of type R_MIPS_64.
5212 
5213       - Otherwise punt.
5214 
5215    The second check is enough to detect LP64 objects generated by pre-4.0
5216    compilers because, in the kind of output generated by those compilers,
5217    the first relocation will be associated with either a CIE personality
5218    routine or an FDE start address.  Furthermore, the compilers never
5219    used a special (non-pointer) encoding for this ABI.
5220 
5221    Checking the relocation type should also be safe because there is no
5222    reason to use R_MIPS_64 in an ILP32 object.  Pre-4.0 compilers never
5223    did so.  */
5224 
5225 unsigned int
_bfd_mips_elf_eh_frame_address_size(bfd * abfd,asection * sec)5226 _bfd_mips_elf_eh_frame_address_size (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
5227 {
5228   if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
5229     return 8;
5230   if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64)
5231     {
5232       bfd_boolean long32_p, long64_p;
5233 
5234       long32_p = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".gcc_compiled_long32") != 0;
5235       long64_p = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".gcc_compiled_long64") != 0;
5236       if (long32_p && long64_p)
5237 	return 0;
5238       if (long32_p)
5239 	return 4;
5240       if (long64_p)
5241 	return 8;
5242 
5243       if (sec->reloc_count > 0
5244 	  && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != NULL
5245 	  && (ELF32_R_TYPE (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs[0].r_info)
5246 	      == R_MIPS_64))
5247 	return 8;
5248 
5249       return 0;
5250     }
5251   return 4;
5252 }
5253 
5254 /* There appears to be a bug in the MIPSpro linker that causes GOT_DISP
5255    relocations against two unnamed section symbols to resolve to the
5256    same address.  For example, if we have code like:
5257 
5258 	lw	$4,%got_disp(.data)($gp)
5259 	lw	$25,%got_disp(.text)($gp)
5260 	jalr	$25
5261 
5262    then the linker will resolve both relocations to .data and the program
5263    will jump there rather than to .text.
5264 
5265    We can work around this problem by giving names to local section symbols.
5266    This is also what the MIPSpro tools do.  */
5267 
5268 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_name_local_section_symbols(bfd * abfd)5269 _bfd_mips_elf_name_local_section_symbols (bfd *abfd)
5270 {
5271   return SGI_COMPAT (abfd);
5272 }
5273 
5274 /* Work over a section just before writing it out.  This routine is
5275    used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI.  FIXME: We recognize
5276    sections that need the SHF_MIPS_GPREL flag by name; there has to be
5277    a better way.  */
5278 
5279 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_section_processing(bfd * abfd,Elf_Internal_Shdr * hdr)5280 _bfd_mips_elf_section_processing (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr)
5281 {
5282   if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_REGINFO
5283       && hdr->sh_size > 0)
5284     {
5285       bfd_byte buf[4];
5286 
5287       BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_size == sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
5288       BFD_ASSERT (hdr->contents == NULL);
5289 
5290       if (bfd_seek (abfd,
5291 		    hdr->sh_offset + sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo) - 4,
5292 		    SEEK_SET) != 0)
5293 	return FALSE;
5294       H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
5295       if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 4, abfd) != 4)
5296 	return FALSE;
5297     }
5298 
5299   if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS
5300       && hdr->bfd_section != NULL
5301       && mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section) != NULL
5302       && mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section)->u.tdata != NULL)
5303     {
5304       bfd_byte *contents, *l, *lend;
5305 
5306       /* We stored the section contents in the tdata field in the
5307 	 set_section_contents routine.  We save the section contents
5308 	 so that we don't have to read them again.
5309 	 At this point we know that elf_gp is set, so we can look
5310 	 through the section contents to see if there is an
5311 	 ODK_REGINFO structure.  */
5312 
5313       contents = mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section)->u.tdata;
5314       l = contents;
5315       lend = contents + hdr->sh_size;
5316       while (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) <= lend)
5317 	{
5318 	  Elf_Internal_Options intopt;
5319 
5320 	  bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (abfd, (Elf_External_Options *) l,
5321 					&intopt);
5322 	  if (intopt.size < sizeof (Elf_External_Options))
5323 	    {
5324 	      (*_bfd_error_handler)
5325 		(_("%B: Warning: bad `%s' option size %u smaller than its header"),
5326 		abfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd), intopt.size);
5327 	      break;
5328 	    }
5329 	  if (ABI_64_P (abfd) && intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
5330 	    {
5331 	      bfd_byte buf[8];
5332 
5333 	      if (bfd_seek (abfd,
5334 			    (hdr->sh_offset
5335 			     + (l - contents)
5336 			     + sizeof (Elf_External_Options)
5337 			     + (sizeof (Elf64_External_RegInfo) - 8)),
5338 			     SEEK_SET) != 0)
5339 		return FALSE;
5340 	      H_PUT_64 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
5341 	      if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 8, abfd) != 8)
5342 		return FALSE;
5343 	    }
5344 	  else if (intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
5345 	    {
5346 	      bfd_byte buf[4];
5347 
5348 	      if (bfd_seek (abfd,
5349 			    (hdr->sh_offset
5350 			     + (l - contents)
5351 			     + sizeof (Elf_External_Options)
5352 			     + (sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo) - 4)),
5353 			    SEEK_SET) != 0)
5354 		return FALSE;
5355 	      H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
5356 	      if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 4, abfd) != 4)
5357 		return FALSE;
5358 	    }
5359 	  l += intopt.size;
5360 	}
5361     }
5362 
5363   if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
5364     {
5365       const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, hdr->bfd_section);
5366 
5367       if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
5368 	  || strcmp (name, ".lit8") == 0
5369 	  || strcmp (name, ".lit4") == 0)
5370 	{
5371 	  hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5372 	  hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
5373 	}
5374       else if (strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
5375 	{
5376 	  hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5377 	  hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
5378 	}
5379       else if (strcmp (name, ".srdata") == 0)
5380 	{
5381 	  hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5382 	  hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
5383 	}
5384       else if (strcmp (name, ".compact_rel") == 0)
5385 	{
5386 	  hdr->sh_flags = 0;
5387 	  hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
5388 	}
5389       else if (strcmp (name, ".rtproc") == 0)
5390 	{
5391 	  if (hdr->sh_addralign != 0 && hdr->sh_entsize == 0)
5392 	    {
5393 	      unsigned int adjust;
5394 
5395 	      adjust = hdr->sh_size % hdr->sh_addralign;
5396 	      if (adjust != 0)
5397 		hdr->sh_size += hdr->sh_addralign - adjust;
5398 	    }
5399 	}
5400     }
5401 
5402   return TRUE;
5403 }
5404 
5405 /* Handle a MIPS specific section when reading an object file.  This
5406    is called when elfcode.h finds a section with an unknown type.
5407    This routine supports both the 32-bit and 64-bit ELF ABI.
5408 
5409    FIXME: We need to handle the SHF_MIPS_GPREL flag, but I'm not sure
5410    how to.  */
5411 
5412 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_section_from_shdr(bfd * abfd,Elf_Internal_Shdr * hdr,const char * name,int shindex)5413 _bfd_mips_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
5414 				 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
5415 				 const char *name,
5416 				 int shindex)
5417 {
5418   flagword flags = 0;
5419 
5420   /* There ought to be a place to keep ELF backend specific flags, but
5421      at the moment there isn't one.  We just keep track of the
5422      sections by their name, instead.  Fortunately, the ABI gives
5423      suggested names for all the MIPS specific sections, so we will
5424      probably get away with this.  */
5425   switch (hdr->sh_type)
5426     {
5427     case SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
5428       if (strcmp (name, ".liblist") != 0)
5429 	return FALSE;
5430       break;
5431     case SHT_MIPS_MSYM:
5432       if (strcmp (name, ".msym") != 0)
5433 	return FALSE;
5434       break;
5435     case SHT_MIPS_CONFLICT:
5436       if (strcmp (name, ".conflict") != 0)
5437 	return FALSE;
5438       break;
5439     case SHT_MIPS_GPTAB:
5440       if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gptab."))
5441 	return FALSE;
5442       break;
5443     case SHT_MIPS_UCODE:
5444       if (strcmp (name, ".ucode") != 0)
5445 	return FALSE;
5446       break;
5447     case SHT_MIPS_DEBUG:
5448       if (strcmp (name, ".mdebug") != 0)
5449 	return FALSE;
5450       flags = SEC_DEBUGGING;
5451       break;
5452     case SHT_MIPS_REGINFO:
5453       if (strcmp (name, ".reginfo") != 0
5454 	  || hdr->sh_size != sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo))
5455 	return FALSE;
5456       flags = (SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_SAME_SIZE);
5457       break;
5458     case SHT_MIPS_IFACE:
5459       if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.interfaces") != 0)
5460 	return FALSE;
5461       break;
5462     case SHT_MIPS_CONTENT:
5463       if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.content"))
5464 	return FALSE;
5465       break;
5466     case SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
5467       if (!MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (name))
5468 	return FALSE;
5469       break;
5470     case SHT_MIPS_DWARF:
5471       if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".debug_"))
5472 	return FALSE;
5473       break;
5474     case SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
5475       if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.symlib") != 0)
5476 	return FALSE;
5477       break;
5478     case SHT_MIPS_EVENTS:
5479       if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.events")
5480 	  && ! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.post_rel"))
5481 	return FALSE;
5482       break;
5483     default:
5484       break;
5485     }
5486 
5487   if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
5488     return FALSE;
5489 
5490   if (flags)
5491     {
5492       if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, hdr->bfd_section,
5493 				   (bfd_get_section_flags (abfd,
5494 							   hdr->bfd_section)
5495 				    | flags)))
5496 	return FALSE;
5497     }
5498 
5499   /* FIXME: We should record sh_info for a .gptab section.  */
5500 
5501   /* For a .reginfo section, set the gp value in the tdata information
5502      from the contents of this section.  We need the gp value while
5503      processing relocs, so we just get it now.  The .reginfo section
5504      is not used in the 64-bit MIPS ELF ABI.  */
5505   if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_REGINFO)
5506     {
5507       Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
5508       Elf32_RegInfo s;
5509 
5510       if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section,
5511 				      &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
5512 	return FALSE;
5513       bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (abfd, &ext, &s);
5514       elf_gp (abfd) = s.ri_gp_value;
5515     }
5516 
5517   /* For a SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS section, look for a ODK_REGINFO entry, and
5518      set the gp value based on what we find.  We may see both
5519      SHT_MIPS_REGINFO and SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS/ODK_REGINFO; in that case,
5520      they should agree.  */
5521   if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
5522     {
5523       bfd_byte *contents, *l, *lend;
5524 
5525       contents = bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
5526       if (contents == NULL)
5527 	return FALSE;
5528       if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section, contents,
5529 				      0, hdr->sh_size))
5530 	{
5531 	  free (contents);
5532 	  return FALSE;
5533 	}
5534       l = contents;
5535       lend = contents + hdr->sh_size;
5536       while (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) <= lend)
5537 	{
5538 	  Elf_Internal_Options intopt;
5539 
5540 	  bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (abfd, (Elf_External_Options *) l,
5541 					&intopt);
5542 	  if (intopt.size < sizeof (Elf_External_Options))
5543 	    {
5544 	      (*_bfd_error_handler)
5545 		(_("%B: Warning: bad `%s' option size %u smaller than its header"),
5546 		abfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd), intopt.size);
5547 	      break;
5548 	    }
5549 	  if (ABI_64_P (abfd) && intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
5550 	    {
5551 	      Elf64_Internal_RegInfo intreg;
5552 
5553 	      bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in
5554 		(abfd,
5555 		 ((Elf64_External_RegInfo *)
5556 		  (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options))),
5557 		 &intreg);
5558 	      elf_gp (abfd) = intreg.ri_gp_value;
5559 	    }
5560 	  else if (intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
5561 	    {
5562 	      Elf32_RegInfo intreg;
5563 
5564 	      bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in
5565 		(abfd,
5566 		 ((Elf32_External_RegInfo *)
5567 		  (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options))),
5568 		 &intreg);
5569 	      elf_gp (abfd) = intreg.ri_gp_value;
5570 	    }
5571 	  l += intopt.size;
5572 	}
5573       free (contents);
5574     }
5575 
5576   return TRUE;
5577 }
5578 
5579 /* Set the correct type for a MIPS ELF section.  We do this by the
5580    section name, which is a hack, but ought to work.  This routine is
5581    used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI.  */
5582 
5583 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_fake_sections(bfd * abfd,Elf_Internal_Shdr * hdr,asection * sec)5584 _bfd_mips_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *sec)
5585 {
5586   const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec);
5587 
5588   if (strcmp (name, ".liblist") == 0)
5589     {
5590       hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST;
5591       hdr->sh_info = sec->size / sizeof (Elf32_Lib);
5592       /* The sh_link field is set in final_write_processing.  */
5593     }
5594   else if (strcmp (name, ".conflict") == 0)
5595     hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_CONFLICT;
5596   else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gptab."))
5597     {
5598       hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_GPTAB;
5599       hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
5600       /* The sh_info field is set in final_write_processing.  */
5601     }
5602   else if (strcmp (name, ".ucode") == 0)
5603     hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_UCODE;
5604   else if (strcmp (name, ".mdebug") == 0)
5605     {
5606       hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_DEBUG;
5607       /* In a shared object on IRIX 5.3, the .mdebug section has an
5608          entsize of 0.  FIXME: Does this matter?  */
5609       if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
5610 	hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
5611       else
5612 	hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
5613     }
5614   else if (strcmp (name, ".reginfo") == 0)
5615     {
5616       hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_REGINFO;
5617       /* In a shared object on IRIX 5.3, the .reginfo section has an
5618          entsize of 0x18.  FIXME: Does this matter?  */
5619       if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
5620 	{
5621 	  if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
5622 	    hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo);
5623 	  else
5624 	    hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
5625 	}
5626       else
5627 	hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo);
5628     }
5629   else if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
5630 	   && (strcmp (name, ".hash") == 0
5631 	       || strcmp (name, ".dynamic") == 0
5632 	       || strcmp (name, ".dynstr") == 0))
5633     {
5634       if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
5635 	hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
5636 #if 0
5637       /* This isn't how the IRIX6 linker behaves.  */
5638       hdr->sh_info = SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES;
5639 #endif
5640     }
5641   else if (strcmp (name, ".got") == 0
5642 	   || strcmp (name, ".srdata") == 0
5643 	   || strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
5644 	   || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0
5645 	   || strcmp (name, ".lit4") == 0
5646 	   || strcmp (name, ".lit8") == 0)
5647     hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5648   else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.interfaces") == 0)
5649     {
5650       hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_IFACE;
5651       hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5652     }
5653   else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.content"))
5654     {
5655       hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_CONTENT;
5656       hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5657       /* The sh_info field is set in final_write_processing.  */
5658     }
5659   else if (MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (name))
5660     {
5661       hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS;
5662       hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
5663       hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5664     }
5665   else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".debug_"))
5666     hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_DWARF;
5667   else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.symlib") == 0)
5668     {
5669       hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB;
5670       /* The sh_link and sh_info fields are set in
5671          final_write_processing.  */
5672     }
5673   else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.events")
5674 	   || CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.post_rel"))
5675     {
5676       hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_EVENTS;
5677       hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5678       /* The sh_link field is set in final_write_processing.  */
5679     }
5680   else if (strcmp (name, ".msym") == 0)
5681     {
5682       hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_MSYM;
5683       hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
5684       hdr->sh_entsize = 8;
5685     }
5686 
5687   /* The generic elf_fake_sections will set up REL_HDR using the default
5688    kind of relocations.  We used to set up a second header for the
5689    non-default kind of relocations here, but only NewABI would use
5690    these, and the IRIX ld doesn't like resulting empty RELA sections.
5691    Thus we create those header only on demand now.  */
5692 
5693   return TRUE;
5694 }
5695 
5696 /* Given a BFD section, try to locate the corresponding ELF section
5697    index.  This is used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI.
5698    Actually, it's not clear to me that the 64-bit ABI supports these,
5699    but for non-PIC objects we will certainly want support for at least
5700    the .scommon section.  */
5701 
5702 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_section_from_bfd_section(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection * sec,int * retval)5703 _bfd_mips_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
5704 					asection *sec, int *retval)
5705 {
5706   if (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), ".scommon") == 0)
5707     {
5708       *retval = SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON;
5709       return TRUE;
5710     }
5711   if (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), ".acommon") == 0)
5712     {
5713       *retval = SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON;
5714       return TRUE;
5715     }
5716   return FALSE;
5717 }
5718 
5719 /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
5720    file.  We must handle the special MIPS section numbers here.  */
5721 
5722 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_add_symbol_hook(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym,const char ** namep,flagword * flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection ** secp,bfd_vma * valp)5723 _bfd_mips_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
5724 			       Elf_Internal_Sym *sym, const char **namep,
5725 			       flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
5726 			       asection **secp, bfd_vma *valp)
5727 {
5728   if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
5729       && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
5730       && strcmp (*namep, "_rld_new_interface") == 0)
5731     {
5732       /* Skip IRIX5 rld entry name.  */
5733       *namep = NULL;
5734       return TRUE;
5735     }
5736 
5737   /* Shared objects may have a dynamic symbol '_gp_disp' defined as
5738      a SECTION *ABS*.  This causes ld to think it can resolve _gp_disp
5739      by setting a DT_NEEDED for the shared object.  Since _gp_disp is
5740      a magic symbol resolved by the linker, we ignore this bogus definition
5741      of _gp_disp.  New ABI objects do not suffer from this problem so this
5742      is not done for them. */
5743   if (!NEWABI_P(abfd)
5744       && (sym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
5745       && (strcmp (*namep, "_gp_disp") == 0))
5746     {
5747       *namep = NULL;
5748       return TRUE;
5749     }
5750 
5751   switch (sym->st_shndx)
5752     {
5753     case SHN_COMMON:
5754       /* Common symbols less than the GP size are automatically
5755 	 treated as SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON symbols.  */
5756       if (sym->st_size > elf_gp_size (abfd)
5757 	  || ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_TLS
5758 	  || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
5759 	break;
5760       /* Fall through.  */
5761     case SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON:
5762       *secp = bfd_make_section_old_way (abfd, ".scommon");
5763       (*secp)->flags |= SEC_IS_COMMON;
5764       *valp = sym->st_size;
5765       break;
5766 
5767     case SHN_MIPS_TEXT:
5768       /* This section is used in a shared object.  */
5769       if (elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section == NULL)
5770 	{
5771 	  asymbol *elf_text_symbol;
5772 	  asection *elf_text_section;
5773 	  bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (asection);
5774 
5775 	  elf_text_section = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5776 	  if (elf_text_section == NULL)
5777 	    return FALSE;
5778 
5779 	  amt = sizeof (asymbol);
5780 	  elf_text_symbol = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5781 	  if (elf_text_symbol == NULL)
5782 	    return FALSE;
5783 
5784 	  /* Initialize the section.  */
5785 
5786 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section = elf_text_section;
5787 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_symbol = elf_text_symbol;
5788 
5789 	  elf_text_section->symbol = elf_text_symbol;
5790 	  elf_text_section->symbol_ptr_ptr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_symbol;
5791 
5792 	  elf_text_section->name = ".text";
5793 	  elf_text_section->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
5794 	  elf_text_section->output_section = NULL;
5795 	  elf_text_section->owner = abfd;
5796 	  elf_text_symbol->name = ".text";
5797 	  elf_text_symbol->flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_DYNAMIC;
5798 	  elf_text_symbol->section = elf_text_section;
5799 	}
5800       /* This code used to do *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr if
5801          info->shared.  I don't know why, and that doesn't make sense,
5802          so I took it out.  */
5803       *secp = elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section;
5804       break;
5805 
5806     case SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON:
5807       /* Fall through. XXX Can we treat this as allocated data?  */
5808     case SHN_MIPS_DATA:
5809       /* This section is used in a shared object.  */
5810       if (elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section == NULL)
5811 	{
5812 	  asymbol *elf_data_symbol;
5813 	  asection *elf_data_section;
5814 	  bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (asection);
5815 
5816 	  elf_data_section = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5817 	  if (elf_data_section == NULL)
5818 	    return FALSE;
5819 
5820 	  amt = sizeof (asymbol);
5821 	  elf_data_symbol = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5822 	  if (elf_data_symbol == NULL)
5823 	    return FALSE;
5824 
5825 	  /* Initialize the section.  */
5826 
5827 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section = elf_data_section;
5828 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_symbol = elf_data_symbol;
5829 
5830 	  elf_data_section->symbol = elf_data_symbol;
5831 	  elf_data_section->symbol_ptr_ptr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_symbol;
5832 
5833 	  elf_data_section->name = ".data";
5834 	  elf_data_section->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
5835 	  elf_data_section->output_section = NULL;
5836 	  elf_data_section->owner = abfd;
5837 	  elf_data_symbol->name = ".data";
5838 	  elf_data_symbol->flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_DYNAMIC;
5839 	  elf_data_symbol->section = elf_data_section;
5840 	}
5841       /* This code used to do *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr if
5842          info->shared.  I don't know why, and that doesn't make sense,
5843          so I took it out.  */
5844       *secp = elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section;
5845       break;
5846 
5847     case SHN_MIPS_SUNDEFINED:
5848       *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr;
5849       break;
5850     }
5851 
5852   if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
5853       && ! info->shared
5854       && info->hash->creator == abfd->xvec
5855       && strcmp (*namep, "__rld_obj_head") == 0)
5856     {
5857       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
5858       struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
5859 
5860       /* Mark __rld_obj_head as dynamic.  */
5861       bh = NULL;
5862       if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
5863 	     (info, abfd, *namep, BSF_GLOBAL, *secp, *valp, NULL, FALSE,
5864 	      get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
5865 	return FALSE;
5866 
5867       h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
5868       h->non_elf = 0;
5869       h->def_regular = 1;
5870       h->type = STT_OBJECT;
5871 
5872       if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
5873 	return FALSE;
5874 
5875       mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head = TRUE;
5876     }
5877 
5878   /* If this is a mips16 text symbol, add 1 to the value to make it
5879      odd.  This will cause something like .word SYM to come up with
5880      the right value when it is loaded into the PC.  */
5881   if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
5882     ++*valp;
5883 
5884   return TRUE;
5885 }
5886 
5887 /* This hook function is called before the linker writes out a global
5888    symbol.  We mark symbols as small common if appropriate.  This is
5889    also where we undo the increment of the value for a mips16 symbol.  */
5890 
5891 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_link_output_symbol_hook(struct bfd_link_info * info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const char * name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym,asection * input_sec,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)5892 _bfd_mips_elf_link_output_symbol_hook
5893   (struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
5894    const char *name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
5895    asection *input_sec, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5896 {
5897   /* If we see a common symbol, which implies a relocatable link, then
5898      if a symbol was small common in an input file, mark it as small
5899      common in the output file.  */
5900   if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
5901       && strcmp (input_sec->name, ".scommon") == 0)
5902     sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON;
5903 
5904   if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
5905     sym->st_value &= ~1;
5906 
5907   return TRUE;
5908 }
5909 
5910 /* Functions for the dynamic linker.  */
5911 
5912 /* Create dynamic sections when linking against a dynamic object.  */
5913 
5914 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)5915 _bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
5916 {
5917   struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
5918   struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
5919   flagword flags;
5920   register asection *s;
5921   const char * const *namep;
5922   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5923 
5924   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
5925   flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
5926 	   | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
5927 
5928   /* The psABI requires a read-only .dynamic section, but the VxWorks
5929      EABI doesn't.  */
5930   if (!htab->is_vxworks)
5931     {
5932       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
5933       if (s != NULL)
5934 	{
5935 	  if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags))
5936 	    return FALSE;
5937 	}
5938     }
5939 
5940   /* We need to create .got section.  */
5941   if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info, FALSE))
5942     return FALSE;
5943 
5944   if (! mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, TRUE))
5945     return FALSE;
5946 
5947   /* Create .stub section.  */
5948   if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
5949 			       MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (abfd)) == NULL)
5950     {
5951       s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd,
5952 				       MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (abfd),
5953 				       flags | SEC_CODE);
5954       if (s == NULL
5955 	  || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
5956 					  MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
5957 	return FALSE;
5958     }
5959 
5960   if ((IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_none)
5961       && !info->shared
5962       && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rld_map") == NULL)
5963     {
5964       s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".rld_map",
5965 				       flags &~ (flagword) SEC_READONLY);
5966       if (s == NULL
5967 	  || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
5968 					  MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
5969 	return FALSE;
5970     }
5971 
5972   /* On IRIX5, we adjust add some additional symbols and change the
5973      alignments of several sections.  There is no ABI documentation
5974      indicating that this is necessary on IRIX6, nor any evidence that
5975      the linker takes such action.  */
5976   if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5)
5977     {
5978       for (namep = mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names; *namep != NULL; namep++)
5979 	{
5980 	  bh = NULL;
5981 	  if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
5982 		 (info, abfd, *namep, BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_und_section_ptr, 0,
5983 		  NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
5984 	    return FALSE;
5985 
5986 	  h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
5987 	  h->non_elf = 0;
5988 	  h->def_regular = 1;
5989 	  h->type = STT_SECTION;
5990 
5991 	  if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
5992 	    return FALSE;
5993 	}
5994 
5995       /* We need to create a .compact_rel section.  */
5996       if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
5997 	{
5998 	  if (!mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section (abfd, info))
5999 	    return FALSE;
6000 	}
6001 
6002       /* Change alignments of some sections.  */
6003       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".hash");
6004       if (s != NULL)
6005 	bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6006       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
6007       if (s != NULL)
6008 	bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6009       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
6010       if (s != NULL)
6011 	bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6012       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
6013       if (s != NULL)
6014 	bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6015       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
6016       if (s != NULL)
6017 	bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6018     }
6019 
6020   if (!info->shared)
6021     {
6022       const char *name;
6023 
6024       name = SGI_COMPAT (abfd) ? "_DYNAMIC_LINK" : "_DYNAMIC_LINKING";
6025       bh = NULL;
6026       if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
6027 	    (info, abfd, name, BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_abs_section_ptr, 0,
6028 	     NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
6029 	return FALSE;
6030 
6031       h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
6032       h->non_elf = 0;
6033       h->def_regular = 1;
6034       h->type = STT_SECTION;
6035 
6036       if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
6037 	return FALSE;
6038 
6039       if (! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head)
6040 	{
6041 	  /* __rld_map is a four byte word located in the .data section
6042 	     and is filled in by the rtld to contain a pointer to
6043 	     the _r_debug structure. Its symbol value will be set in
6044 	     _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol.  */
6045 	  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rld_map");
6046 	  BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
6047 
6048 	  name = SGI_COMPAT (abfd) ? "__rld_map" : "__RLD_MAP";
6049 	  bh = NULL;
6050 	  if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
6051 		(info, abfd, name, BSF_GLOBAL, s, 0, NULL, FALSE,
6052 		 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
6053 	    return FALSE;
6054 
6055 	  h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
6056 	  h->non_elf = 0;
6057 	  h->def_regular = 1;
6058 	  h->type = STT_OBJECT;
6059 
6060 	  if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
6061 	    return FALSE;
6062 	}
6063     }
6064 
6065   if (htab->is_vxworks)
6066     {
6067       /* Create the .plt, .rela.plt, .dynbss and .rela.bss sections.
6068 	 Also create the _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE symbol.  */
6069       if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
6070 	return FALSE;
6071 
6072       /* Cache the sections created above.  */
6073       htab->sdynbss = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynbss");
6074       htab->srelbss = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.bss");
6075       htab->srelplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
6076       htab->splt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
6077       if (!htab->sdynbss
6078 	  || (!htab->srelbss && !info->shared)
6079 	  || !htab->srelplt
6080 	  || !htab->splt)
6081 	abort ();
6082 
6083       /* Do the usual VxWorks handling.  */
6084       if (!elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
6085 	return FALSE;
6086 
6087       /* Work out the PLT sizes.  */
6088       if (info->shared)
6089 	{
6090 	  htab->plt_header_size
6091 	    = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry);
6092 	  htab->plt_entry_size
6093 	    = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_shared_plt_entry);
6094 	}
6095       else
6096 	{
6097 	  htab->plt_header_size
6098 	    = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry);
6099 	  htab->plt_entry_size
6100 	    = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_exec_plt_entry);
6101 	}
6102     }
6103 
6104   return TRUE;
6105 }
6106 
6107 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
6108    allocate space in the global offset table.  */
6109 
6110 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_check_relocs(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,asection * sec,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocs)6111 _bfd_mips_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
6112 			    asection *sec, const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
6113 {
6114   const char *name;
6115   bfd *dynobj;
6116   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6117   struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
6118   struct mips_got_info *g;
6119   size_t extsymoff;
6120   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
6121   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
6122   asection *sgot;
6123   asection *sreloc;
6124   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6125   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6126 
6127   if (info->relocatable)
6128     return TRUE;
6129 
6130   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
6131   dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
6132   symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
6133   sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
6134   extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (abfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6135 
6136   /* Check for the mips16 stub sections.  */
6137 
6138   name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec);
6139   if (FN_STUB_P (name))
6140     {
6141       unsigned long r_symndx;
6142 
6143       /* Look at the relocation information to figure out which symbol
6144          this is for.  */
6145 
6146       r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocs->r_info);
6147 
6148       if (r_symndx < extsymoff
6149 	  || sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff] == NULL)
6150 	{
6151 	  asection *o;
6152 
6153 	  /* This stub is for a local symbol.  This stub will only be
6154              needed if there is some relocation in this BFD, other
6155              than a 16 bit function call, which refers to this symbol.  */
6156 	  for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
6157 	    {
6158 	      Elf_Internal_Rela *sec_relocs;
6159 	      const Elf_Internal_Rela *r, *rend;
6160 
6161 	      /* We can ignore stub sections when looking for relocs.  */
6162 	      if ((o->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
6163 		  || o->reloc_count == 0
6164 		  || mips16_stub_section_p (abfd, o))
6165 		continue;
6166 
6167 	      sec_relocs
6168 		= _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
6169 					     info->keep_memory);
6170 	      if (sec_relocs == NULL)
6171 		return FALSE;
6172 
6173 	      rend = sec_relocs + o->reloc_count;
6174 	      for (r = sec_relocs; r < rend; r++)
6175 		if (ELF_R_SYM (abfd, r->r_info) == r_symndx
6176 		    && ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, r->r_info) != R_MIPS16_26)
6177 		  break;
6178 
6179 	      if (elf_section_data (o)->relocs != sec_relocs)
6180 		free (sec_relocs);
6181 
6182 	      if (r < rend)
6183 		break;
6184 	    }
6185 
6186 	  if (o == NULL)
6187 	    {
6188 	      /* There is no non-call reloc for this stub, so we do
6189                  not need it.  Since this function is called before
6190                  the linker maps input sections to output sections, we
6191                  can easily discard it by setting the SEC_EXCLUDE
6192                  flag.  */
6193 	      sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
6194 	      return TRUE;
6195 	    }
6196 
6197 	  /* Record this stub in an array of local symbol stubs for
6198              this BFD.  */
6199 	  if (elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs == NULL)
6200 	    {
6201 	      unsigned long symcount;
6202 	      asection **n;
6203 	      bfd_size_type amt;
6204 
6205 	      if (elf_bad_symtab (abfd))
6206 		symcount = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr);
6207 	      else
6208 		symcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6209 	      amt = symcount * sizeof (asection *);
6210 	      n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
6211 	      if (n == NULL)
6212 		return FALSE;
6213 	      elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs = n;
6214 	    }
6215 
6216 	  sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
6217 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx] = sec;
6218 
6219 	  /* We don't need to set mips16_stubs_seen in this case.
6220              That flag is used to see whether we need to look through
6221              the global symbol table for stubs.  We don't need to set
6222              it here, because we just have a local stub.  */
6223 	}
6224       else
6225 	{
6226 	  struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6227 
6228 	  h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
6229 	       sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]);
6230 
6231 	  while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6232 		 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6233 	    h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
6234 
6235 	  /* H is the symbol this stub is for.  */
6236 
6237 	  /* If we already have an appropriate stub for this function, we
6238 	     don't need another one, so we can discard this one.  Since
6239 	     this function is called before the linker maps input sections
6240 	     to output sections, we can easily discard it by setting the
6241 	     SEC_EXCLUDE flag.  */
6242 	  if (h->fn_stub != NULL)
6243 	    {
6244 	      sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
6245 	      return TRUE;
6246 	    }
6247 
6248 	  sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
6249 	  h->fn_stub = sec;
6250 	  mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen = TRUE;
6251 	}
6252     }
6253   else if (CALL_STUB_P (name) || CALL_FP_STUB_P (name))
6254     {
6255       unsigned long r_symndx;
6256       struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6257       asection **loc;
6258 
6259       /* Look at the relocation information to figure out which symbol
6260          this is for.  */
6261 
6262       r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocs->r_info);
6263 
6264       if (r_symndx < extsymoff
6265 	  || sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff] == NULL)
6266 	{
6267 	  asection *o;
6268 
6269 	  /* This stub is for a local symbol.  This stub will only be
6270              needed if there is some relocation (R_MIPS16_26) in this BFD
6271              that refers to this symbol.  */
6272 	  for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
6273 	    {
6274 	      Elf_Internal_Rela *sec_relocs;
6275 	      const Elf_Internal_Rela *r, *rend;
6276 
6277 	      /* We can ignore stub sections when looking for relocs.  */
6278 	      if ((o->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
6279 		  || o->reloc_count == 0
6280 		  || mips16_stub_section_p (abfd, o))
6281 		continue;
6282 
6283 	      sec_relocs
6284 		= _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
6285 					     info->keep_memory);
6286 	      if (sec_relocs == NULL)
6287 		return FALSE;
6288 
6289 	      rend = sec_relocs + o->reloc_count;
6290 	      for (r = sec_relocs; r < rend; r++)
6291 		if (ELF_R_SYM (abfd, r->r_info) == r_symndx
6292 		    && ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, r->r_info) == R_MIPS16_26)
6293 		    break;
6294 
6295 	      if (elf_section_data (o)->relocs != sec_relocs)
6296 		free (sec_relocs);
6297 
6298 	      if (r < rend)
6299 		break;
6300 	    }
6301 
6302 	  if (o == NULL)
6303 	    {
6304 	      /* There is no non-call reloc for this stub, so we do
6305                  not need it.  Since this function is called before
6306                  the linker maps input sections to output sections, we
6307                  can easily discard it by setting the SEC_EXCLUDE
6308                  flag.  */
6309 	      sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
6310 	      return TRUE;
6311 	    }
6312 
6313 	  /* Record this stub in an array of local symbol call_stubs for
6314              this BFD.  */
6315 	  if (elf_tdata (abfd)->local_call_stubs == NULL)
6316 	    {
6317 	      unsigned long symcount;
6318 	      asection **n;
6319 	      bfd_size_type amt;
6320 
6321 	      if (elf_bad_symtab (abfd))
6322 		symcount = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr);
6323 	      else
6324 		symcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6325 	      amt = symcount * sizeof (asection *);
6326 	      n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
6327 	      if (n == NULL)
6328 		return FALSE;
6329 	      elf_tdata (abfd)->local_call_stubs = n;
6330 	    }
6331 
6332 	  sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
6333 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->local_call_stubs[r_symndx] = sec;
6334 
6335 	  /* We don't need to set mips16_stubs_seen in this case.
6336              That flag is used to see whether we need to look through
6337              the global symbol table for stubs.  We don't need to set
6338              it here, because we just have a local stub.  */
6339 	}
6340       else
6341 	{
6342 	  h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
6343 	       sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]);
6344 
6345 	  /* H is the symbol this stub is for.  */
6346 
6347 	  if (CALL_FP_STUB_P (name))
6348 	    loc = &h->call_fp_stub;
6349 	  else
6350 	    loc = &h->call_stub;
6351 
6352 	  /* If we already have an appropriate stub for this function, we
6353 	     don't need another one, so we can discard this one.  Since
6354 	     this function is called before the linker maps input sections
6355 	     to output sections, we can easily discard it by setting the
6356 	     SEC_EXCLUDE flag.  */
6357 	  if (*loc != NULL)
6358 	    {
6359 	      sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
6360 	      return TRUE;
6361 	    }
6362 
6363 	  sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
6364 	  *loc = sec;
6365 	  mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen = TRUE;
6366 	}
6367     }
6368 
6369   if (dynobj == NULL)
6370     {
6371       sgot = NULL;
6372       g = NULL;
6373     }
6374   else
6375     {
6376       sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
6377       if (sgot == NULL)
6378 	g = NULL;
6379       else
6380 	{
6381 	  BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
6382 	  g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
6383 	  BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
6384 	}
6385     }
6386 
6387   sreloc = NULL;
6388   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6389   rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
6390   for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; ++rel)
6391     {
6392       unsigned long r_symndx;
6393       unsigned int r_type;
6394       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6395 
6396       r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, rel->r_info);
6397       r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info);
6398 
6399       if (r_symndx < extsymoff)
6400 	h = NULL;
6401       else if (r_symndx >= extsymoff + NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr))
6402 	{
6403 	  (*_bfd_error_handler)
6404 	    (_("%B: Malformed reloc detected for section %s"),
6405 	     abfd, name);
6406 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
6407 	  return FALSE;
6408 	}
6409       else
6410 	{
6411 	  h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff];
6412 
6413 	  /* This may be an indirect symbol created because of a version.  */
6414 	  if (h != NULL)
6415 	    {
6416 	      while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
6417 		h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
6418 	    }
6419 	}
6420 
6421       /* Some relocs require a global offset table.  */
6422       if (dynobj == NULL || sgot == NULL)
6423 	{
6424 	  switch (r_type)
6425 	    {
6426 	    case R_MIPS_GOT16:
6427 	    case R_MIPS_CALL16:
6428 	    case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
6429 	    case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
6430 	    case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
6431 	    case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
6432 	    case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
6433 	    case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
6434 	    case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
6435 	    case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
6436 	    case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
6437 	    case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
6438 	      if (dynobj == NULL)
6439 		elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
6440 	      if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (dynobj, info, FALSE))
6441 		return FALSE;
6442 	      g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot);
6443 	      if (htab->is_vxworks && !info->shared)
6444 		{
6445 		  (*_bfd_error_handler)
6446 		    (_("%B: GOT reloc at 0x%lx not expected in executables"),
6447 		     abfd, (unsigned long) rel->r_offset);
6448 		  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
6449 		  return FALSE;
6450 		}
6451 	      break;
6452 
6453 	    case R_MIPS_32:
6454 	    case R_MIPS_REL32:
6455 	    case R_MIPS_64:
6456 	      /* In VxWorks executables, references to external symbols
6457 		 are handled using copy relocs or PLT stubs, so there's
6458 		 no need to add a dynamic relocation here.  */
6459 	      if (dynobj == NULL
6460 		  && (info->shared || (h != NULL && !htab->is_vxworks))
6461 		  && (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
6462 		elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
6463 	      break;
6464 
6465 	    default:
6466 	      break;
6467 	    }
6468 	}
6469 
6470       if (h)
6471 	{
6472 	  ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->is_relocation_target = TRUE;
6473 
6474 	  /* Relocations against the special VxWorks __GOTT_BASE__ and
6475 	     __GOTT_INDEX__ symbols must be left to the loader.  Allocate
6476 	     room for them in .rela.dyn.  */
6477 	  if (is_gott_symbol (info, h))
6478 	    {
6479 	      if (sreloc == NULL)
6480 		{
6481 		  sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, TRUE);
6482 		  if (sreloc == NULL)
6483 		    return FALSE;
6484 		}
6485 	      mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, 1);
6486 	      if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))
6487 		/* We tell the dynamic linker that there are
6488 		   relocations against the text segment.  */
6489 		info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
6490 	    }
6491 	}
6492       else if (r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_LO16
6493 	       || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_LO16
6494 	       || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_DISP
6495 	       || (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16 && htab->is_vxworks))
6496 	{
6497 	  /* We may need a local GOT entry for this relocation.  We
6498 	     don't count R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE because we can estimate the
6499 	     maximum number of pages needed by looking at the size of
6500 	     the segment.  Similar comments apply to R_MIPS_GOT16 and
6501 	     R_MIPS_CALL16, except on VxWorks, where GOT relocations
6502 	     always evaluate to "G".  We don't count R_MIPS_GOT_HI16, or
6503 	     R_MIPS_CALL_HI16 because these are always followed by an
6504 	     R_MIPS_GOT_LO16 or R_MIPS_CALL_LO16.  */
6505 	  if (! mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (abfd, r_symndx,
6506 						  rel->r_addend, g, 0))
6507 	    return FALSE;
6508 	}
6509 
6510       switch (r_type)
6511 	{
6512 	case R_MIPS_CALL16:
6513 	  if (h == NULL)
6514 	    {
6515 	      (*_bfd_error_handler)
6516 		(_("%B: CALL16 reloc at 0x%lx not against global symbol"),
6517 		 abfd, (unsigned long) rel->r_offset);
6518 	      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
6519 	      return FALSE;
6520 	    }
6521 	  /* Fall through.  */
6522 
6523 	case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
6524 	case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
6525 	  if (h != NULL)
6526 	    {
6527 	      /* VxWorks call relocations point the function's .got.plt
6528 		 entry, which will be allocated by adjust_dynamic_symbol.
6529 		 Otherwise, this symbol requires a global GOT entry.  */
6530 	      if (!htab->is_vxworks
6531 		  && !mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g, 0))
6532 		return FALSE;
6533 
6534 	      /* We need a stub, not a plt entry for the undefined
6535 		 function.  But we record it as if it needs plt.  See
6536 		 _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol.  */
6537 	      h->needs_plt = 1;
6538 	      h->type = STT_FUNC;
6539 	    }
6540 	  break;
6541 
6542 	case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
6543 	  /* If this is a global, overridable symbol, GOT_PAGE will
6544 	     decay to GOT_DISP, so we'll need a GOT entry for it.  */
6545 	  if (h == NULL)
6546 	    break;
6547 	  else
6548 	    {
6549 	      struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips =
6550 		(struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6551 
6552 	      while (hmips->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6553 		     || hmips->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6554 		hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
6555 		  hmips->root.root.u.i.link;
6556 
6557 	      if (hmips->root.def_regular
6558 		  && ! (info->shared && ! info->symbolic
6559 			&& ! hmips->root.forced_local))
6560 		break;
6561 	    }
6562 	  /* Fall through.  */
6563 
6564 	case R_MIPS_GOT16:
6565 	case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
6566 	case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
6567 	case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
6568 	  if (h && ! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g, 0))
6569 	    return FALSE;
6570 	  break;
6571 
6572 	case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
6573 	  if (info->shared)
6574 	    info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
6575 	  /* Fall through */
6576 
6577 	case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
6578 	  if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
6579 	    {
6580 	      r_symndx = 0;
6581 	      h = NULL;
6582 	    }
6583 	  /* Fall through */
6584 
6585 	case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
6586 	  /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry, or two
6587 	     for TLS GD relocations.  */
6588 	  {
6589 	    unsigned char flag = (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD
6590 				  ? GOT_TLS_GD
6591 				  : r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM
6592 				  ? GOT_TLS_LDM
6593 				  : GOT_TLS_IE);
6594 	    if (h != NULL)
6595 	      {
6596 		struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips =
6597 		  (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6598 		hmips->tls_type |= flag;
6599 
6600 		if (h && ! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g, flag))
6601 		  return FALSE;
6602 	      }
6603 	    else
6604 	      {
6605 		BFD_ASSERT (flag == GOT_TLS_LDM || r_symndx != 0);
6606 
6607 		if (! mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (abfd, r_symndx,
6608 							rel->r_addend, g, flag))
6609 		  return FALSE;
6610 	      }
6611 	  }
6612 	  break;
6613 
6614 	case R_MIPS_32:
6615 	case R_MIPS_REL32:
6616 	case R_MIPS_64:
6617 	  /* In VxWorks executables, references to external symbols
6618 	     are handled using copy relocs or PLT stubs, so there's
6619 	     no need to add a .rela.dyn entry for this relocation.  */
6620 	  if ((info->shared || (h != NULL && !htab->is_vxworks))
6621 	      && (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
6622 	    {
6623 	      if (sreloc == NULL)
6624 		{
6625 		  sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, TRUE);
6626 		  if (sreloc == NULL)
6627 		    return FALSE;
6628 		}
6629 	      if (info->shared)
6630 		{
6631 		  /* When creating a shared object, we must copy these
6632 		     reloc types into the output file as R_MIPS_REL32
6633 		     relocs.  Make room for this reloc in .rel(a).dyn.  */
6634 		  mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, 1);
6635 		  if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))
6636 		    /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are
6637 		       relocations against the text segment.  */
6638 		    info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
6639 		}
6640 	      else
6641 		{
6642 		  struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
6643 
6644 		  /* We only need to copy this reloc if the symbol is
6645                      defined in a dynamic object.  */
6646 		  hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6647 		  ++hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs;
6648 		  if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))
6649 		    /* We need it to tell the dynamic linker if there
6650 		       are relocations against the text segment.  */
6651 		    hmips->readonly_reloc = TRUE;
6652 		}
6653 
6654 	      /* Even though we don't directly need a GOT entry for
6655 		 this symbol, a symbol must have a dynamic symbol
6656 		 table index greater that DT_MIPS_GOTSYM if there are
6657 		 dynamic relocations against it.  This does not apply
6658 		 to VxWorks, which does not have the usual coupling
6659 		 between global GOT entries and .dynsym entries.  */
6660 	      if (h != NULL && !htab->is_vxworks)
6661 		{
6662 		  if (dynobj == NULL)
6663 		    elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
6664 		  if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (dynobj, info, TRUE))
6665 		    return FALSE;
6666 		  g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot);
6667 		  if (! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g, 0))
6668 		    return FALSE;
6669 		}
6670 	    }
6671 
6672 	  if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
6673 	    mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size +=
6674 	      sizeof (Elf32_External_crinfo);
6675 	  break;
6676 
6677 	case R_MIPS_PC16:
6678 	  if (h)
6679 	    ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->is_branch_target = TRUE;
6680 	  break;
6681 
6682 	case R_MIPS_26:
6683 	  if (h)
6684 	    ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->is_branch_target = TRUE;
6685 	  /* Fall through.  */
6686 
6687 	case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
6688 	case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
6689 	case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
6690 	  if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
6691 	    mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size +=
6692 	      sizeof (Elf32_External_crinfo);
6693 	  break;
6694 
6695 	  /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
6696 	     Reconstruct it for later use during GC.  */
6697 	case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
6698 	  if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
6699 	    return FALSE;
6700 	  break;
6701 
6702 	  /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
6703 	     used.  Record for later use during GC.  */
6704 	case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
6705 	  if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
6706 	    return FALSE;
6707 	  break;
6708 
6709 	default:
6710 	  break;
6711 	}
6712 
6713       /* We must not create a stub for a symbol that has relocations
6714 	 related to taking the function's address.  This doesn't apply to
6715 	 VxWorks, where CALL relocs refer to a .got.plt entry instead of
6716 	 a normal .got entry.  */
6717       if (!htab->is_vxworks && h != NULL)
6718 	switch (r_type)
6719 	  {
6720 	  default:
6721 	    ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
6722 	    break;
6723 	  case R_MIPS_CALL16:
6724 	  case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
6725 	  case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
6726 	  case R_MIPS_JALR:
6727 	    break;
6728 	  }
6729 
6730       /* If this reloc is not a 16 bit call, and it has a global
6731          symbol, then we will need the fn_stub if there is one.
6732          References from a stub section do not count.  */
6733       if (h != NULL
6734 	  && r_type != R_MIPS16_26
6735 	  && !mips16_stub_section_p (abfd, sec))
6736 	{
6737 	  struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *mh;
6738 
6739 	  mh = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6740 	  mh->need_fn_stub = TRUE;
6741 	}
6742     }
6743 
6744   return TRUE;
6745 }
6746 
6747 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_relax_section(bfd * abfd,asection * sec,struct bfd_link_info * link_info,bfd_boolean * again)6748 _bfd_mips_relax_section (bfd *abfd, asection *sec,
6749 			 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
6750 			 bfd_boolean *again)
6751 {
6752   Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
6753   Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend;
6754   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6755   bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
6756   size_t extsymoff;
6757   bfd_boolean changed_contents = FALSE;
6758   bfd_vma sec_start = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
6759   Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
6760 
6761   /* We are not currently changing any sizes, so only one pass.  */
6762   *again = FALSE;
6763 
6764   if (link_info->relocatable)
6765     return TRUE;
6766 
6767   internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
6768 					       link_info->keep_memory);
6769   if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6770     return TRUE;
6771 
6772   irelend = internal_relocs + sec->reloc_count
6773     * get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
6774   symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
6775   extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (abfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6776 
6777   for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
6778     {
6779       bfd_vma symval;
6780       bfd_signed_vma sym_offset;
6781       unsigned int r_type;
6782       unsigned long r_symndx;
6783       asection *sym_sec;
6784       unsigned long instruction;
6785 
6786       /* Turn jalr into bgezal, and jr into beq, if they're marked
6787 	 with a JALR relocation, that indicate where they jump to.
6788 	 This saves some pipeline bubbles.  */
6789       r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, irel->r_info);
6790       if (r_type != R_MIPS_JALR)
6791 	continue;
6792 
6793       r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, irel->r_info);
6794       /* Compute the address of the jump target.  */
6795       if (r_symndx >= extsymoff)
6796 	{
6797 	  struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h
6798 	    = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
6799 	       elf_sym_hashes (abfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff]);
6800 
6801 	  while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6802 		 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6803 	    h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
6804 
6805 	  /* If a symbol is undefined, or if it may be overridden,
6806 	     skip it.  */
6807 	  if (! ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6808 		  || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6809 		 && h->root.root.u.def.section)
6810 	      || (link_info->shared && ! link_info->symbolic
6811 		  && !h->root.forced_local))
6812 	    continue;
6813 
6814 	  sym_sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
6815 	  if (sym_sec->output_section)
6816 	    symval = (h->root.root.u.def.value
6817 		      + sym_sec->output_section->vma
6818 		      + sym_sec->output_offset);
6819 	  else
6820 	    symval = h->root.root.u.def.value;
6821 	}
6822       else
6823 	{
6824 	  Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
6825 
6826 	  /* Read this BFD's symbols if we haven't done so already.  */
6827 	  if (isymbuf == NULL && symtab_hdr->sh_info != 0)
6828 	    {
6829 	      isymbuf = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
6830 	      if (isymbuf == NULL)
6831 		isymbuf = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr,
6832 						symtab_hdr->sh_info, 0,
6833 						NULL, NULL, NULL);
6834 	      if (isymbuf == NULL)
6835 		goto relax_return;
6836 	    }
6837 
6838 	  isym = isymbuf + r_symndx;
6839 	  if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_UNDEF)
6840 	    continue;
6841 	  else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
6842 	    sym_sec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6843 	  else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON)
6844 	    sym_sec = bfd_com_section_ptr;
6845 	  else
6846 	    sym_sec
6847 	      = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
6848 	  symval = isym->st_value
6849 	    + sym_sec->output_section->vma
6850 	    + sym_sec->output_offset;
6851 	}
6852 
6853       /* Compute branch offset, from delay slot of the jump to the
6854 	 branch target.  */
6855       sym_offset = (symval + irel->r_addend)
6856 	- (sec_start + irel->r_offset + 4);
6857 
6858       /* Branch offset must be properly aligned.  */
6859       if ((sym_offset & 3) != 0)
6860 	continue;
6861 
6862       sym_offset >>= 2;
6863 
6864       /* Check that it's in range.  */
6865       if (sym_offset < -0x8000 || sym_offset >= 0x8000)
6866 	continue;
6867 
6868       /* Get the section contents if we haven't done so already.  */
6869       if (contents == NULL)
6870 	{
6871 	  /* Get cached copy if it exists.  */
6872 	  if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
6873 	    contents = elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents;
6874 	  else
6875 	    {
6876 	      if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, sec, &contents))
6877 		goto relax_return;
6878 	    }
6879 	}
6880 
6881       instruction = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + irel->r_offset);
6882 
6883       /* If it was jalr <reg>, turn it into bgezal $zero, <target>.  */
6884       if ((instruction & 0xfc1fffff) == 0x0000f809)
6885 	instruction = 0x04110000;
6886       /* If it was jr <reg>, turn it into b <target>.  */
6887       else if ((instruction & 0xfc1fffff) == 0x00000008)
6888 	instruction = 0x10000000;
6889       else
6890 	continue;
6891 
6892       instruction |= (sym_offset & 0xffff);
6893       bfd_put_32 (abfd, instruction, contents + irel->r_offset);
6894       changed_contents = TRUE;
6895     }
6896 
6897   if (contents != NULL
6898       && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6899     {
6900       if (!changed_contents && !link_info->keep_memory)
6901         free (contents);
6902       else
6903         {
6904           /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd.  */
6905           elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
6906         }
6907     }
6908   return TRUE;
6909 
6910  relax_return:
6911   if (contents != NULL
6912       && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6913     free (contents);
6914   return FALSE;
6915 }
6916 
6917 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
6918    regular object.  The current definition is in some section of the
6919    dynamic object, but we're not including those sections.  We have to
6920    change the definition to something the rest of the link can
6921    understand.  */
6922 
6923 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)6924 _bfd_mips_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
6925 				     struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6926 {
6927   bfd *dynobj;
6928   struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
6929   asection *s;
6930   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6931 
6932   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
6933   dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
6934 
6935   /* Make sure we know what is going on here.  */
6936   BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL
6937 	      && (h->needs_plt
6938 		  || h->u.weakdef != NULL
6939 		  || (h->def_dynamic
6940 		      && h->ref_regular
6941 		      && !h->def_regular)));
6942 
6943   /* If this symbol is defined in a dynamic object, we need to copy
6944      any R_MIPS_32 or R_MIPS_REL32 relocs against it into the output
6945      file.  */
6946   hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6947   if (! info->relocatable
6948       && hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs != 0
6949       && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
6950 	  || !h->def_regular))
6951     {
6952       mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations
6953 	(dynobj, info, hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs);
6954       if (hmips->readonly_reloc)
6955 	/* We tell the dynamic linker that there are relocations
6956 	   against the text segment.  */
6957 	info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
6958     }
6959 
6960   /* For a function, create a stub, if allowed.  */
6961   if (! hmips->no_fn_stub
6962       && h->needs_plt)
6963     {
6964       if (! elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
6965 	return TRUE;
6966 
6967       /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular file, then set
6968 	 the symbol to the stub location.  This is required to make
6969 	 function pointers compare as equal between the normal
6970 	 executable and the shared library.  */
6971       if (!h->def_regular)
6972 	{
6973 	  /* We need .stub section.  */
6974 	  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj,
6975 				       MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj));
6976 	  BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
6977 
6978 	  h->root.u.def.section = s;
6979 	  h->root.u.def.value = s->size;
6980 
6981 	  /* XXX Write this stub address somewhere.  */
6982 	  h->plt.offset = s->size;
6983 
6984 	  /* Make room for this stub code.  */
6985 	  s->size += htab->function_stub_size;
6986 
6987 	  /* The last half word of the stub will be filled with the index
6988 	     of this symbol in .dynsym section.  */
6989 	  return TRUE;
6990 	}
6991     }
6992   else if ((h->type == STT_FUNC)
6993 	   && !h->needs_plt)
6994     {
6995       /* This will set the entry for this symbol in the GOT to 0, and
6996          the dynamic linker will take care of this.  */
6997       h->root.u.def.value = 0;
6998       return TRUE;
6999     }
7000 
7001   /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
7002      processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
7003      real definition first, and we can just use the same value.  */
7004   if (h->u.weakdef != NULL)
7005     {
7006       BFD_ASSERT (h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
7007 		  || h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
7008       h->root.u.def.section = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.section;
7009       h->root.u.def.value = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.value;
7010       return TRUE;
7011     }
7012 
7013   /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
7014      is not a function.  */
7015 
7016   return TRUE;
7017 }
7018 
7019 /* Likewise, for VxWorks.  */
7020 
7021 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_vxworks_adjust_dynamic_symbol(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)7022 _bfd_mips_vxworks_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
7023 					 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
7024 {
7025   bfd *dynobj;
7026   struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
7027   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
7028 
7029   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
7030   dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
7031   hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
7032 
7033   /* Make sure we know what is going on here.  */
7034   BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL
7035 	      && (h->needs_plt
7036 		  || h->needs_copy
7037 		  || h->u.weakdef != NULL
7038 		  || (h->def_dynamic
7039 		      && h->ref_regular
7040 		      && !h->def_regular)));
7041 
7042   /* If the symbol is defined by a dynamic object, we need a PLT stub if
7043      either (a) we want to branch to the symbol or (b) we're linking an
7044      executable that needs a canonical function address.  In the latter
7045      case, the canonical address will be the address of the executable's
7046      load stub.  */
7047   if ((hmips->is_branch_target
7048        || (!info->shared
7049 	   && h->type == STT_FUNC
7050 	   && hmips->is_relocation_target))
7051       && h->def_dynamic
7052       && h->ref_regular
7053       && !h->def_regular
7054       && !h->forced_local)
7055     h->needs_plt = 1;
7056 
7057   /* Locally-binding symbols do not need a PLT stub; we can refer to
7058      the functions directly.  */
7059   else if (h->needs_plt
7060 	   && (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
7061 	       || (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT
7062 		   && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)))
7063     {
7064       h->needs_plt = 0;
7065       return TRUE;
7066     }
7067 
7068   if (h->needs_plt)
7069     {
7070       /* If this is the first symbol to need a PLT entry, allocate room
7071 	 for the header, and for the header's .rela.plt.unloaded entries.  */
7072       if (htab->splt->size == 0)
7073 	{
7074 	  htab->splt->size += htab->plt_header_size;
7075 	  if (!info->shared)
7076 	    htab->srelplt2->size += 2 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
7077 	}
7078 
7079       /* Assign the next .plt entry to this symbol.  */
7080       h->plt.offset = htab->splt->size;
7081       htab->splt->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
7082 
7083       /* If the output file has no definition of the symbol, set the
7084 	 symbol's value to the address of the stub.  For executables,
7085 	 point at the PLT load stub rather than the lazy resolution stub;
7086 	 this stub will become the canonical function address.  */
7087       if (!h->def_regular)
7088 	{
7089 	  h->root.u.def.section = htab->splt;
7090 	  h->root.u.def.value = h->plt.offset;
7091 	  if (!info->shared)
7092 	    h->root.u.def.value += 8;
7093 	}
7094 
7095       /* Make room for the .got.plt entry and the R_JUMP_SLOT relocation.  */
7096       htab->sgotplt->size += 4;
7097       htab->srelplt->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
7098 
7099       /* Make room for the .rela.plt.unloaded relocations.  */
7100       if (!info->shared)
7101 	htab->srelplt2->size += 3 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
7102 
7103       return TRUE;
7104     }
7105 
7106   /* If a function symbol is defined by a dynamic object, and we do not
7107      need a PLT stub for it, the symbol's value should be zero.  */
7108   if (h->type == STT_FUNC
7109       && h->def_dynamic
7110       && h->ref_regular
7111       && !h->def_regular)
7112     {
7113       h->root.u.def.value = 0;
7114       return TRUE;
7115     }
7116 
7117   /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
7118      processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
7119      real definition first, and we can just use the same value.  */
7120   if (h->u.weakdef != NULL)
7121     {
7122       BFD_ASSERT (h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
7123 		  || h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
7124       h->root.u.def.section = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.section;
7125       h->root.u.def.value = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.value;
7126       return TRUE;
7127     }
7128 
7129   /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
7130      is not a function.  */
7131   if (info->shared)
7132     return TRUE;
7133 
7134   /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
7135      become part of the .bss section of the executable.  There will be
7136      an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section.  The dynamic
7137      object will contain position independent code, so all references
7138      from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
7139      offset table.  The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
7140      determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
7141      both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
7142      same memory location for the variable.  */
7143 
7144   if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
7145     {
7146       htab->srelbss->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
7147       h->needs_copy = 1;
7148     }
7149 
7150   return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (h, htab->sdynbss);
7151 }
7152 
7153 /* Return the number of dynamic section symbols required by OUTPUT_BFD.
7154    The number might be exact or a worst-case estimate, depending on how
7155    much information is available to elf_backend_omit_section_dynsym at
7156    the current linking stage.  */
7157 
7158 static bfd_size_type
count_section_dynsyms(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)7159 count_section_dynsyms (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
7160 {
7161   bfd_size_type count;
7162 
7163   count = 0;
7164   if (info->shared || elf_hash_table (info)->is_relocatable_executable)
7165     {
7166       asection *p;
7167       const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7168 
7169       bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
7170       for (p = output_bfd->sections; p ; p = p->next)
7171 	if ((p->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
7172 	    && (p->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
7173 	    && !(*bed->elf_backend_omit_section_dynsym) (output_bfd, info, p))
7174 	  ++count;
7175     }
7176   return count;
7177 }
7178 
7179 /* This function is called after all the input files have been read,
7180    and the input sections have been assigned to output sections.  We
7181    check for any mips16 stub sections that we can discard.  */
7182 
7183 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)7184 _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
7185 				    struct bfd_link_info *info)
7186 {
7187   asection *ri;
7188 
7189   bfd *dynobj;
7190   asection *s;
7191   struct mips_got_info *g;
7192   int i;
7193   bfd_size_type loadable_size = 0;
7194   bfd_size_type local_gotno;
7195   bfd_size_type dynsymcount;
7196   bfd *sub;
7197   struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg count_tls_arg;
7198   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
7199 
7200   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
7201 
7202   /* The .reginfo section has a fixed size.  */
7203   ri = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".reginfo");
7204   if (ri != NULL)
7205     bfd_set_section_size (output_bfd, ri, sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
7206 
7207   if (! (info->relocatable
7208 	 || ! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen))
7209     mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
7210 				 mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs, NULL);
7211 
7212   dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
7213   if (dynobj == NULL)
7214     /* Relocatable links don't have it.  */
7215     return TRUE;
7216 
7217   g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &s);
7218   if (s == NULL)
7219     return TRUE;
7220 
7221   /* Calculate the total loadable size of the output.  That
7222      will give us the maximum number of GOT_PAGE entries
7223      required.  */
7224   for (sub = info->input_bfds; sub; sub = sub->link_next)
7225     {
7226       asection *subsection;
7227 
7228       for (subsection = sub->sections;
7229 	   subsection;
7230 	   subsection = subsection->next)
7231 	{
7232 	  if ((subsection->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
7233 	    continue;
7234 	  loadable_size += ((subsection->size + 0xf)
7235 			    &~ (bfd_size_type) 0xf);
7236 	}
7237     }
7238 
7239   /* There has to be a global GOT entry for every symbol with
7240      a dynamic symbol table index of DT_MIPS_GOTSYM or
7241      higher.  Therefore, it make sense to put those symbols
7242      that need GOT entries at the end of the symbol table.  We
7243      do that here.  */
7244   if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, 1))
7245     return FALSE;
7246 
7247   if (g->global_gotsym != NULL)
7248     i = elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount - g->global_gotsym->dynindx;
7249   else
7250     /* If there are no global symbols, or none requiring
7251        relocations, then GLOBAL_GOTSYM will be NULL.  */
7252     i = 0;
7253 
7254   /* Get a worst-case estimate of the number of dynamic symbols needed.
7255      At this point, dynsymcount does not account for section symbols
7256      and count_section_dynsyms may overestimate the number that will
7257      be needed.  */
7258   dynsymcount = (elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount
7259 		 + count_section_dynsyms (output_bfd, info));
7260 
7261   /* Determine the size of one stub entry.  */
7262   htab->function_stub_size = (dynsymcount > 0x10000
7263 			      ? MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE
7264 			      : MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_NORMAL_SIZE);
7265 
7266   /* In the worst case, we'll get one stub per dynamic symbol, plus
7267      one to account for the dummy entry at the end required by IRIX
7268      rld.  */
7269   loadable_size += htab->function_stub_size * (i + 1);
7270 
7271   if (htab->is_vxworks)
7272     /* There's no need to allocate page entries for VxWorks; R_MIPS_GOT16
7273        relocations against local symbols evaluate to "G", and the EABI does
7274        not include R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE.  */
7275     local_gotno = 0;
7276   else
7277     /* Assume there are two loadable segments consisting of contiguous
7278        sections.  Is 5 enough?  */
7279     local_gotno = (loadable_size >> 16) + 5;
7280 
7281   g->local_gotno += local_gotno;
7282   s->size += g->local_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
7283 
7284   g->global_gotno = i;
7285   s->size += i * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
7286 
7287   /* We need to calculate tls_gotno for global symbols at this point
7288      instead of building it up earlier, to avoid doublecounting
7289      entries for one global symbol from multiple input files.  */
7290   count_tls_arg.info = info;
7291   count_tls_arg.needed = 0;
7292   elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info),
7293 			  mips_elf_count_global_tls_entries,
7294 			  &count_tls_arg);
7295   g->tls_gotno += count_tls_arg.needed;
7296   s->size += g->tls_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
7297 
7298   mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (g);
7299 
7300   /* VxWorks does not support multiple GOTs.  It initializes $gp to
7301      __GOTT_BASE__[__GOTT_INDEX__], the value of which is set by the
7302      dynamic loader.  */
7303   if (!htab->is_vxworks && s->size > MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (info))
7304     {
7305       if (! mips_elf_multi_got (output_bfd, info, g, s, local_gotno))
7306 	return FALSE;
7307     }
7308   else
7309     {
7310       /* Set up TLS entries for the first GOT.  */
7311       g->tls_assigned_gotno = g->global_gotno + g->local_gotno;
7312       htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_initialize_tls_index, g);
7313     }
7314 
7315   return TRUE;
7316 }
7317 
7318 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections.  */
7319 
7320 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_size_dynamic_sections(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)7321 _bfd_mips_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
7322 				     struct bfd_link_info *info)
7323 {
7324   bfd *dynobj;
7325   asection *s, *sreldyn;
7326   bfd_boolean reltext;
7327   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
7328 
7329   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
7330   dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
7331   BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL);
7332 
7333   if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
7334     {
7335       /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter.  */
7336       if (info->executable)
7337 	{
7338 	  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".interp");
7339 	  BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
7340 	  s->size
7341 	    = strlen (ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER (output_bfd)) + 1;
7342 	  s->contents
7343 	    = (bfd_byte *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER (output_bfd);
7344 	}
7345     }
7346 
7347   /* The check_relocs and adjust_dynamic_symbol entry points have
7348      determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections.  Allocate
7349      memory for them.  */
7350   reltext = FALSE;
7351   sreldyn = NULL;
7352   for (s = dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
7353     {
7354       const char *name;
7355 
7356       /* It's OK to base decisions on the section name, because none
7357 	 of the dynobj section names depend upon the input files.  */
7358       name = bfd_get_section_name (dynobj, s);
7359 
7360       if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
7361 	continue;
7362 
7363       if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".rel"))
7364 	{
7365 	  if (s->size != 0)
7366 	    {
7367 	      const char *outname;
7368 	      asection *target;
7369 
7370 	      /* If this relocation section applies to a read only
7371                  section, then we probably need a DT_TEXTREL entry.
7372                  If the relocation section is .rel(a).dyn, we always
7373                  assert a DT_TEXTREL entry rather than testing whether
7374                  there exists a relocation to a read only section or
7375                  not.  */
7376 	      outname = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd,
7377 					      s->output_section);
7378 	      target = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, outname + 4);
7379 	      if ((target != NULL
7380 		   && (target->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0
7381 		   && (target->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
7382 		  || strcmp (outname, MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info)) == 0)
7383 		reltext = TRUE;
7384 
7385 	      /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
7386 		 to copy relocs into the output file.  */
7387 	      if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info)) != 0)
7388 		s->reloc_count = 0;
7389 
7390 	      /* If combreloc is enabled, elf_link_sort_relocs() will
7391 		 sort relocations, but in a different way than we do,
7392 		 and before we're done creating relocations.  Also, it
7393 		 will move them around between input sections'
7394 		 relocation's contents, so our sorting would be
7395 		 broken, so don't let it run.  */
7396 	      info->combreloc = 0;
7397 	    }
7398 	}
7399       else if (htab->is_vxworks && strcmp (name, ".got") == 0)
7400 	{
7401 	  /* Executables do not need a GOT.  */
7402 	  if (info->shared)
7403 	    {
7404 	      /* Allocate relocations for all but the reserved entries.  */
7405 	      struct mips_got_info *g;
7406 	      unsigned int count;
7407 
7408 	      g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL);
7409 	      count = (g->global_gotno
7410 		       + g->local_gotno
7411 		       - MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info));
7412 	      mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, count);
7413 	    }
7414 	}
7415       else if (!htab->is_vxworks && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".got"))
7416 	{
7417 	  /* _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections() has already done
7418 	     most of the work, but some symbols may have been mapped
7419 	     to versions that we must now resolve in the got_entries
7420 	     hash tables.  */
7421 	  struct mips_got_info *gg = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL);
7422 	  struct mips_got_info *g = gg;
7423 	  struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg set_got_offset_arg;
7424 	  unsigned int needed_relocs = 0;
7425 
7426 	  if (gg->next)
7427 	    {
7428 	      set_got_offset_arg.value = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
7429 	      set_got_offset_arg.info = info;
7430 
7431 	      /* NOTE 2005-02-03: How can this call, or the next, ever
7432 		 find any indirect entries to resolve?  They were all
7433 		 resolved in mips_elf_multi_got.  */
7434 	      mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (gg);
7435 	      for (g = gg->next; g && g->next != gg; g = g->next)
7436 		{
7437 		  unsigned int save_assign;
7438 
7439 		  mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (g);
7440 
7441 		  /* Assign offsets to global GOT entries.  */
7442 		  save_assign = g->assigned_gotno;
7443 		  g->assigned_gotno = g->local_gotno;
7444 		  set_got_offset_arg.g = g;
7445 		  set_got_offset_arg.needed_relocs = 0;
7446 		  htab_traverse (g->got_entries,
7447 				 mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
7448 				 &set_got_offset_arg);
7449 		  needed_relocs += set_got_offset_arg.needed_relocs;
7450 		  BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_gotno - g->local_gotno
7451 			      <= g->global_gotno);
7452 
7453 		  g->assigned_gotno = save_assign;
7454 		  if (info->shared)
7455 		    {
7456 		      needed_relocs += g->local_gotno - g->assigned_gotno;
7457 		      BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_gotno == g->next->local_gotno
7458 				  + g->next->global_gotno
7459 				  + g->next->tls_gotno
7460 				  + MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info));
7461 		    }
7462 		}
7463 	    }
7464 	  else
7465 	    {
7466 	      struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg arg;
7467 	      arg.info = info;
7468 	      arg.needed = 0;
7469 
7470 	      htab_traverse (gg->got_entries, mips_elf_count_local_tls_relocs,
7471 			     &arg);
7472 	      elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info),
7473 				      mips_elf_count_global_tls_relocs,
7474 				      &arg);
7475 
7476 	      needed_relocs += arg.needed;
7477 	    }
7478 
7479 	  if (needed_relocs)
7480 	    mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info,
7481 						   needed_relocs);
7482 	}
7483       else if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (output_bfd)) == 0)
7484 	{
7485 	  /* IRIX rld assumes that the function stub isn't at the end
7486 	     of .text section.  So put a dummy.  XXX  */
7487 	  s->size += htab->function_stub_size;
7488 	}
7489       else if (! info->shared
7490 	       && ! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
7491 	       && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".rld_map"))
7492 	{
7493 	  /* We add a room for __rld_map.  It will be filled in by the
7494 	     rtld to contain a pointer to the _r_debug structure.  */
7495 	  s->size += 4;
7496 	}
7497       else if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)
7498 	       && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".compact_rel"))
7499 	s->size += mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size;
7500       else if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".init")
7501 	       && s != htab->sgotplt
7502 	       && s != htab->splt)
7503 	{
7504 	  /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space.  */
7505 	  continue;
7506 	}
7507 
7508       if (s->size == 0)
7509 	{
7510 	  s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7511 	  continue;
7512 	}
7513 
7514       if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
7515 	continue;
7516 
7517       /* Allocate memory for this section last, since we may increase its
7518 	 size above.  */
7519       if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info)) == 0)
7520 	{
7521 	  sreldyn = s;
7522 	  continue;
7523 	}
7524 
7525       /* Allocate memory for the section contents.  */
7526       s->contents = bfd_zalloc (dynobj, s->size);
7527       if (s->contents == NULL)
7528 	{
7529 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
7530 	  return FALSE;
7531 	}
7532     }
7533 
7534   /* Allocate memory for the .rel(a).dyn section.  */
7535   if (sreldyn != NULL)
7536     {
7537       sreldyn->contents = bfd_zalloc (dynobj, sreldyn->size);
7538       if (sreldyn->contents == NULL)
7539 	{
7540 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
7541 	  return FALSE;
7542 	}
7543     }
7544 
7545   if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
7546     {
7547       /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section.  We fill in the
7548 	 values later, in _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
7549 	 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
7550 	 the .dynamic section.  */
7551 
7552       /* SGI object has the equivalence of DT_DEBUG in the
7553 	 DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP entry.  This must come first because glibc
7554 	 only fills in DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP (not DT_DEBUG) and GDB only
7555 	 looks at the first one it sees.  */
7556       if (!info->shared
7557 	  && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP, 0))
7558 	return FALSE;
7559 
7560       /* The DT_DEBUG entry may be filled in by the dynamic linker and
7561 	 used by the debugger.  */
7562       if (info->executable
7563 	  && !SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)
7564 	  && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_DEBUG, 0))
7565 	return FALSE;
7566 
7567       if (reltext && (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd) || htab->is_vxworks))
7568 	info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
7569 
7570       if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
7571 	{
7572 	  if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_TEXTREL, 0))
7573 	    return FALSE;
7574 
7575 	  /* Clear the DF_TEXTREL flag.  It will be set again if we
7576 	     write out an actual text relocation; we may not, because
7577 	     at this point we do not know whether e.g. any .eh_frame
7578 	     absolute relocations have been converted to PC-relative.  */
7579 	  info->flags &= ~DF_TEXTREL;
7580 	}
7581 
7582       if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTGOT, 0))
7583 	return FALSE;
7584 
7585       if (htab->is_vxworks)
7586 	{
7587 	  /* VxWorks uses .rela.dyn instead of .rel.dyn.  It does not
7588 	     use any of the DT_MIPS_* tags.  */
7589 	  if (mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE))
7590 	    {
7591 	      if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELA, 0))
7592 		return FALSE;
7593 
7594 	      if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELASZ, 0))
7595 		return FALSE;
7596 
7597 	      if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELAENT, 0))
7598 		return FALSE;
7599 	    }
7600 	  if (htab->splt->size > 0)
7601 	    {
7602 	      if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTREL, 0))
7603 		return FALSE;
7604 
7605 	      if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_JMPREL, 0))
7606 		return FALSE;
7607 
7608 	      if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTRELSZ, 0))
7609 		return FALSE;
7610 	    }
7611 	}
7612       else
7613 	{
7614 	  if (mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE))
7615 	    {
7616 	      if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_REL, 0))
7617 		return FALSE;
7618 
7619 	      if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELSZ, 0))
7620 		return FALSE;
7621 
7622 	      if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELENT, 0))
7623 		return FALSE;
7624 	    }
7625 
7626 	  if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION, 0))
7627 	    return FALSE;
7628 
7629 	  if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_FLAGS, 0))
7630 	    return FALSE;
7631 
7632 	  if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS, 0))
7633 	    return FALSE;
7634 
7635 	  if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO, 0))
7636 	    return FALSE;
7637 
7638 	  if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO, 0))
7639 	    return FALSE;
7640 
7641 	  if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO, 0))
7642 	    return FALSE;
7643 
7644 	  if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_GOTSYM, 0))
7645 	    return FALSE;
7646 
7647 	  if (IRIX_COMPAT (dynobj) == ict_irix5
7648 	      && ! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO, 0))
7649 	    return FALSE;
7650 
7651 	  if (IRIX_COMPAT (dynobj) == ict_irix6
7652 	      && (bfd_get_section_by_name
7653 		  (dynobj, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (dynobj)))
7654 	      && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_OPTIONS, 0))
7655 	    return FALSE;
7656 	}
7657     }
7658 
7659   return TRUE;
7660 }
7661 
7662 /* REL is a relocation in INPUT_BFD that is being copied to OUTPUT_BFD.
7663    Adjust its R_ADDEND field so that it is correct for the output file.
7664    LOCAL_SYMS and LOCAL_SECTIONS are arrays of INPUT_BFD's local symbols
7665    and sections respectively; both use symbol indexes.  */
7666 
7667 static void
mips_elf_adjust_addend(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd * input_bfd,Elf_Internal_Sym * local_syms,asection ** local_sections,Elf_Internal_Rela * rel)7668 mips_elf_adjust_addend (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
7669 			bfd *input_bfd, Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
7670 			asection **local_sections, Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
7671 {
7672   unsigned int r_type, r_symndx;
7673   Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7674   asection *sec;
7675 
7676   if (mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel, local_sections, FALSE))
7677     {
7678       r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
7679       if (r_type == R_MIPS16_GPREL
7680 	  || r_type == R_MIPS_GPREL16
7681 	  || r_type == R_MIPS_GPREL32
7682 	  || r_type == R_MIPS_LITERAL)
7683 	{
7684 	  rel->r_addend += _bfd_get_gp_value (input_bfd);
7685 	  rel->r_addend -= _bfd_get_gp_value (output_bfd);
7686 	}
7687 
7688       r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
7689       sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
7690 
7691       /* Adjust REL's addend to account for section merging.  */
7692       if (!info->relocatable)
7693 	{
7694 	  sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
7695 	  _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
7696 	}
7697 
7698       /* This would normally be done by the rela_normal code in elflink.c.  */
7699       if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
7700 	rel->r_addend += local_sections[r_symndx]->output_offset;
7701     }
7702 }
7703 
7704 /* Relocate a MIPS ELF section.  */
7705 
7706 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_relocate_section(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd * input_bfd,asection * input_section,bfd_byte * contents,Elf_Internal_Rela * relocs,Elf_Internal_Sym * local_syms,asection ** local_sections)7707 _bfd_mips_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
7708 				bfd *input_bfd, asection *input_section,
7709 				bfd_byte *contents, Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
7710 				Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
7711 				asection **local_sections)
7712 {
7713   Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
7714   const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
7715   bfd_vma addend = 0;
7716   bfd_boolean use_saved_addend_p = FALSE;
7717   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7718 
7719   bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
7720   relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
7721   for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; ++rel)
7722     {
7723       const char *name;
7724       bfd_vma value = 0;
7725       reloc_howto_type *howto;
7726       bfd_boolean require_jalx;
7727       /* TRUE if the relocation is a RELA relocation, rather than a
7728          REL relocation.  */
7729       bfd_boolean rela_relocation_p = TRUE;
7730       unsigned int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
7731       const char *msg;
7732       unsigned long r_symndx;
7733       asection *sec;
7734       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7735       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7736 
7737       /* Find the relocation howto for this relocation.  */
7738       howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, r_type,
7739 				       NEWABI_P (input_bfd)
7740 				       && (MIPS_RELOC_RELA_P
7741 					   (input_bfd, input_section,
7742 					    rel - relocs)));
7743 
7744       r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, rel->r_info);
7745       symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
7746       if (mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel, local_sections, FALSE))
7747 	{
7748 	  sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
7749 	  h = NULL;
7750 	}
7751       else
7752 	{
7753 	  unsigned long extsymoff;
7754 
7755 	  extsymoff = 0;
7756 	  if (!elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd))
7757 	    extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7758 	  h = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff];
7759 	  while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
7760 		 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
7761 	    h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
7762 
7763 	  sec = NULL;
7764 	  if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
7765 	      || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
7766 	    sec = h->root.u.def.section;
7767 	}
7768 
7769       if (sec != NULL && elf_discarded_section (sec))
7770 	{
7771 	  /* For relocs against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
7772 	     or sections discarded by a linker script, we just want the
7773 	     section contents zeroed.  Avoid any special processing.  */
7774 	  _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7775 	  rel->r_info = 0;
7776 	  rel->r_addend = 0;
7777 	  continue;
7778 	}
7779 
7780       if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (input_bfd))
7781 	{
7782 	  /* Some 32-bit code uses R_MIPS_64.  In particular, people use
7783 	     64-bit code, but make sure all their addresses are in the
7784 	     lowermost or uppermost 32-bit section of the 64-bit address
7785 	     space.  Thus, when they use an R_MIPS_64 they mean what is
7786 	     usually meant by R_MIPS_32, with the exception that the
7787 	     stored value is sign-extended to 64 bits.  */
7788 	  howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, R_MIPS_32, FALSE);
7789 
7790 	  /* On big-endian systems, we need to lie about the position
7791 	     of the reloc.  */
7792 	  if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
7793 	    rel->r_offset += 4;
7794 	}
7795 
7796       if (!use_saved_addend_p)
7797 	{
7798 	  Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
7799 
7800 	  /* If these relocations were originally of the REL variety,
7801 	     we must pull the addend out of the field that will be
7802 	     relocated.  Otherwise, we simply use the contents of the
7803 	     RELA relocation.  To determine which flavor or relocation
7804 	     this is, we depend on the fact that the INPUT_SECTION's
7805 	     REL_HDR is read before its REL_HDR2.  */
7806 	  rel_hdr = &elf_section_data (input_section)->rel_hdr;
7807 	  if ((size_t) (rel - relocs)
7808 	      >= (NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (rel_hdr) * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel))
7809 	    rel_hdr = elf_section_data (input_section)->rel_hdr2;
7810 	  if (rel_hdr->sh_entsize == MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (input_bfd))
7811 	    {
7812 	      bfd_byte *location = contents + rel->r_offset;
7813 
7814 	      /* Note that this is a REL relocation.  */
7815 	      rela_relocation_p = FALSE;
7816 
7817 	      /* Get the addend, which is stored in the input file.  */
7818 	      _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (input_bfd, r_type, FALSE,
7819 					       location);
7820 	      addend = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, rel, input_bfd,
7821 						 contents);
7822 	      _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle(input_bfd, r_type, FALSE,
7823 					    location);
7824 
7825 	      addend &= howto->src_mask;
7826 
7827 	      /* For some kinds of relocations, the ADDEND is a
7828 		 combination of the addend stored in two different
7829 		 relocations.   */
7830 	      if (r_type == R_MIPS_HI16 || r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16
7831 		  || (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16
7832 		      && mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel,
7833 						      local_sections, FALSE)))
7834 		{
7835 		  const Elf_Internal_Rela *lo16_relocation;
7836 		  reloc_howto_type *lo16_howto;
7837 		  int lo16_type;
7838 
7839 		  if (r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16)
7840 		    lo16_type = R_MIPS16_LO16;
7841 		  else
7842 		    lo16_type = R_MIPS_LO16;
7843 
7844 		  /* The combined value is the sum of the HI16 addend,
7845 		     left-shifted by sixteen bits, and the LO16
7846 		     addend, sign extended.  (Usually, the code does
7847 		     a `lui' of the HI16 value, and then an `addiu' of
7848 		     the LO16 value.)
7849 
7850 		     Scan ahead to find a matching LO16 relocation.
7851 
7852 		     According to the MIPS ELF ABI, the R_MIPS_LO16
7853 		     relocation must be immediately following.
7854 		     However, for the IRIX6 ABI, the next relocation
7855 		     may be a composed relocation consisting of
7856 		     several relocations for the same address.  In
7857 		     that case, the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation may occur
7858 		     as one of these.  We permit a similar extension
7859 		     in general, as that is useful for GCC.
7860 
7861 		     In some cases GCC dead code elimination removes
7862 		     the LO16 but keeps the corresponding HI16.  This
7863 		     is strictly speaking a violation of the ABI but
7864 		     not immediately harmful.  */
7865 		  lo16_relocation = mips_elf_next_relocation (input_bfd,
7866 							      lo16_type,
7867 							      rel, relend);
7868 		  if (lo16_relocation == NULL)
7869 		    {
7870 		      const char *name;
7871 
7872 		      if (h)
7873 			name = h->root.root.string;
7874 		      else
7875 			name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr,
7876 						 local_syms + r_symndx,
7877 						 sec);
7878 		      (*_bfd_error_handler)
7879 			(_("%B: Can't find matching LO16 reloc against `%s' for %s at 0x%lx in section `%A'"),
7880 			 input_bfd, input_section, name, howto->name,
7881 			 rel->r_offset);
7882 		    }
7883 		  else
7884 		    {
7885 		      bfd_byte *lo16_location;
7886 		      bfd_vma l;
7887 
7888 		      lo16_location = contents + lo16_relocation->r_offset;
7889 
7890 		      /* Obtain the addend kept there.  */
7891 		      lo16_howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd,
7892 							    lo16_type, FALSE);
7893 		      _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (input_bfd, lo16_type,
7894 						       FALSE, lo16_location);
7895 		      l = mips_elf_obtain_contents (lo16_howto,
7896 						    lo16_relocation,
7897 						    input_bfd, contents);
7898 		      _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (input_bfd, lo16_type,
7899 						     FALSE, lo16_location);
7900 		      l &= lo16_howto->src_mask;
7901 		      l <<= lo16_howto->rightshift;
7902 		      l = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (l, 16);
7903 
7904 		      addend <<= 16;
7905 
7906 		      /* Compute the combined addend.  */
7907 		      addend += l;
7908 		    }
7909 		}
7910 	      else
7911 		addend <<= howto->rightshift;
7912 	    }
7913 	  else
7914 	    addend = rel->r_addend;
7915 	  mips_elf_adjust_addend (output_bfd, info, input_bfd,
7916 				  local_syms, local_sections, rel);
7917 	}
7918 
7919       if (info->relocatable)
7920 	{
7921 	  if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd)
7922 	      && bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
7923 	    rel->r_offset -= 4;
7924 
7925 	  if (!rela_relocation_p && rel->r_addend)
7926 	    {
7927 	      addend += rel->r_addend;
7928 	      if (r_type == R_MIPS_HI16
7929 		  || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16)
7930 		addend = mips_elf_high (addend);
7931 	      else if (r_type == R_MIPS_HIGHER)
7932 		addend = mips_elf_higher (addend);
7933 	      else if (r_type == R_MIPS_HIGHEST)
7934 		addend = mips_elf_highest (addend);
7935 	      else
7936 		addend >>= howto->rightshift;
7937 
7938 	      /* We use the source mask, rather than the destination
7939 		 mask because the place to which we are writing will be
7940 		 source of the addend in the final link.  */
7941 	      addend &= howto->src_mask;
7942 
7943 	      if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
7944 		/* See the comment above about using R_MIPS_64 in the 32-bit
7945 		   ABI.  Here, we need to update the addend.  It would be
7946 		   possible to get away with just using the R_MIPS_32 reloc
7947 		   but for endianness.  */
7948 		{
7949 		  bfd_vma sign_bits;
7950 		  bfd_vma low_bits;
7951 		  bfd_vma high_bits;
7952 
7953 		  if (addend & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31))
7954 #ifdef BFD64
7955 		    sign_bits = ((bfd_vma) 1 << 32) - 1;
7956 #else
7957 		    sign_bits = -1;
7958 #endif
7959 		  else
7960 		    sign_bits = 0;
7961 
7962 		  /* If we don't know that we have a 64-bit type,
7963 		     do two separate stores.  */
7964 		  if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
7965 		    {
7966 		      /* Store the sign-bits (which are most significant)
7967 			 first.  */
7968 		      low_bits = sign_bits;
7969 		      high_bits = addend;
7970 		    }
7971 		  else
7972 		    {
7973 		      low_bits = addend;
7974 		      high_bits = sign_bits;
7975 		    }
7976 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, low_bits,
7977 			      contents + rel->r_offset);
7978 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, high_bits,
7979 			      contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
7980 		  continue;
7981 		}
7982 
7983 	      if (! mips_elf_perform_relocation (info, howto, rel, addend,
7984 						 input_bfd, input_section,
7985 						 contents, FALSE))
7986 		return FALSE;
7987 	    }
7988 
7989 	  /* Go on to the next relocation.  */
7990 	  continue;
7991 	}
7992 
7993       /* In the N32 and 64-bit ABIs there may be multiple consecutive
7994 	 relocations for the same offset.  In that case we are
7995 	 supposed to treat the output of each relocation as the addend
7996 	 for the next.  */
7997       if (rel + 1 < relend
7998 	  && rel->r_offset == rel[1].r_offset
7999 	  && ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, rel[1].r_info) != R_MIPS_NONE)
8000 	use_saved_addend_p = TRUE;
8001       else
8002 	use_saved_addend_p = FALSE;
8003 
8004       /* Figure out what value we are supposed to relocate.  */
8005       switch (mips_elf_calculate_relocation (output_bfd, input_bfd,
8006 					     input_section, info, rel,
8007 					     addend, howto, local_syms,
8008 					     local_sections, &value,
8009 					     &name, &require_jalx,
8010 					     use_saved_addend_p))
8011 	{
8012 	case bfd_reloc_continue:
8013 	  /* There's nothing to do.  */
8014 	  continue;
8015 
8016 	case bfd_reloc_undefined:
8017 	  /* mips_elf_calculate_relocation already called the
8018 	     undefined_symbol callback.  There's no real point in
8019 	     trying to perform the relocation at this point, so we
8020 	     just skip ahead to the next relocation.  */
8021 	  continue;
8022 
8023 	case bfd_reloc_notsupported:
8024 	  msg = _("internal error: unsupported relocation error");
8025 	  info->callbacks->warning
8026 	    (info, msg, name, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
8027 	  return FALSE;
8028 
8029 	case bfd_reloc_overflow:
8030 	  if (use_saved_addend_p)
8031 	    /* Ignore overflow until we reach the last relocation for
8032 	       a given location.  */
8033 	    ;
8034 	  else
8035 	    {
8036 	      BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL);
8037 	      if (! ((*info->callbacks->reloc_overflow)
8038 		     (info, NULL, name, howto->name, (bfd_vma) 0,
8039 		      input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset)))
8040 		return FALSE;
8041 	    }
8042 	  break;
8043 
8044 	case bfd_reloc_ok:
8045 	  break;
8046 
8047 	default:
8048 	  abort ();
8049 	  break;
8050 	}
8051 
8052       /* If we've got another relocation for the address, keep going
8053 	 until we reach the last one.  */
8054       if (use_saved_addend_p)
8055 	{
8056 	  addend = value;
8057 	  continue;
8058 	}
8059 
8060       if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
8061 	/* See the comment above about using R_MIPS_64 in the 32-bit
8062 	   ABI.  Until now, we've been using the HOWTO for R_MIPS_32;
8063 	   that calculated the right value.  Now, however, we
8064 	   sign-extend the 32-bit result to 64-bits, and store it as a
8065 	   64-bit value.  We are especially generous here in that we
8066 	   go to extreme lengths to support this usage on systems with
8067 	   only a 32-bit VMA.  */
8068 	{
8069 	  bfd_vma sign_bits;
8070 	  bfd_vma low_bits;
8071 	  bfd_vma high_bits;
8072 
8073 	  if (value & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31))
8074 #ifdef BFD64
8075 	    sign_bits = ((bfd_vma) 1 << 32) - 1;
8076 #else
8077 	    sign_bits = -1;
8078 #endif
8079 	  else
8080 	    sign_bits = 0;
8081 
8082 	  /* If we don't know that we have a 64-bit type,
8083 	     do two separate stores.  */
8084 	  if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
8085 	    {
8086 	      /* Undo what we did above.  */
8087 	      rel->r_offset -= 4;
8088 	      /* Store the sign-bits (which are most significant)
8089 		 first.  */
8090 	      low_bits = sign_bits;
8091 	      high_bits = value;
8092 	    }
8093 	  else
8094 	    {
8095 	      low_bits = value;
8096 	      high_bits = sign_bits;
8097 	    }
8098 	  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, low_bits,
8099 		      contents + rel->r_offset);
8100 	  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, high_bits,
8101 		      contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
8102 	  continue;
8103 	}
8104 
8105       /* Actually perform the relocation.  */
8106       if (! mips_elf_perform_relocation (info, howto, rel, value,
8107 					 input_bfd, input_section,
8108 					 contents, require_jalx))
8109 	return FALSE;
8110     }
8111 
8112   return TRUE;
8113 }
8114 
8115 /* If NAME is one of the special IRIX6 symbols defined by the linker,
8116    adjust it appropriately now.  */
8117 
8118 static void
mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const char * name,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym)8119 mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8120 				      const char *name, Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
8121 {
8122   /* The linker script takes care of providing names and values for
8123      these, but we must place them into the right sections.  */
8124   static const char* const text_section_symbols[] = {
8125     "_ftext",
8126     "_etext",
8127     "__dso_displacement",
8128     "__elf_header",
8129     "__program_header_table",
8130     NULL
8131   };
8132 
8133   static const char* const data_section_symbols[] = {
8134     "_fdata",
8135     "_edata",
8136     "_end",
8137     "_fbss",
8138     NULL
8139   };
8140 
8141   const char* const *p;
8142   int i;
8143 
8144   for (i = 0; i < 2; ++i)
8145     for (p = (i == 0) ? text_section_symbols : data_section_symbols;
8146 	 *p;
8147 	 ++p)
8148       if (strcmp (*p, name) == 0)
8149 	{
8150 	  /* All of these symbols are given type STT_SECTION by the
8151 	     IRIX6 linker.  */
8152 	  sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8153 	  sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
8154 
8155 	  /* The IRIX linker puts these symbols in special sections.  */
8156 	  if (i == 0)
8157 	    sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_TEXT;
8158 	  else
8159 	    sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
8160 
8161 	  break;
8162 	}
8163 }
8164 
8165 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling.  We set the contents of various
8166    dynamic sections here.  */
8167 
8168 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym)8169 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
8170 				     struct bfd_link_info *info,
8171 				     struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
8172 				     Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
8173 {
8174   bfd *dynobj;
8175   asection *sgot;
8176   struct mips_got_info *g, *gg;
8177   const char *name;
8178   int idx;
8179   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8180 
8181   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8182   dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
8183 
8184   if (h->plt.offset != MINUS_ONE)
8185     {
8186       asection *s;
8187       bfd_byte stub[MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE];
8188 
8189       /* This symbol has a stub.  Set it up.  */
8190 
8191       BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
8192 
8193       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj,
8194 				   MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj));
8195       BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
8196 
8197       BFD_ASSERT ((htab->function_stub_size == MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE)
8198                   || (h->dynindx <= 0xffff));
8199 
8200       /* Values up to 2^31 - 1 are allowed.  Larger values would cause
8201 	 sign extension at runtime in the stub, resulting in a negative
8202 	 index value.  */
8203       if (h->dynindx & ~0x7fffffff)
8204 	return FALSE;
8205 
8206       /* Fill the stub.  */
8207       idx = 0;
8208       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LW (output_bfd), stub + idx);
8209       idx += 4;
8210       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_MOVE (output_bfd), stub + idx);
8211       idx += 4;
8212       if (htab->function_stub_size == MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE)
8213         {
8214           bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LUI ((h->dynindx >> 16) & 0x7fff),
8215                       stub + idx);
8216           idx += 4;
8217         }
8218       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_JALR, stub + idx);
8219       idx += 4;
8220 
8221       /* If a large stub is not required and sign extension is not a
8222          problem, then use legacy code in the stub.  */
8223       if (htab->function_stub_size == MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE)
8224 	bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_ORI (h->dynindx & 0xffff), stub + idx);
8225       else if (h->dynindx & ~0x7fff)
8226         bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LI16U (h->dynindx & 0xffff), stub + idx);
8227       else
8228         bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LI16S (output_bfd, h->dynindx),
8229 		    stub + idx);
8230 
8231       BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.offset <= s->size);
8232       memcpy (s->contents + h->plt.offset, stub, htab->function_stub_size);
8233 
8234       /* Mark the symbol as undefined.  plt.offset != -1 occurs
8235 	 only for the referenced symbol.  */
8236       sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
8237 
8238       /* The run-time linker uses the st_value field of the symbol
8239 	 to reset the global offset table entry for this external
8240 	 to its stub address when unlinking a shared object.  */
8241       sym->st_value = (s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset
8242 		       + h->plt.offset);
8243     }
8244 
8245   BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1
8246 	      || h->forced_local);
8247 
8248   sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
8249   BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL);
8250   BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
8251   g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
8252   BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
8253 
8254   /* Run through the global symbol table, creating GOT entries for all
8255      the symbols that need them.  */
8256   if (g->global_gotsym != NULL
8257       && h->dynindx >= g->global_gotsym->dynindx)
8258     {
8259       bfd_vma offset;
8260       bfd_vma value;
8261 
8262       value = sym->st_value;
8263       offset = mips_elf_global_got_index (dynobj, output_bfd, h, R_MIPS_GOT16, info);
8264       MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, value, sgot->contents + offset);
8265     }
8266 
8267   if (g->next && h->dynindx != -1 && h->type != STT_TLS)
8268     {
8269       struct mips_got_entry e, *p;
8270       bfd_vma entry;
8271       bfd_vma offset;
8272 
8273       gg = g;
8274 
8275       e.abfd = output_bfd;
8276       e.symndx = -1;
8277       e.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h;
8278       e.tls_type = 0;
8279 
8280       for (g = g->next; g->next != gg; g = g->next)
8281 	{
8282 	  if (g->got_entries
8283 	      && (p = (struct mips_got_entry *) htab_find (g->got_entries,
8284 							   &e)))
8285 	    {
8286 	      offset = p->gotidx;
8287 	      if (info->shared
8288 		  || (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created
8289 		      && p->d.h != NULL
8290 		      && p->d.h->root.def_dynamic
8291 		      && !p->d.h->root.def_regular))
8292 		{
8293 		  /* Create an R_MIPS_REL32 relocation for this entry.  Due to
8294 		     the various compatibility problems, it's easier to mock
8295 		     up an R_MIPS_32 or R_MIPS_64 relocation and leave
8296 		     mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation to calculate the
8297 		     appropriate addend.  */
8298 		  Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
8299 
8300 		  memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
8301 		  if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
8302 		    rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_64);
8303 		  else
8304 		    rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_32);
8305 		  rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset = offset;
8306 
8307 		  entry = 0;
8308 		  if (! (mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
8309 			 (output_bfd, info, rel,
8310 			  e.d.h, NULL, sym->st_value, &entry, sgot)))
8311 		    return FALSE;
8312 		}
8313 	      else
8314 		entry = sym->st_value;
8315 	      MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, entry, sgot->contents + offset);
8316 	    }
8317 	}
8318     }
8319 
8320   /* Mark _DYNAMIC and _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ as absolute.  */
8321   name = h->root.root.string;
8322   if (strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC") == 0
8323       || h == elf_hash_table (info)->hgot)
8324     sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
8325   else if (strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC_LINK") == 0
8326 	   || strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC_LINKING") == 0)
8327     {
8328       sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
8329       sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8330       sym->st_value = 1;
8331     }
8332   else if (strcmp (name, "_gp_disp") == 0 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
8333     {
8334       sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
8335       sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8336       sym->st_value = elf_gp (output_bfd);
8337     }
8338   else if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
8339     {
8340       if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[0]) == 0
8341 	  || strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[1]) == 0)
8342 	{
8343 	  sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8344 	  sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
8345 	  sym->st_value = 0;
8346 	  sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
8347 	}
8348       else if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[2]) == 0)
8349 	{
8350 	  sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8351 	  sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
8352 	  sym->st_value = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count;
8353 	  sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
8354 	}
8355       else if (sym->st_shndx != SHN_UNDEF && sym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)
8356 	{
8357 	  if (h->type == STT_FUNC)
8358 	    sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_TEXT;
8359 	  else if (h->type == STT_OBJECT)
8360 	    sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
8361 	}
8362     }
8363 
8364   /* Handle the IRIX6-specific symbols.  */
8365   if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix6)
8366     mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol (output_bfd, name, sym);
8367 
8368   if (! info->shared)
8369     {
8370       if (! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
8371 	  && (strcmp (name, "__rld_map") == 0
8372 	      || strcmp (name, "__RLD_MAP") == 0))
8373 	{
8374 	  asection *s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".rld_map");
8375 	  BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
8376 	  sym->st_value = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
8377 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0, s->contents);
8378 	  if (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value == 0)
8379 	    mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value = sym->st_value;
8380 	}
8381       else if (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
8382 	       && strcmp (name, "__rld_obj_head") == 0)
8383 	{
8384 	  /* IRIX6 does not use a .rld_map section.  */
8385 	  if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix5
8386               || IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_none)
8387 	    BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".rld_map")
8388 			!= NULL);
8389 	  mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value = sym->st_value;
8390 	}
8391     }
8392 
8393   /* If this is a mips16 symbol, force the value to be even.  */
8394   if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
8395     sym->st_value &= ~1;
8396 
8397   return TRUE;
8398 }
8399 
8400 /* Likewise, for VxWorks.  */
8401 
8402 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_vxworks_finish_dynamic_symbol(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym)8403 _bfd_mips_vxworks_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
8404 					 struct bfd_link_info *info,
8405 					 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
8406 					 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
8407 {
8408   bfd *dynobj;
8409   asection *sgot;
8410   struct mips_got_info *g;
8411   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8412 
8413   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8414   dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
8415 
8416   if (h->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
8417     {
8418       bfd_byte *loc;
8419       bfd_vma plt_address, plt_index, got_address, got_offset, branch_offset;
8420       Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
8421       static const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
8422 
8423       BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
8424       BFD_ASSERT (htab->splt != NULL);
8425       BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.offset <= htab->splt->size);
8426 
8427       /* Calculate the address of the .plt entry.  */
8428       plt_address = (htab->splt->output_section->vma
8429 		     + htab->splt->output_offset
8430 		     + h->plt.offset);
8431 
8432       /* Calculate the index of the entry.  */
8433       plt_index = ((h->plt.offset - htab->plt_header_size)
8434 		   / htab->plt_entry_size);
8435 
8436       /* Calculate the address of the .got.plt entry.  */
8437       got_address = (htab->sgotplt->output_section->vma
8438 		     + htab->sgotplt->output_offset
8439 		     + plt_index * 4);
8440 
8441       /* Calculate the offset of the .got.plt entry from
8442 	 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_.  */
8443       got_offset = mips_elf_gotplt_index (info, h);
8444 
8445       /* Calculate the offset for the branch at the start of the PLT
8446 	 entry.  The branch jumps to the beginning of .plt.  */
8447       branch_offset = -(h->plt.offset / 4 + 1) & 0xffff;
8448 
8449       /* Fill in the initial value of the .got.plt entry.  */
8450       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_address,
8451 		  htab->sgotplt->contents + plt_index * 4);
8452 
8453       /* Find out where the .plt entry should go.  */
8454       loc = htab->splt->contents + h->plt.offset;
8455 
8456       if (info->shared)
8457 	{
8458 	  plt_entry = mips_vxworks_shared_plt_entry;
8459 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | branch_offset, loc);
8460 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | plt_index, loc + 4);
8461 	}
8462       else
8463 	{
8464 	  bfd_vma got_address_high, got_address_low;
8465 
8466 	  plt_entry = mips_vxworks_exec_plt_entry;
8467 	  got_address_high = ((got_address + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
8468 	  got_address_low = got_address & 0xffff;
8469 
8470 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | branch_offset, loc);
8471 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | plt_index, loc + 4);
8472 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2] | got_address_high, loc + 8);
8473 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3] | got_address_low, loc + 12);
8474 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 16);
8475 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], loc + 20);
8476 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], loc + 24);
8477 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], loc + 28);
8478 
8479 	  loc = (htab->srelplt2->contents
8480 		 + (plt_index * 3 + 2) * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
8481 
8482 	  /* Emit a relocation for the .got.plt entry.  */
8483 	  rel.r_offset = got_address;
8484 	  rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hplt->indx, R_MIPS_32);
8485 	  rel.r_addend = h->plt.offset;
8486 	  bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8487 
8488 	  /* Emit a relocation for the lui of %hi(<.got.plt slot>).  */
8489 	  loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8490 	  rel.r_offset = plt_address + 8;
8491 	  rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_HI16);
8492 	  rel.r_addend = got_offset;
8493 	  bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8494 
8495 	  /* Emit a relocation for the addiu of %lo(<.got.plt slot>).  */
8496 	  loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8497 	  rel.r_offset += 4;
8498 	  rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_LO16);
8499 	  bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8500 	}
8501 
8502       /* Emit an R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT relocation against the .got.plt entry.  */
8503       loc = htab->srelplt->contents + plt_index * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8504       rel.r_offset = got_address;
8505       rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT);
8506       rel.r_addend = 0;
8507       bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8508 
8509       if (!h->def_regular)
8510 	sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
8511     }
8512 
8513   BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1 || h->forced_local);
8514 
8515   sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
8516   BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL);
8517   BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
8518   g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
8519   BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
8520 
8521   /* See if this symbol has an entry in the GOT.  */
8522   if (g->global_gotsym != NULL
8523       && h->dynindx >= g->global_gotsym->dynindx)
8524     {
8525       bfd_vma offset;
8526       Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
8527       bfd_byte *loc;
8528       asection *s;
8529 
8530       /* Install the symbol value in the GOT.   */
8531       offset = mips_elf_global_got_index (dynobj, output_bfd, h,
8532 					  R_MIPS_GOT16, info);
8533       MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, sym->st_value, sgot->contents + offset);
8534 
8535       /* Add a dynamic relocation for it.  */
8536       s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
8537       loc = s->contents + (s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
8538       outrel.r_offset = (sgot->output_section->vma
8539 			 + sgot->output_offset
8540 			 + offset);
8541       outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_MIPS_32);
8542       outrel.r_addend = 0;
8543       bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (dynobj, &outrel, loc);
8544     }
8545 
8546   /* Emit a copy reloc, if needed.  */
8547   if (h->needs_copy)
8548     {
8549       Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
8550 
8551       BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
8552 
8553       rel.r_offset = (h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
8554 		      + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
8555 		      + h->root.u.def.value);
8556       rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_MIPS_COPY);
8557       rel.r_addend = 0;
8558       bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel,
8559 				 htab->srelbss->contents
8560 				 + (htab->srelbss->reloc_count
8561 				    * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)));
8562       ++htab->srelbss->reloc_count;
8563     }
8564 
8565   /* If this is a mips16 symbol, force the value to be even.  */
8566   if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
8567     sym->st_value &= ~1;
8568 
8569   return TRUE;
8570 }
8571 
8572 /* Install the PLT header for a VxWorks executable and finalize the
8573    contents of .rela.plt.unloaded.  */
8574 
8575 static void
mips_vxworks_finish_exec_plt(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)8576 mips_vxworks_finish_exec_plt (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
8577 {
8578   Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
8579   bfd_byte *loc;
8580   bfd_vma got_value, got_value_high, got_value_low, plt_address;
8581   static const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
8582   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8583 
8584   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8585   plt_entry = mips_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry;
8586 
8587   /* Calculate the value of _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_.  */
8588   got_value = (htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
8589 	       + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_offset
8590 	       + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.value);
8591 
8592   got_value_high = ((got_value + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
8593   got_value_low = got_value & 0xffff;
8594 
8595   /* Calculate the address of the PLT header.  */
8596   plt_address = htab->splt->output_section->vma + htab->splt->output_offset;
8597 
8598   /* Install the PLT header.  */
8599   loc = htab->splt->contents;
8600   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | got_value_high, loc);
8601   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | got_value_low, loc + 4);
8602   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], loc + 8);
8603   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], loc + 12);
8604   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 16);
8605   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], loc + 20);
8606 
8607   /* Output the relocation for the lui of %hi(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_).  */
8608   loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
8609   rela.r_offset = plt_address;
8610   rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_HI16);
8611   rela.r_addend = 0;
8612   bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
8613   loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8614 
8615   /* Output the relocation for the following addiu of
8616      %lo(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_).  */
8617   rela.r_offset += 4;
8618   rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_LO16);
8619   bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
8620   loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8621 
8622   /* Fix up the remaining relocations.  They may have the wrong
8623      symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
8624      in which symbols were output.  */
8625   while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
8626     {
8627       Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
8628 
8629       bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
8630       rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hplt->indx, R_MIPS_32);
8631       bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8632       loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8633 
8634       bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
8635       rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_HI16);
8636       bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8637       loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8638 
8639       bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
8640       rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_LO16);
8641       bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8642       loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8643     }
8644 }
8645 
8646 /* Install the PLT header for a VxWorks shared library.  */
8647 
8648 static void
mips_vxworks_finish_shared_plt(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)8649 mips_vxworks_finish_shared_plt (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
8650 {
8651   unsigned int i;
8652   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8653 
8654   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8655 
8656   /* We just need to copy the entry byte-by-byte.  */
8657   for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry); i++)
8658     bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry[i],
8659 		htab->splt->contents + i * 4);
8660 }
8661 
8662 /* Finish up the dynamic sections.  */
8663 
8664 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)8665 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
8666 				       struct bfd_link_info *info)
8667 {
8668   bfd *dynobj;
8669   asection *sdyn;
8670   asection *sgot;
8671   struct mips_got_info *gg, *g;
8672   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8673 
8674   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8675   dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
8676 
8677   sdyn = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".dynamic");
8678 
8679   sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
8680   if (sgot == NULL)
8681     gg = g = NULL;
8682   else
8683     {
8684       BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
8685       gg = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
8686       BFD_ASSERT (gg != NULL);
8687       g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, output_bfd);
8688       BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
8689     }
8690 
8691   if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
8692     {
8693       bfd_byte *b;
8694       int dyn_to_skip = 0, dyn_skipped = 0;
8695 
8696       BFD_ASSERT (sdyn != NULL);
8697       BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
8698 
8699       for (b = sdyn->contents;
8700 	   b < sdyn->contents + sdyn->size;
8701 	   b += MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj))
8702 	{
8703 	  Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
8704 	  const char *name;
8705 	  size_t elemsize;
8706 	  asection *s;
8707 	  bfd_boolean swap_out_p;
8708 
8709 	  /* Read in the current dynamic entry.  */
8710 	  (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_in) (dynobj, b, &dyn);
8711 
8712 	  /* Assume that we're going to modify it and write it out.  */
8713 	  swap_out_p = TRUE;
8714 
8715 	  switch (dyn.d_tag)
8716 	    {
8717 	    case DT_RELENT:
8718 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (dynobj);
8719 	      break;
8720 
8721 	    case DT_RELAENT:
8722 	      BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
8723 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE (dynobj);
8724 	      break;
8725 
8726 	    case DT_STRSZ:
8727 	      /* Rewrite DT_STRSZ.  */
8728 	      dyn.d_un.d_val =
8729 		_bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr);
8730 	      break;
8731 
8732 	    case DT_PLTGOT:
8733 	      name = ".got";
8734 	      if (htab->is_vxworks)
8735 		{
8736 		  /* _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ is defined to be the beginning
8737 		     of the ".got" section in DYNOBJ.  */
8738 		  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, name);
8739 		  BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
8740 		  dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
8741 		}
8742 	      else
8743 		{
8744 		  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, name);
8745 		  BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
8746 		  dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma;
8747 		}
8748 	      break;
8749 
8750 	    case DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION:
8751 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = 1; /* XXX */
8752 	      break;
8753 
8754 	    case DT_MIPS_FLAGS:
8755 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = RHF_NOTPOT; /* XXX */
8756 	      break;
8757 
8758 	    case DT_MIPS_TIME_STAMP:
8759 	      {
8760 		time_t t;
8761 		time (&t);
8762 		dyn.d_un.d_val = t;
8763 	      }
8764 	      break;
8765 
8766 	    case DT_MIPS_ICHECKSUM:
8767 	      /* XXX FIXME: */
8768 	      swap_out_p = FALSE;
8769 	      break;
8770 
8771 	    case DT_MIPS_IVERSION:
8772 	      /* XXX FIXME: */
8773 	      swap_out_p = FALSE;
8774 	      break;
8775 
8776 	    case DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS:
8777 	      s = output_bfd->sections;
8778 	      BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
8779 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma & ~(bfd_vma) 0xffff;
8780 	      break;
8781 
8782 	    case DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO:
8783 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = g->local_gotno;
8784 	      break;
8785 
8786 	    case DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO:
8787 	      /* The index into the dynamic symbol table which is the
8788 		 entry of the first external symbol that is not
8789 		 referenced within the same object.  */
8790 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = bfd_count_sections (output_bfd) + 1;
8791 	      break;
8792 
8793 	    case DT_MIPS_GOTSYM:
8794 	      if (gg->global_gotsym)
8795 		{
8796 		  dyn.d_un.d_val = gg->global_gotsym->dynindx;
8797 		  break;
8798 		}
8799 	      /* In case if we don't have global got symbols we default
8800 		 to setting DT_MIPS_GOTSYM to the same value as
8801 		 DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO, so we just fall through.  */
8802 
8803 	    case DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO:
8804 	      name = ".dynsym";
8805 	      elemsize = MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE (output_bfd);
8806 	      s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, name);
8807 	      BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
8808 
8809 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = s->size / elemsize;
8810 	      break;
8811 
8812 	    case DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO:
8813 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = g->local_gotno - MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info);
8814 	      break;
8815 
8816 	    case DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP:
8817 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value;
8818 	      break;
8819 
8820 	    case DT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
8821 	      s = (bfd_get_section_by_name
8822 		   (output_bfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (output_bfd)));
8823 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma;
8824 	      break;
8825 
8826 	    case DT_RELASZ:
8827 	      BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
8828 	      /* The count does not include the JUMP_SLOT relocations.  */
8829 	      if (htab->srelplt)
8830 		dyn.d_un.d_val -= htab->srelplt->size;
8831 	      break;
8832 
8833 	    case DT_PLTREL:
8834 	      BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
8835 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = DT_RELA;
8836 	      break;
8837 
8838 	    case DT_PLTRELSZ:
8839 	      BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
8840 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->srelplt->size;
8841 	      break;
8842 
8843 	    case DT_JMPREL:
8844 	      BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
8845 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = (htab->srelplt->output_section->vma
8846 				+ htab->srelplt->output_offset);
8847 	      break;
8848 
8849 	    case DT_TEXTREL:
8850 	      /* If we didn't need any text relocations after all, delete
8851 		 the dynamic tag.  */
8852 	      if (!(info->flags & DF_TEXTREL))
8853 		{
8854 		  dyn_to_skip = MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj);
8855 		  swap_out_p = FALSE;
8856 		}
8857 	      break;
8858 
8859 	    case DT_FLAGS:
8860 	      /* If we didn't need any text relocations after all, clear
8861 		 DF_TEXTREL from DT_FLAGS.  */
8862 	      if (!(info->flags & DF_TEXTREL))
8863 		dyn.d_un.d_val &= ~DF_TEXTREL;
8864 	      else
8865 		swap_out_p = FALSE;
8866 	      break;
8867 
8868 	    default:
8869 	      swap_out_p = FALSE;
8870 	      break;
8871 	    }
8872 
8873 	  if (swap_out_p || dyn_skipped)
8874 	    (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_out)
8875 	      (dynobj, &dyn, b - dyn_skipped);
8876 
8877 	  if (dyn_to_skip)
8878 	    {
8879 	      dyn_skipped += dyn_to_skip;
8880 	      dyn_to_skip = 0;
8881 	    }
8882 	}
8883 
8884       /* Wipe out any trailing entries if we shifted down a dynamic tag.  */
8885       if (dyn_skipped > 0)
8886 	memset (b - dyn_skipped, 0, dyn_skipped);
8887     }
8888 
8889   if (sgot != NULL && sgot->size > 0)
8890     {
8891       if (htab->is_vxworks)
8892 	{
8893 	  /* The first entry of the global offset table points to the
8894 	     ".dynamic" section.  The second is initialized by the
8895 	     loader and contains the shared library identifier.
8896 	     The third is also initialized by the loader and points
8897 	     to the lazy resolution stub.  */
8898 	  MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd,
8899 			     sdyn->output_offset + sdyn->output_section->vma,
8900 			     sgot->contents);
8901 	  MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0,
8902 			     sgot->contents + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
8903 	  MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0,
8904 			     sgot->contents
8905 			     + 2 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
8906 	}
8907       else
8908 	{
8909 	  /* The first entry of the global offset table will be filled at
8910 	     runtime. The second entry will be used by some runtime loaders.
8911 	     This isn't the case of IRIX rld.  */
8912 	  MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, (bfd_vma) 0, sgot->contents);
8913 	  MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, (bfd_vma) 0x80000000,
8914 			     sgot->contents + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
8915 	}
8916 
8917       elf_section_data (sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
8918 	 = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
8919     }
8920 
8921   /* Generate dynamic relocations for the non-primary gots.  */
8922   if (gg != NULL && gg->next)
8923     {
8924       Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
8925       bfd_vma addend = 0;
8926 
8927       memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
8928       rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_REL32);
8929 
8930       for (g = gg->next; g->next != gg; g = g->next)
8931 	{
8932 	  bfd_vma index = g->next->local_gotno + g->next->global_gotno
8933 	    + g->next->tls_gotno;
8934 
8935 	  MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0, sgot->contents
8936 			     + index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
8937 	  MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0x80000000, sgot->contents
8938 			     + index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
8939 
8940 	  if (! info->shared)
8941 	    continue;
8942 
8943 	  while (index < g->assigned_gotno)
8944 	    {
8945 	      rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset
8946 		= index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
8947 	      if (!(mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
8948 		    (output_bfd, info, rel, NULL,
8949 		     bfd_abs_section_ptr,
8950 		     0, &addend, sgot)))
8951 		return FALSE;
8952 	      BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0);
8953 	    }
8954 	}
8955     }
8956 
8957   /* The generation of dynamic relocations for the non-primary gots
8958      adds more dynamic relocations.  We cannot count them until
8959      here.  */
8960 
8961   if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
8962     {
8963       bfd_byte *b;
8964       bfd_boolean swap_out_p;
8965 
8966       BFD_ASSERT (sdyn != NULL);
8967 
8968       for (b = sdyn->contents;
8969 	   b < sdyn->contents + sdyn->size;
8970 	   b += MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj))
8971 	{
8972 	  Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
8973 	  asection *s;
8974 
8975 	  /* Read in the current dynamic entry.  */
8976 	  (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_in) (dynobj, b, &dyn);
8977 
8978 	  /* Assume that we're going to modify it and write it out.  */
8979 	  swap_out_p = TRUE;
8980 
8981 	  switch (dyn.d_tag)
8982 	    {
8983 	    case DT_RELSZ:
8984 	      /* Reduce DT_RELSZ to account for any relocations we
8985 		 decided not to make.  This is for the n64 irix rld,
8986 		 which doesn't seem to apply any relocations if there
8987 		 are trailing null entries.  */
8988 	      s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
8989 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = (s->reloc_count
8990 				* (ABI_64_P (output_bfd)
8991 				   ? sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)
8992 				   : sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
8993 	      /* Adjust the section size too.  Tools like the prelinker
8994 		 can reasonably expect the values to the same.  */
8995 	      elf_section_data (s->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_size
8996 		= dyn.d_un.d_val;
8997 	      break;
8998 
8999 	    default:
9000 	      swap_out_p = FALSE;
9001 	      break;
9002 	    }
9003 
9004 	  if (swap_out_p)
9005 	    (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_out)
9006 	      (dynobj, &dyn, b);
9007 	}
9008     }
9009 
9010   {
9011     asection *s;
9012     Elf32_compact_rel cpt;
9013 
9014     if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
9015       {
9016 	/* Write .compact_rel section out.  */
9017 	s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".compact_rel");
9018 	if (s != NULL)
9019 	  {
9020 	    cpt.id1 = 1;
9021 	    cpt.num = s->reloc_count;
9022 	    cpt.id2 = 2;
9023 	    cpt.offset = (s->output_section->filepos
9024 			  + sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel));
9025 	    cpt.reserved0 = 0;
9026 	    cpt.reserved1 = 0;
9027 	    bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out (output_bfd, &cpt,
9028 					    ((Elf32_External_compact_rel *)
9029 					     s->contents));
9030 
9031 	    /* Clean up a dummy stub function entry in .text.  */
9032 	    s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj,
9033 					 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj));
9034 	    if (s != NULL)
9035 	      {
9036 		file_ptr dummy_offset;
9037 
9038 		BFD_ASSERT (s->size >= htab->function_stub_size);
9039 		dummy_offset = s->size - htab->function_stub_size;
9040 		memset (s->contents + dummy_offset, 0,
9041 			htab->function_stub_size);
9042 	      }
9043 	  }
9044       }
9045 
9046     /* The psABI says that the dynamic relocations must be sorted in
9047        increasing order of r_symndx.  The VxWorks EABI doesn't require
9048        this, and because the code below handles REL rather than RELA
9049        relocations, using it for VxWorks would be outright harmful.  */
9050     if (!htab->is_vxworks)
9051       {
9052 	s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
9053 	if (s != NULL
9054 	    && s->size > (bfd_vma)2 * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (output_bfd))
9055 	  {
9056 	    reldyn_sorting_bfd = output_bfd;
9057 
9058 	    if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
9059 	      qsort ((Elf64_External_Rel *) s->contents + 1,
9060 		     s->reloc_count - 1, sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel),
9061 		     sort_dynamic_relocs_64);
9062 	    else
9063 	      qsort ((Elf32_External_Rel *) s->contents + 1,
9064 		     s->reloc_count - 1, sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel),
9065 		     sort_dynamic_relocs);
9066 	  }
9067       }
9068   }
9069 
9070   if (htab->is_vxworks && htab->splt->size > 0)
9071     {
9072       if (info->shared)
9073 	mips_vxworks_finish_shared_plt (output_bfd, info);
9074       else
9075 	mips_vxworks_finish_exec_plt (output_bfd, info);
9076     }
9077   return TRUE;
9078 }
9079 
9080 
9081 /* Set ABFD's EF_MIPS_ARCH and EF_MIPS_MACH flags.  */
9082 
9083 static void
mips_set_isa_flags(bfd * abfd)9084 mips_set_isa_flags (bfd *abfd)
9085 {
9086   flagword val;
9087 
9088   switch (bfd_get_mach (abfd))
9089     {
9090     default:
9091     case bfd_mach_mips3000:
9092       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1;
9093       break;
9094 
9095     case bfd_mach_mips3900:
9096       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1 | E_MIPS_MACH_3900;
9097       break;
9098 
9099     case bfd_mach_mips6000:
9100       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_2;
9101       break;
9102 
9103     case bfd_mach_mips4000:
9104     case bfd_mach_mips4300:
9105     case bfd_mach_mips4400:
9106     case bfd_mach_mips4600:
9107       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3;
9108       break;
9109 
9110     case bfd_mach_mips4010:
9111       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4010;
9112       break;
9113 
9114     case bfd_mach_mips4100:
9115       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4100;
9116       break;
9117 
9118     case bfd_mach_mips4111:
9119       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4111;
9120       break;
9121 
9122     case bfd_mach_mips4120:
9123       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4120;
9124       break;
9125 
9126     case bfd_mach_mips4650:
9127       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4650;
9128       break;
9129 
9130     case bfd_mach_mips5400:
9131       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_5400;
9132       break;
9133 
9134     case bfd_mach_mips5500:
9135       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_5500;
9136       break;
9137 
9138     case bfd_mach_mips9000:
9139       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_9000;
9140       break;
9141 
9142     case bfd_mach_mips5000:
9143     case bfd_mach_mips7000:
9144     case bfd_mach_mips8000:
9145     case bfd_mach_mips10000:
9146     case bfd_mach_mips12000:
9147       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4;
9148       break;
9149 
9150     case bfd_mach_mips5:
9151       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_5;
9152       break;
9153 
9154     case bfd_mach_mips_octeon:
9155       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2 | E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON;
9156       break;
9157 
9158     case bfd_mach_mips_sb1:
9159       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64 | E_MIPS_MACH_SB1;
9160       break;
9161 
9162     case bfd_mach_mipsisa32:
9163       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32;
9164       break;
9165 
9166     case bfd_mach_mipsisa64:
9167       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64;
9168       break;
9169 
9170     case bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2:
9171       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2;
9172       break;
9173 
9174     case bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2:
9175       val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2;
9176       break;
9177     }
9178   elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH);
9179   elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags |= val;
9180 
9181 }
9182 
9183 
9184 /* The final processing done just before writing out a MIPS ELF object
9185    file.  This gets the MIPS architecture right based on the machine
9186    number.  This is used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI.  */
9187 
9188 void
_bfd_mips_elf_final_write_processing(bfd * abfd,bfd_boolean linker ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)9189 _bfd_mips_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd,
9190 				      bfd_boolean linker ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9191 {
9192   unsigned int i;
9193   Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
9194   const char *name;
9195   asection *sec;
9196 
9197   /* Keep the existing EF_MIPS_MACH and EF_MIPS_ARCH flags if the former
9198      is nonzero.  This is for compatibility with old objects, which used
9199      a combination of a 32-bit EF_MIPS_ARCH and a 64-bit EF_MIPS_MACH.  */
9200   if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_MACH) == 0)
9201     mips_set_isa_flags (abfd);
9202 
9203   /* Set the sh_info field for .gptab sections and other appropriate
9204      info for each special section.  */
9205   for (i = 1, hdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd) + 1;
9206        i < elf_numsections (abfd);
9207        i++, hdrpp++)
9208     {
9209       switch ((*hdrpp)->sh_type)
9210 	{
9211 	case SHT_MIPS_MSYM:
9212 	case SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
9213 	  sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
9214 	  if (sec != NULL)
9215 	    (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9216 	  break;
9217 
9218 	case SHT_MIPS_GPTAB:
9219 	  BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
9220 	  name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
9221 	  BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL
9222 		      && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gptab."));
9223 	  sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1);
9224 	  BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
9225 	  (*hdrpp)->sh_info = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9226 	  break;
9227 
9228 	case SHT_MIPS_CONTENT:
9229 	  BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
9230 	  name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
9231 	  BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL
9232 		      && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.content"));
9233 	  sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
9234 					 name + sizeof ".MIPS.content" - 1);
9235 	  BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
9236 	  (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9237 	  break;
9238 
9239 	case SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
9240 	  sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
9241 	  if (sec != NULL)
9242 	    (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9243 	  sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".liblist");
9244 	  if (sec != NULL)
9245 	    (*hdrpp)->sh_info = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9246 	  break;
9247 
9248 	case SHT_MIPS_EVENTS:
9249 	  BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
9250 	  name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
9251 	  BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL);
9252 	  if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.events"))
9253 	    sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
9254 					   name + sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1);
9255 	  else
9256 	    {
9257 	      BFD_ASSERT (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.post_rel"));
9258 	      sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
9259 					     (name
9260 					      + sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1));
9261 	    }
9262 	  BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
9263 	  (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9264 	  break;
9265 
9266 	}
9267     }
9268 }
9269 
9270 /* When creating an IRIX5 executable, we need REGINFO and RTPROC
9271    segments.  */
9272 
9273 int
_bfd_mips_elf_additional_program_headers(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)9274 _bfd_mips_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
9275 					  struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9276 {
9277   asection *s;
9278   int ret = 0;
9279 
9280   /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_REGINFO segment.  */
9281   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
9282   if (s && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD))
9283     ++ret;
9284 
9285   /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_OPTIONS segment.  */
9286   if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6
9287       && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
9288 				  MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd)))
9289     ++ret;
9290 
9291   /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_RTPROC segment.  */
9292   if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5
9293       && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic")
9294       && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug"))
9295     ++ret;
9296 
9297   /* Allocate a PT_NULL header in dynamic objects.  See
9298      _bfd_mips_elf_modify_segment_map for details.  */
9299   if (!SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
9300       && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic"))
9301     ++ret;
9302 
9303   return ret;
9304 }
9305 
9306 /* Modify the segment map for an IRIX5 executable.  */
9307 
9308 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_modify_segment_map(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)9309 _bfd_mips_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
9310 				  struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9311 {
9312   asection *s;
9313   struct elf_segment_map *m, **pm;
9314   bfd_size_type amt;
9315 
9316   /* If there is a .reginfo section, we need a PT_MIPS_REGINFO
9317      segment.  */
9318   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
9319   if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
9320     {
9321       for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
9322 	if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_REGINFO)
9323 	  break;
9324       if (m == NULL)
9325 	{
9326 	  amt = sizeof *m;
9327 	  m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9328 	  if (m == NULL)
9329 	    return FALSE;
9330 
9331 	  m->p_type = PT_MIPS_REGINFO;
9332 	  m->count = 1;
9333 	  m->sections[0] = s;
9334 
9335 	  /* We want to put it after the PHDR and INTERP segments.  */
9336 	  pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
9337 	  while (*pm != NULL
9338 		 && ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR
9339 		     || (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP))
9340 	    pm = &(*pm)->next;
9341 
9342 	  m->next = *pm;
9343 	  *pm = m;
9344 	}
9345     }
9346 
9347   /* For IRIX 6, we don't have .mdebug sections, nor does anything but
9348      .dynamic end up in PT_DYNAMIC.  However, we do have to insert a
9349      PT_MIPS_OPTIONS segment immediately following the program header
9350      table.  */
9351   if (NEWABI_P (abfd)
9352       /* On non-IRIX6 new abi, we'll have already created a segment
9353 	 for this section, so don't create another.  I'm not sure this
9354 	 is not also the case for IRIX 6, but I can't test it right
9355 	 now.  */
9356       && IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
9357     {
9358       for (s = abfd->sections; s; s = s->next)
9359 	if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
9360 	  break;
9361 
9362       if (s)
9363 	{
9364 	  struct elf_segment_map *options_segment;
9365 
9366 	  pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
9367 	  while (*pm != NULL
9368 		 && ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR
9369 		     || (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP))
9370 	    pm = &(*pm)->next;
9371 
9372 	  if (*pm == NULL || (*pm)->p_type != PT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
9373 	    {
9374 	      amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
9375 	      options_segment = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9376 	      options_segment->next = *pm;
9377 	      options_segment->p_type = PT_MIPS_OPTIONS;
9378 	      options_segment->p_flags = PF_R;
9379 	      options_segment->p_flags_valid = TRUE;
9380 	      options_segment->count = 1;
9381 	      options_segment->sections[0] = s;
9382 	      *pm = options_segment;
9383 	    }
9384 	}
9385     }
9386   else
9387     {
9388       if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5)
9389 	{
9390 	  /* If there are .dynamic and .mdebug sections, we make a room
9391 	     for the RTPROC header.  FIXME: Rewrite without section names.  */
9392 	  if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp") == NULL
9393 	      && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL
9394 	      && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug") != NULL)
9395 	    {
9396 	      for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
9397 		if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_RTPROC)
9398 		  break;
9399 	      if (m == NULL)
9400 		{
9401 		  amt = sizeof *m;
9402 		  m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9403 		  if (m == NULL)
9404 		    return FALSE;
9405 
9406 		  m->p_type = PT_MIPS_RTPROC;
9407 
9408 		  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
9409 		  if (s == NULL)
9410 		    {
9411 		      m->count = 0;
9412 		      m->p_flags = 0;
9413 		      m->p_flags_valid = 1;
9414 		    }
9415 		  else
9416 		    {
9417 		      m->count = 1;
9418 		      m->sections[0] = s;
9419 		    }
9420 
9421 		  /* We want to put it after the DYNAMIC segment.  */
9422 		  pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
9423 		  while (*pm != NULL && (*pm)->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC)
9424 		    pm = &(*pm)->next;
9425 		  if (*pm != NULL)
9426 		    pm = &(*pm)->next;
9427 
9428 		  m->next = *pm;
9429 		  *pm = m;
9430 		}
9431 	    }
9432 	}
9433       /* On IRIX5, the PT_DYNAMIC segment includes the .dynamic,
9434 	 .dynstr, .dynsym, and .hash sections, and everything in
9435 	 between.  */
9436       for (pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; *pm != NULL;
9437 	   pm = &(*pm)->next)
9438 	if ((*pm)->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC)
9439 	  break;
9440       m = *pm;
9441       if (m != NULL && IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_none)
9442 	{
9443 	  /* For a normal mips executable the permissions for the PT_DYNAMIC
9444 	     segment are read, write and execute. We do that here since
9445 	     the code in elf.c sets only the read permission. This matters
9446 	     sometimes for the dynamic linker.  */
9447 	  if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
9448 	    {
9449 	      m->p_flags = PF_R | PF_W | PF_X;
9450 	      m->p_flags_valid = 1;
9451 	    }
9452 	}
9453       /* GNU/Linux binaries do not need the extended PT_DYNAMIC section.
9454 	 glibc's dynamic linker has traditionally derived the number of
9455 	 tags from the p_filesz field, and sometimes allocates stack
9456 	 arrays of that size.  An overly-big PT_DYNAMIC segment can
9457 	 be actively harmful in such cases.  Making PT_DYNAMIC contain
9458 	 other sections can also make life hard for the prelinker,
9459 	 which might move one of the other sections to a different
9460 	 PT_LOAD segment.  */
9461       if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
9462 	  && m != NULL
9463 	  && m->count == 1
9464 	  && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") == 0)
9465 	{
9466 	  static const char *sec_names[] =
9467 	  {
9468 	    ".dynamic", ".dynstr", ".dynsym", ".hash"
9469 	  };
9470 	  bfd_vma low, high;
9471 	  unsigned int i, c;
9472 	  struct elf_segment_map *n;
9473 
9474 	  low = ~(bfd_vma) 0;
9475 	  high = 0;
9476 	  for (i = 0; i < sizeof sec_names / sizeof sec_names[0]; i++)
9477 	    {
9478 	      s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec_names[i]);
9479 	      if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
9480 		{
9481 		  bfd_size_type sz;
9482 
9483 		  if (low > s->vma)
9484 		    low = s->vma;
9485 		  sz = s->size;
9486 		  if (high < s->vma + sz)
9487 		    high = s->vma + sz;
9488 		}
9489 	    }
9490 
9491 	  c = 0;
9492 	  for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
9493 	    if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
9494 		&& s->vma >= low
9495 		&& s->vma + s->size <= high)
9496 	      ++c;
9497 
9498 	  amt = sizeof *n + (bfd_size_type) (c - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
9499 	  n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9500 	  if (n == NULL)
9501 	    return FALSE;
9502 	  *n = *m;
9503 	  n->count = c;
9504 
9505 	  i = 0;
9506 	  for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
9507 	    {
9508 	      if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
9509 		  && s->vma >= low
9510 		  && s->vma + s->size <= high)
9511 		{
9512 		  n->sections[i] = s;
9513 		  ++i;
9514 		}
9515 	    }
9516 
9517 	  *pm = n;
9518 	}
9519     }
9520 
9521   /* Allocate a spare program header in dynamic objects so that tools
9522      like the prelinker can add an extra PT_LOAD entry.
9523 
9524      If the prelinker needs to make room for a new PT_LOAD entry, its
9525      standard procedure is to move the first (read-only) sections into
9526      the new (writable) segment.  However, the MIPS ABI requires
9527      .dynamic to be in a read-only segment, and the section will often
9528      start within sizeof (ElfNN_Phdr) bytes of the last program header.
9529 
9530      Although the prelinker could in principle move .dynamic to a
9531      writable segment, it seems better to allocate a spare program
9532      header instead, and avoid the need to move any sections.
9533      There is a long tradition of allocating spare dynamic tags,
9534      so allocating a spare program header seems like a natural
9535      extension.  */
9536   if (!SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
9537       && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic"))
9538     {
9539       for (pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; *pm != NULL; pm = &(*pm)->next)
9540 	if ((*pm)->p_type == PT_NULL)
9541 	  break;
9542       if (*pm == NULL)
9543 	{
9544 	  m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*m));
9545 	  if (m == NULL)
9546 	    return FALSE;
9547 
9548 	  m->p_type = PT_NULL;
9549 	  *pm = m;
9550 	}
9551     }
9552 
9553   return TRUE;
9554 }
9555 
9556 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
9557    relocation.  */
9558 
9559 asection *
_bfd_mips_elf_gc_mark_hook(asection * sec,struct bfd_link_info * info,Elf_Internal_Rela * rel,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym)9560 _bfd_mips_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
9561 			    struct bfd_link_info *info,
9562 			    Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
9563 			    struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
9564 			    Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
9565 {
9566   /* ??? Do mips16 stub sections need to be handled special?  */
9567 
9568   if (h != NULL)
9569     switch (ELF_R_TYPE (sec->owner, rel->r_info))
9570       {
9571       case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
9572       case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
9573 	return NULL;
9574       }
9575 
9576   return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
9577 }
9578 
9579 /* Update the got entry reference counts for the section being removed.  */
9580 
9581 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_gc_sweep_hook(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,struct bfd_link_info * info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection * sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)9582 _bfd_mips_elf_gc_sweep_hook (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9583 			     struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9584 			     asection *sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9585 			     const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9586 {
9587 #if 0
9588   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9589   struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
9590   bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts;
9591   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, *relend;
9592   unsigned long r_symndx;
9593   struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
9594 
9595   symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
9596   sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
9597   local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
9598 
9599   relend = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
9600   for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; rel++)
9601     switch (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info))
9602       {
9603       case R_MIPS_GOT16:
9604       case R_MIPS_CALL16:
9605       case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
9606       case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
9607       case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
9608       case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
9609       case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
9610       case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
9611       case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
9612 	/* ??? It would seem that the existing MIPS code does no sort
9613 	   of reference counting or whatnot on its GOT and PLT entries,
9614 	   so it is not possible to garbage collect them at this time.  */
9615 	break;
9616 
9617       default:
9618 	break;
9619       }
9620 #endif
9621 
9622   return TRUE;
9623 }
9624 
9625 /* Copy data from a MIPS ELF indirect symbol to its direct symbol,
9626    hiding the old indirect symbol.  Process additional relocation
9627    information.  Also called for weakdefs, in which case we just let
9628    _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect copy the flags for us.  */
9629 
9630 void
_bfd_mips_elf_copy_indirect_symbol(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * dir,struct elf_link_hash_entry * ind)9631 _bfd_mips_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
9632 				    struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
9633 				    struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
9634 {
9635   struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *dirmips, *indmips;
9636 
9637   _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect (info, dir, ind);
9638 
9639   if (ind->root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
9640     return;
9641 
9642   dirmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
9643   indmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
9644   dirmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs += indmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs;
9645   if (indmips->readonly_reloc)
9646     dirmips->readonly_reloc = TRUE;
9647   if (indmips->no_fn_stub)
9648     dirmips->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
9649 
9650   if (dirmips->tls_type == 0)
9651     dirmips->tls_type = indmips->tls_type;
9652 }
9653 
9654 void
_bfd_mips_elf_hide_symbol(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * entry,bfd_boolean force_local)9655 _bfd_mips_elf_hide_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
9656 			   struct elf_link_hash_entry *entry,
9657 			   bfd_boolean force_local)
9658 {
9659   bfd *dynobj;
9660   asection *got;
9661   struct mips_got_info *g;
9662   struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
9663 
9664   h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) entry;
9665   if (h->forced_local)
9666     return;
9667   h->forced_local = force_local;
9668 
9669   dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
9670   if (dynobj != NULL && force_local && h->root.type != STT_TLS
9671       && (got = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, TRUE)) != NULL
9672       && (g = mips_elf_section_data (got)->u.got_info) != NULL)
9673     {
9674       if (g->next)
9675 	{
9676 	  struct mips_got_entry e;
9677 	  struct mips_got_info *gg = g;
9678 
9679 	  /* Since we're turning what used to be a global symbol into a
9680 	     local one, bump up the number of local entries of each GOT
9681 	     that had an entry for it.  This will automatically decrease
9682 	     the number of global entries, since global_gotno is actually
9683 	     the upper limit of global entries.  */
9684 	  e.abfd = dynobj;
9685 	  e.symndx = -1;
9686 	  e.d.h = h;
9687 	  e.tls_type = 0;
9688 
9689 	  for (g = g->next; g != gg; g = g->next)
9690 	    if (htab_find (g->got_entries, &e))
9691 	      {
9692 		BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotno > 0);
9693 		g->local_gotno++;
9694 		g->global_gotno--;
9695 	      }
9696 
9697 	  /* If this was a global symbol forced into the primary GOT, we
9698 	     no longer need an entry for it.  We can't release the entry
9699 	     at this point, but we must at least stop counting it as one
9700 	     of the symbols that required a forced got entry.  */
9701 	  if (h->root.got.offset == 2)
9702 	    {
9703 	      BFD_ASSERT (gg->assigned_gotno > 0);
9704 	      gg->assigned_gotno--;
9705 	    }
9706 	}
9707       else if (g->global_gotno == 0 && g->global_gotsym == NULL)
9708 	/* If we haven't got through GOT allocation yet, just bump up the
9709 	   number of local entries, as this symbol won't be counted as
9710 	   global.  */
9711 	g->local_gotno++;
9712       else if (h->root.got.offset == 1)
9713 	{
9714 	  /* If we're past non-multi-GOT allocation and this symbol had
9715 	     been marked for a global got entry, give it a local entry
9716 	     instead.  */
9717 	  BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotno > 0);
9718 	  g->local_gotno++;
9719 	  g->global_gotno--;
9720 	}
9721     }
9722 
9723   _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &h->root, force_local);
9724 }
9725 
9726 #define PDR_SIZE 32
9727 
9728 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_discard_info(bfd * abfd,struct elf_reloc_cookie * cookie,struct bfd_link_info * info)9729 _bfd_mips_elf_discard_info (bfd *abfd, struct elf_reloc_cookie *cookie,
9730 			    struct bfd_link_info *info)
9731 {
9732   asection *o;
9733   bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
9734   unsigned char *tdata;
9735   size_t i, skip;
9736 
9737   o = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".pdr");
9738   if (! o)
9739     return FALSE;
9740   if (o->size == 0)
9741     return FALSE;
9742   if (o->size % PDR_SIZE != 0)
9743     return FALSE;
9744   if (o->output_section != NULL
9745       && bfd_is_abs_section (o->output_section))
9746     return FALSE;
9747 
9748   tdata = bfd_zmalloc (o->size / PDR_SIZE);
9749   if (! tdata)
9750     return FALSE;
9751 
9752   cookie->rels = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
9753 					    info->keep_memory);
9754   if (!cookie->rels)
9755     {
9756       free (tdata);
9757       return FALSE;
9758     }
9759 
9760   cookie->rel = cookie->rels;
9761   cookie->relend = cookie->rels + o->reloc_count;
9762 
9763   for (i = 0, skip = 0; i < o->size / PDR_SIZE; i ++)
9764     {
9765       if (bfd_elf_reloc_symbol_deleted_p (i * PDR_SIZE, cookie))
9766 	{
9767 	  tdata[i] = 1;
9768 	  skip ++;
9769 	}
9770     }
9771 
9772   if (skip != 0)
9773     {
9774       mips_elf_section_data (o)->u.tdata = tdata;
9775       o->size -= skip * PDR_SIZE;
9776       ret = TRUE;
9777     }
9778   else
9779     free (tdata);
9780 
9781   if (! info->keep_memory)
9782     free (cookie->rels);
9783 
9784   return ret;
9785 }
9786 
9787 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_ignore_discarded_relocs(asection * sec)9788 _bfd_mips_elf_ignore_discarded_relocs (asection *sec)
9789 {
9790   if (strcmp (sec->name, ".pdr") == 0)
9791     return TRUE;
9792   return FALSE;
9793 }
9794 
9795 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_write_section(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection * sec,bfd_byte * contents)9796 _bfd_mips_elf_write_section (bfd *output_bfd,
9797 			     struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9798                              asection *sec, bfd_byte *contents)
9799 {
9800   bfd_byte *to, *from, *end;
9801   int i;
9802 
9803   if (strcmp (sec->name, ".pdr") != 0)
9804     return FALSE;
9805 
9806   if (mips_elf_section_data (sec)->u.tdata == NULL)
9807     return FALSE;
9808 
9809   to = contents;
9810   end = contents + sec->size;
9811   for (from = contents, i = 0;
9812        from < end;
9813        from += PDR_SIZE, i++)
9814     {
9815       if ((mips_elf_section_data (sec)->u.tdata)[i] == 1)
9816 	continue;
9817       if (to != from)
9818 	memcpy (to, from, PDR_SIZE);
9819       to += PDR_SIZE;
9820     }
9821   bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd, sec->output_section, contents,
9822 			    sec->output_offset, sec->size);
9823   return TRUE;
9824 }
9825 
9826 /* MIPS ELF uses a special find_nearest_line routine in order the
9827    handle the ECOFF debugging information.  */
9828 
9829 struct mips_elf_find_line
9830 {
9831   struct ecoff_debug_info d;
9832   struct ecoff_find_line i;
9833 };
9834 
9835 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_find_nearest_line(bfd * abfd,asection * section,asymbol ** symbols,bfd_vma offset,const char ** filename_ptr,const char ** functionname_ptr,unsigned int * line_ptr)9836 _bfd_mips_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd, asection *section,
9837 				 asymbol **symbols, bfd_vma offset,
9838 				 const char **filename_ptr,
9839 				 const char **functionname_ptr,
9840 				 unsigned int *line_ptr)
9841 {
9842   asection *msec;
9843 
9844   if (_bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
9845 				     filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
9846 				     line_ptr))
9847     return TRUE;
9848 
9849   if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
9850 				     filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
9851 				     line_ptr, ABI_64_P (abfd) ? 8 : 0,
9852 				     &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info))
9853     return TRUE;
9854 
9855   msec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug");
9856   if (msec != NULL)
9857     {
9858       flagword origflags;
9859       struct mips_elf_find_line *fi;
9860       const struct ecoff_debug_swap * const swap =
9861 	get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
9862 
9863       /* If we are called during a link, mips_elf_final_link may have
9864 	 cleared the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS field.  We force it back on here
9865 	 if appropriate (which it normally will be).  */
9866       origflags = msec->flags;
9867       if (elf_section_data (msec)->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
9868 	msec->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
9869 
9870       fi = elf_tdata (abfd)->find_line_info;
9871       if (fi == NULL)
9872 	{
9873 	  bfd_size_type external_fdr_size;
9874 	  char *fraw_src;
9875 	  char *fraw_end;
9876 	  struct fdr *fdr_ptr;
9877 	  bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct mips_elf_find_line);
9878 
9879 	  fi = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9880 	  if (fi == NULL)
9881 	    {
9882 	      msec->flags = origflags;
9883 	      return FALSE;
9884 	    }
9885 
9886 	  if (! _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (abfd, msec, &fi->d))
9887 	    {
9888 	      msec->flags = origflags;
9889 	      return FALSE;
9890 	    }
9891 
9892 	  /* Swap in the FDR information.  */
9893 	  amt = fi->d.symbolic_header.ifdMax * sizeof (struct fdr);
9894 	  fi->d.fdr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
9895 	  if (fi->d.fdr == NULL)
9896 	    {
9897 	      msec->flags = origflags;
9898 	      return FALSE;
9899 	    }
9900 	  external_fdr_size = swap->external_fdr_size;
9901 	  fdr_ptr = fi->d.fdr;
9902 	  fraw_src = (char *) fi->d.external_fdr;
9903 	  fraw_end = (fraw_src
9904 		      + fi->d.symbolic_header.ifdMax * external_fdr_size);
9905 	  for (; fraw_src < fraw_end; fraw_src += external_fdr_size, fdr_ptr++)
9906 	    (*swap->swap_fdr_in) (abfd, fraw_src, fdr_ptr);
9907 
9908 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->find_line_info = fi;
9909 
9910 	  /* Note that we don't bother to ever free this information.
9911              find_nearest_line is either called all the time, as in
9912              objdump -l, so the information should be saved, or it is
9913              rarely called, as in ld error messages, so the memory
9914              wasted is unimportant.  Still, it would probably be a
9915              good idea for free_cached_info to throw it away.  */
9916 	}
9917 
9918       if (_bfd_ecoff_locate_line (abfd, section, offset, &fi->d, swap,
9919 				  &fi->i, filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
9920 				  line_ptr))
9921 	{
9922 	  msec->flags = origflags;
9923 	  return TRUE;
9924 	}
9925 
9926       msec->flags = origflags;
9927     }
9928 
9929   /* Fall back on the generic ELF find_nearest_line routine.  */
9930 
9931   return _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
9932 				     filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
9933 				     line_ptr);
9934 }
9935 
9936 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_find_inliner_info(bfd * abfd,const char ** filename_ptr,const char ** functionname_ptr,unsigned int * line_ptr)9937 _bfd_mips_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
9938 				 const char **filename_ptr,
9939 				 const char **functionname_ptr,
9940 				 unsigned int *line_ptr)
9941 {
9942   bfd_boolean found;
9943   found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
9944 					 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
9945 					 & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
9946   return found;
9947 }
9948 
9949 
9950 /* When are writing out the .options or .MIPS.options section,
9951    remember the bytes we are writing out, so that we can install the
9952    GP value in the section_processing routine.  */
9953 
9954 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_set_section_contents(bfd * abfd,sec_ptr section,const void * location,file_ptr offset,bfd_size_type count)9955 _bfd_mips_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd, sec_ptr section,
9956 				    const void *location,
9957 				    file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type count)
9958 {
9959   if (MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (section->name))
9960     {
9961       bfd_byte *c;
9962 
9963       if (elf_section_data (section) == NULL)
9964 	{
9965 	  bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct bfd_elf_section_data);
9966 	  section->used_by_bfd = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9967 	  if (elf_section_data (section) == NULL)
9968 	    return FALSE;
9969 	}
9970       c = mips_elf_section_data (section)->u.tdata;
9971       if (c == NULL)
9972 	{
9973 	  c = bfd_zalloc (abfd, section->size);
9974 	  if (c == NULL)
9975 	    return FALSE;
9976 	  mips_elf_section_data (section)->u.tdata = c;
9977 	}
9978 
9979       memcpy (c + offset, location, count);
9980     }
9981 
9982   return _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (abfd, section, location, offset,
9983 					count);
9984 }
9985 
9986 /* This is almost identical to bfd_generic_get_... except that some
9987    MIPS relocations need to be handled specially.  Sigh.  */
9988 
9989 bfd_byte *
_bfd_elf_mips_get_relocated_section_contents(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * link_info,struct bfd_link_order * link_order,bfd_byte * data,bfd_boolean relocatable,asymbol ** symbols)9990 _bfd_elf_mips_get_relocated_section_contents
9991   (bfd *abfd,
9992    struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
9993    struct bfd_link_order *link_order,
9994    bfd_byte *data,
9995    bfd_boolean relocatable,
9996    asymbol **symbols)
9997 {
9998   /* Get enough memory to hold the stuff */
9999   bfd *input_bfd = link_order->u.indirect.section->owner;
10000   asection *input_section = link_order->u.indirect.section;
10001   bfd_size_type sz;
10002 
10003   long reloc_size = bfd_get_reloc_upper_bound (input_bfd, input_section);
10004   arelent **reloc_vector = NULL;
10005   long reloc_count;
10006 
10007   if (reloc_size < 0)
10008     goto error_return;
10009 
10010   reloc_vector = bfd_malloc (reloc_size);
10011   if (reloc_vector == NULL && reloc_size != 0)
10012     goto error_return;
10013 
10014   /* read in the section */
10015   sz = input_section->rawsize ? input_section->rawsize : input_section->size;
10016   if (!bfd_get_section_contents (input_bfd, input_section, data, 0, sz))
10017     goto error_return;
10018 
10019   reloc_count = bfd_canonicalize_reloc (input_bfd,
10020 					input_section,
10021 					reloc_vector,
10022 					symbols);
10023   if (reloc_count < 0)
10024     goto error_return;
10025 
10026   if (reloc_count > 0)
10027     {
10028       arelent **parent;
10029       /* for mips */
10030       int gp_found;
10031       bfd_vma gp = 0x12345678;	/* initialize just to shut gcc up */
10032 
10033       {
10034 	struct bfd_hash_entry *h;
10035 	struct bfd_link_hash_entry *lh;
10036 	/* Skip all this stuff if we aren't mixing formats.  */
10037 	if (abfd && input_bfd
10038 	    && abfd->xvec == input_bfd->xvec)
10039 	  lh = 0;
10040 	else
10041 	  {
10042 	    h = bfd_hash_lookup (&link_info->hash->table, "_gp", FALSE, FALSE);
10043 	    lh = (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *) h;
10044 	  }
10045       lookup:
10046 	if (lh)
10047 	  {
10048 	    switch (lh->type)
10049 	      {
10050 	      case bfd_link_hash_undefined:
10051 	      case bfd_link_hash_undefweak:
10052 	      case bfd_link_hash_common:
10053 		gp_found = 0;
10054 		break;
10055 	      case bfd_link_hash_defined:
10056 	      case bfd_link_hash_defweak:
10057 		gp_found = 1;
10058 		gp = lh->u.def.value;
10059 		break;
10060 	      case bfd_link_hash_indirect:
10061 	      case bfd_link_hash_warning:
10062 		lh = lh->u.i.link;
10063 		/* @@FIXME  ignoring warning for now */
10064 		goto lookup;
10065 	      case bfd_link_hash_new:
10066 	      default:
10067 		abort ();
10068 	      }
10069 	  }
10070 	else
10071 	  gp_found = 0;
10072       }
10073       /* end mips */
10074       for (parent = reloc_vector; *parent != NULL; parent++)
10075 	{
10076 	  char *error_message = NULL;
10077 	  bfd_reloc_status_type r;
10078 
10079 	  /* Specific to MIPS: Deal with relocation types that require
10080 	     knowing the gp of the output bfd.  */
10081 	  asymbol *sym = *(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr;
10082 
10083 	  /* If we've managed to find the gp and have a special
10084 	     function for the relocation then go ahead, else default
10085 	     to the generic handling.  */
10086 	  if (gp_found
10087 	      && (*parent)->howto->special_function
10088 	      == _bfd_mips_elf32_gprel16_reloc)
10089 	    r = _bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp (input_bfd, sym, *parent,
10090 					       input_section, relocatable,
10091 					       data, gp);
10092 	  else
10093 	    r = bfd_perform_relocation (input_bfd, *parent, data,
10094 					input_section,
10095 					relocatable ? abfd : NULL,
10096 					&error_message);
10097 
10098 	  if (relocatable)
10099 	    {
10100 	      asection *os = input_section->output_section;
10101 
10102 	      /* A partial link, so keep the relocs */
10103 	      os->orelocation[os->reloc_count] = *parent;
10104 	      os->reloc_count++;
10105 	    }
10106 
10107 	  if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
10108 	    {
10109 	      switch (r)
10110 		{
10111 		case bfd_reloc_undefined:
10112 		  if (!((*link_info->callbacks->undefined_symbol)
10113 			(link_info, bfd_asymbol_name (*(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr),
10114 			 input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address, TRUE)))
10115 		    goto error_return;
10116 		  break;
10117 		case bfd_reloc_dangerous:
10118 		  BFD_ASSERT (error_message != NULL);
10119 		  if (!((*link_info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
10120 			(link_info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section,
10121 			 (*parent)->address)))
10122 		    goto error_return;
10123 		  break;
10124 		case bfd_reloc_overflow:
10125 		  if (!((*link_info->callbacks->reloc_overflow)
10126 			(link_info, NULL,
10127 			 bfd_asymbol_name (*(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr),
10128 			 (*parent)->howto->name, (*parent)->addend,
10129 			 input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address)))
10130 		    goto error_return;
10131 		  break;
10132 		case bfd_reloc_outofrange:
10133 		default:
10134 		  abort ();
10135 		  break;
10136 		}
10137 
10138 	    }
10139 	}
10140     }
10141   if (reloc_vector != NULL)
10142     free (reloc_vector);
10143   return data;
10144 
10145 error_return:
10146   if (reloc_vector != NULL)
10147     free (reloc_vector);
10148   return NULL;
10149 }
10150 
10151 /* Create a MIPS ELF linker hash table.  */
10152 
10153 struct bfd_link_hash_table *
_bfd_mips_elf_link_hash_table_create(bfd * abfd)10154 _bfd_mips_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
10155 {
10156   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
10157   bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_table);
10158 
10159   ret = bfd_malloc (amt);
10160   if (ret == NULL)
10161     return NULL;
10162 
10163   if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->root, abfd,
10164 				      mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
10165 				      sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry)))
10166     {
10167       free (ret);
10168       return NULL;
10169     }
10170 
10171 #if 0
10172   /* We no longer use this.  */
10173   for (i = 0; i < SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES; i++)
10174     ret->dynsym_sec_strindex[i] = (bfd_size_type) -1;
10175 #endif
10176   ret->procedure_count = 0;
10177   ret->compact_rel_size = 0;
10178   ret->use_rld_obj_head = FALSE;
10179   ret->rld_value = 0;
10180   ret->mips16_stubs_seen = FALSE;
10181   ret->is_vxworks = FALSE;
10182   ret->srelbss = NULL;
10183   ret->sdynbss = NULL;
10184   ret->srelplt = NULL;
10185   ret->srelplt2 = NULL;
10186   ret->sgotplt = NULL;
10187   ret->splt = NULL;
10188   ret->plt_header_size = 0;
10189   ret->plt_entry_size = 0;
10190   ret->function_stub_size = 0;
10191 
10192   return &ret->root.root;
10193 }
10194 
10195 /* Likewise, but indicate that the target is VxWorks.  */
10196 
10197 struct bfd_link_hash_table *
_bfd_mips_vxworks_link_hash_table_create(bfd * abfd)10198 _bfd_mips_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
10199 {
10200   struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
10201 
10202   ret = _bfd_mips_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
10203   if (ret)
10204     {
10205       struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
10206 
10207       htab = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *) ret;
10208       htab->is_vxworks = 1;
10209     }
10210   return ret;
10211 }
10212 
10213 /* We need to use a special link routine to handle the .reginfo and
10214    the .mdebug sections.  We need to merge all instances of these
10215    sections together, not write them all out sequentially.  */
10216 
10217 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_final_link(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)10218 _bfd_mips_elf_final_link (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
10219 {
10220   asection *o;
10221   struct bfd_link_order *p;
10222   asection *reginfo_sec, *mdebug_sec, *gptab_data_sec, *gptab_bss_sec;
10223   asection *rtproc_sec;
10224   Elf32_RegInfo reginfo;
10225   struct ecoff_debug_info debug;
10226   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10227   const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap = bed->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
10228   HDRR *symhdr = &debug.symbolic_header;
10229   void *mdebug_handle = NULL;
10230   asection *s;
10231   EXTR esym;
10232   unsigned int i;
10233   bfd_size_type amt;
10234   struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
10235 
10236   static const char * const secname[] =
10237   {
10238     ".text", ".init", ".fini", ".data",
10239     ".rodata", ".sdata", ".sbss", ".bss"
10240   };
10241   static const int sc[] =
10242   {
10243     scText, scInit, scFini, scData,
10244     scRData, scSData, scSBss, scBss
10245   };
10246 
10247   /* We'd carefully arranged the dynamic symbol indices, and then the
10248      generic size_dynamic_sections renumbered them out from under us.
10249      Rather than trying somehow to prevent the renumbering, just do
10250      the sort again.  */
10251   htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
10252   if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
10253     {
10254       bfd *dynobj;
10255       asection *got;
10256       struct mips_got_info *g;
10257       bfd_size_type dynsecsymcount;
10258 
10259       /* When we resort, we must tell mips_elf_sort_hash_table what
10260 	 the lowest index it may use is.  That's the number of section
10261 	 symbols we're going to add.  The generic ELF linker only
10262 	 adds these symbols when building a shared object.  Note that
10263 	 we count the sections after (possibly) removing the .options
10264 	 section above.  */
10265 
10266       dynsecsymcount = count_section_dynsyms (abfd, info);
10267       if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, dynsecsymcount + 1))
10268 	return FALSE;
10269 
10270       /* Make sure we didn't grow the global .got region.  */
10271       dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
10272       got = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
10273       g = mips_elf_section_data (got)->u.got_info;
10274 
10275       if (g->global_gotsym != NULL)
10276 	BFD_ASSERT ((elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount
10277 		     - g->global_gotsym->dynindx)
10278 		    <= g->global_gotno);
10279     }
10280 
10281   /* Get a value for the GP register.  */
10282   if (elf_gp (abfd) == 0)
10283     {
10284       struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h;
10285 
10286       h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash, "_gp", FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
10287       if (h != NULL && h->type == bfd_link_hash_defined)
10288 	elf_gp (abfd) = (h->u.def.value
10289 			 + h->u.def.section->output_section->vma
10290 			 + h->u.def.section->output_offset);
10291       else if (htab->is_vxworks
10292 	       && (h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash,
10293 					     "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_",
10294 					     FALSE, FALSE, TRUE))
10295 	       && h->type == bfd_link_hash_defined)
10296 	elf_gp (abfd) = (h->u.def.section->output_section->vma
10297 			 + h->u.def.section->output_offset
10298 			 + h->u.def.value);
10299       else if (info->relocatable)
10300 	{
10301 	  bfd_vma lo = MINUS_ONE;
10302 
10303 	  /* Find the GP-relative section with the lowest offset.  */
10304 	  for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
10305 	    if (o->vma < lo
10306 		&& (elf_section_data (o)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_MIPS_GPREL))
10307 	      lo = o->vma;
10308 
10309 	  /* And calculate GP relative to that.  */
10310 	  elf_gp (abfd) = lo + ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET (info);
10311 	}
10312       else
10313 	{
10314 	  /* If the relocate_section function needs to do a reloc
10315 	     involving the GP value, it should make a reloc_dangerous
10316 	     callback to warn that GP is not defined.  */
10317 	}
10318     }
10319 
10320   /* Go through the sections and collect the .reginfo and .mdebug
10321      information.  */
10322   reginfo_sec = NULL;
10323   mdebug_sec = NULL;
10324   gptab_data_sec = NULL;
10325   gptab_bss_sec = NULL;
10326   for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
10327     {
10328       if (strcmp (o->name, ".reginfo") == 0)
10329 	{
10330 	  memset (&reginfo, 0, sizeof reginfo);
10331 
10332 	  /* We have found the .reginfo section in the output file.
10333 	     Look through all the link_orders comprising it and merge
10334 	     the information together.  */
10335 	  for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
10336 	    {
10337 	      asection *input_section;
10338 	      bfd *input_bfd;
10339 	      Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
10340 	      Elf32_RegInfo sub;
10341 
10342 	      if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
10343 		{
10344 		  if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
10345 		    continue;
10346 		  abort ();
10347 		}
10348 
10349 	      input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
10350 	      input_bfd = input_section->owner;
10351 
10352 	      if (! bfd_get_section_contents (input_bfd, input_section,
10353 					      &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
10354 		return FALSE;
10355 
10356 	      bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (input_bfd, &ext, &sub);
10357 
10358 	      reginfo.ri_gprmask |= sub.ri_gprmask;
10359 	      reginfo.ri_cprmask[0] |= sub.ri_cprmask[0];
10360 	      reginfo.ri_cprmask[1] |= sub.ri_cprmask[1];
10361 	      reginfo.ri_cprmask[2] |= sub.ri_cprmask[2];
10362 	      reginfo.ri_cprmask[3] |= sub.ri_cprmask[3];
10363 
10364 	      /* ri_gp_value is set by the function
10365 		 mips_elf32_section_processing when the section is
10366 		 finally written out.  */
10367 
10368 	      /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
10369 		 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section.  */
10370 	      input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
10371 	    }
10372 
10373 	  /* Size has been set in _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections.  */
10374 	  BFD_ASSERT(o->size == sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
10375 
10376 	  /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
10377 	     matters, but someday it might).  */
10378 	  o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
10379 
10380 	  reginfo_sec = o;
10381 	}
10382 
10383       if (strcmp (o->name, ".mdebug") == 0)
10384 	{
10385 	  struct extsym_info einfo;
10386 	  bfd_vma last;
10387 
10388 	  /* We have found the .mdebug section in the output file.
10389 	     Look through all the link_orders comprising it and merge
10390 	     the information together.  */
10391 	  symhdr->magic = swap->sym_magic;
10392 	  /* FIXME: What should the version stamp be?  */
10393 	  symhdr->vstamp = 0;
10394 	  symhdr->ilineMax = 0;
10395 	  symhdr->cbLine = 0;
10396 	  symhdr->idnMax = 0;
10397 	  symhdr->ipdMax = 0;
10398 	  symhdr->isymMax = 0;
10399 	  symhdr->ioptMax = 0;
10400 	  symhdr->iauxMax = 0;
10401 	  symhdr->issMax = 0;
10402 	  symhdr->issExtMax = 0;
10403 	  symhdr->ifdMax = 0;
10404 	  symhdr->crfd = 0;
10405 	  symhdr->iextMax = 0;
10406 
10407 	  /* We accumulate the debugging information itself in the
10408 	     debug_info structure.  */
10409 	  debug.line = NULL;
10410 	  debug.external_dnr = NULL;
10411 	  debug.external_pdr = NULL;
10412 	  debug.external_sym = NULL;
10413 	  debug.external_opt = NULL;
10414 	  debug.external_aux = NULL;
10415 	  debug.ss = NULL;
10416 	  debug.ssext = debug.ssext_end = NULL;
10417 	  debug.external_fdr = NULL;
10418 	  debug.external_rfd = NULL;
10419 	  debug.external_ext = debug.external_ext_end = NULL;
10420 
10421 	  mdebug_handle = bfd_ecoff_debug_init (abfd, &debug, swap, info);
10422 	  if (mdebug_handle == NULL)
10423 	    return FALSE;
10424 
10425 	  esym.jmptbl = 0;
10426 	  esym.cobol_main = 0;
10427 	  esym.weakext = 0;
10428 	  esym.reserved = 0;
10429 	  esym.ifd = ifdNil;
10430 	  esym.asym.iss = issNil;
10431 	  esym.asym.st = stLocal;
10432 	  esym.asym.reserved = 0;
10433 	  esym.asym.index = indexNil;
10434 	  last = 0;
10435 	  for (i = 0; i < sizeof (secname) / sizeof (secname[0]); i++)
10436 	    {
10437 	      esym.asym.sc = sc[i];
10438 	      s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, secname[i]);
10439 	      if (s != NULL)
10440 		{
10441 		  esym.asym.value = s->vma;
10442 		  last = s->vma + s->size;
10443 		}
10444 	      else
10445 		esym.asym.value = last;
10446 	      if (!bfd_ecoff_debug_one_external (abfd, &debug, swap,
10447 						 secname[i], &esym))
10448 		return FALSE;
10449 	    }
10450 
10451 	  for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
10452 	    {
10453 	      asection *input_section;
10454 	      bfd *input_bfd;
10455 	      const struct ecoff_debug_swap *input_swap;
10456 	      struct ecoff_debug_info input_debug;
10457 	      char *eraw_src;
10458 	      char *eraw_end;
10459 
10460 	      if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
10461 		{
10462 		  if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
10463 		    continue;
10464 		  abort ();
10465 		}
10466 
10467 	      input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
10468 	      input_bfd = input_section->owner;
10469 
10470 	      if (bfd_get_flavour (input_bfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
10471 		  || (get_elf_backend_data (input_bfd)
10472 		      ->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap) == NULL)
10473 		{
10474 		  /* I don't know what a non MIPS ELF bfd would be
10475 		     doing with a .mdebug section, but I don't really
10476 		     want to deal with it.  */
10477 		  continue;
10478 		}
10479 
10480 	      input_swap = (get_elf_backend_data (input_bfd)
10481 			    ->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap);
10482 
10483 	      BFD_ASSERT (p->size == input_section->size);
10484 
10485 	      /* The ECOFF linking code expects that we have already
10486 		 read in the debugging information and set up an
10487 		 ecoff_debug_info structure, so we do that now.  */
10488 	      if (! _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (input_bfd, input_section,
10489 						   &input_debug))
10490 		return FALSE;
10491 
10492 	      if (! (bfd_ecoff_debug_accumulate
10493 		     (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, swap, input_bfd,
10494 		      &input_debug, input_swap, info)))
10495 		return FALSE;
10496 
10497 	      /* Loop through the external symbols.  For each one with
10498 		 interesting information, try to find the symbol in
10499 		 the linker global hash table and save the information
10500 		 for the output external symbols.  */
10501 	      eraw_src = input_debug.external_ext;
10502 	      eraw_end = (eraw_src
10503 			  + (input_debug.symbolic_header.iextMax
10504 			     * input_swap->external_ext_size));
10505 	      for (;
10506 		   eraw_src < eraw_end;
10507 		   eraw_src += input_swap->external_ext_size)
10508 		{
10509 		  EXTR ext;
10510 		  const char *name;
10511 		  struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
10512 
10513 		  (*input_swap->swap_ext_in) (input_bfd, eraw_src, &ext);
10514 		  if (ext.asym.sc == scNil
10515 		      || ext.asym.sc == scUndefined
10516 		      || ext.asym.sc == scSUndefined)
10517 		    continue;
10518 
10519 		  name = input_debug.ssext + ext.asym.iss;
10520 		  h = mips_elf_link_hash_lookup (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
10521 						 name, FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
10522 		  if (h == NULL || h->esym.ifd != -2)
10523 		    continue;
10524 
10525 		  if (ext.ifd != -1)
10526 		    {
10527 		      BFD_ASSERT (ext.ifd
10528 				  < input_debug.symbolic_header.ifdMax);
10529 		      ext.ifd = input_debug.ifdmap[ext.ifd];
10530 		    }
10531 
10532 		  h->esym = ext;
10533 		}
10534 
10535 	      /* Free up the information we just read.  */
10536 	      free (input_debug.line);
10537 	      free (input_debug.external_dnr);
10538 	      free (input_debug.external_pdr);
10539 	      free (input_debug.external_sym);
10540 	      free (input_debug.external_opt);
10541 	      free (input_debug.external_aux);
10542 	      free (input_debug.ss);
10543 	      free (input_debug.ssext);
10544 	      free (input_debug.external_fdr);
10545 	      free (input_debug.external_rfd);
10546 	      free (input_debug.external_ext);
10547 
10548 	      /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
10549 		 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section.  */
10550 	      input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
10551 	    }
10552 
10553 	  if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && info->shared)
10554 	    {
10555 	      /* Create .rtproc section.  */
10556 	      rtproc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
10557 	      if (rtproc_sec == NULL)
10558 		{
10559 		  flagword flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
10560 				    | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
10561 
10562 		  rtproc_sec = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd,
10563 							    ".rtproc",
10564 							    flags);
10565 		  if (rtproc_sec == NULL
10566 		      || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, rtproc_sec, 4))
10567 		    return FALSE;
10568 		}
10569 
10570 	      if (! mips_elf_create_procedure_table (mdebug_handle, abfd,
10571 						     info, rtproc_sec,
10572 						     &debug))
10573 		return FALSE;
10574 	    }
10575 
10576 	  /* Build the external symbol information.  */
10577 	  einfo.abfd = abfd;
10578 	  einfo.info = info;
10579 	  einfo.debug = &debug;
10580 	  einfo.swap = swap;
10581 	  einfo.failed = FALSE;
10582 	  mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
10583 				       mips_elf_output_extsym, &einfo);
10584 	  if (einfo.failed)
10585 	    return FALSE;
10586 
10587 	  /* Set the size of the .mdebug section.  */
10588 	  o->size = bfd_ecoff_debug_size (abfd, &debug, swap);
10589 
10590 	  /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
10591 	     matters, but someday it might).  */
10592 	  o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
10593 
10594 	  mdebug_sec = o;
10595 	}
10596 
10597       if (CONST_STRNEQ (o->name, ".gptab."))
10598 	{
10599 	  const char *subname;
10600 	  unsigned int c;
10601 	  Elf32_gptab *tab;
10602 	  Elf32_External_gptab *ext_tab;
10603 	  unsigned int j;
10604 
10605 	  /* The .gptab.sdata and .gptab.sbss sections hold
10606 	     information describing how the small data area would
10607 	     change depending upon the -G switch.  These sections
10608 	     not used in executables files.  */
10609 	  if (! info->relocatable)
10610 	    {
10611 	      for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
10612 		{
10613 		  asection *input_section;
10614 
10615 		  if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
10616 		    {
10617 		      if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
10618 			continue;
10619 		      abort ();
10620 		    }
10621 
10622 		  input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
10623 
10624 		  /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
10625 		     elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section.  */
10626 		  input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
10627 		}
10628 
10629 	      /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this
10630 		 currently matters, but someday it might).  */
10631 	      o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
10632 
10633 	      /* Really remove the section.  */
10634 	      bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, o);
10635 	      --abfd->section_count;
10636 
10637 	      continue;
10638 	    }
10639 
10640 	  /* There is one gptab for initialized data, and one for
10641 	     uninitialized data.  */
10642 	  if (strcmp (o->name, ".gptab.sdata") == 0)
10643 	    gptab_data_sec = o;
10644 	  else if (strcmp (o->name, ".gptab.sbss") == 0)
10645 	    gptab_bss_sec = o;
10646 	  else
10647 	    {
10648 	      (*_bfd_error_handler)
10649 		(_("%s: illegal section name `%s'"),
10650 		 bfd_get_filename (abfd), o->name);
10651 	      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
10652 	      return FALSE;
10653 	    }
10654 
10655 	  /* The linker script always combines .gptab.data and
10656 	     .gptab.sdata into .gptab.sdata, and likewise for
10657 	     .gptab.bss and .gptab.sbss.  It is possible that there is
10658 	     no .sdata or .sbss section in the output file, in which
10659 	     case we must change the name of the output section.  */
10660 	  subname = o->name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1;
10661 	  if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, subname) == NULL)
10662 	    {
10663 	      if (o == gptab_data_sec)
10664 		o->name = ".gptab.data";
10665 	      else
10666 		o->name = ".gptab.bss";
10667 	      subname = o->name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1;
10668 	      BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, subname) != NULL);
10669 	    }
10670 
10671 	  /* Set up the first entry.  */
10672 	  c = 1;
10673 	  amt = c * sizeof (Elf32_gptab);
10674 	  tab = bfd_malloc (amt);
10675 	  if (tab == NULL)
10676 	    return FALSE;
10677 	  tab[0].gt_header.gt_current_g_value = elf_gp_size (abfd);
10678 	  tab[0].gt_header.gt_unused = 0;
10679 
10680 	  /* Combine the input sections.  */
10681 	  for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
10682 	    {
10683 	      asection *input_section;
10684 	      bfd *input_bfd;
10685 	      bfd_size_type size;
10686 	      unsigned long last;
10687 	      bfd_size_type gpentry;
10688 
10689 	      if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
10690 		{
10691 		  if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
10692 		    continue;
10693 		  abort ();
10694 		}
10695 
10696 	      input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
10697 	      input_bfd = input_section->owner;
10698 
10699 	      /* Combine the gptab entries for this input section one
10700 		 by one.  We know that the input gptab entries are
10701 		 sorted by ascending -G value.  */
10702 	      size = input_section->size;
10703 	      last = 0;
10704 	      for (gpentry = sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
10705 		   gpentry < size;
10706 		   gpentry += sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab))
10707 		{
10708 		  Elf32_External_gptab ext_gptab;
10709 		  Elf32_gptab int_gptab;
10710 		  unsigned long val;
10711 		  unsigned long add;
10712 		  bfd_boolean exact;
10713 		  unsigned int look;
10714 
10715 		  if (! (bfd_get_section_contents
10716 			 (input_bfd, input_section, &ext_gptab, gpentry,
10717 			  sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab))))
10718 		    {
10719 		      free (tab);
10720 		      return FALSE;
10721 		    }
10722 
10723 		  bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in (input_bfd, &ext_gptab,
10724 						&int_gptab);
10725 		  val = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_g_value;
10726 		  add = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_bytes - last;
10727 
10728 		  exact = FALSE;
10729 		  for (look = 1; look < c; look++)
10730 		    {
10731 		      if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value >= val)
10732 			tab[look].gt_entry.gt_bytes += add;
10733 
10734 		      if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value == val)
10735 			exact = TRUE;
10736 		    }
10737 
10738 		  if (! exact)
10739 		    {
10740 		      Elf32_gptab *new_tab;
10741 		      unsigned int max;
10742 
10743 		      /* We need a new table entry.  */
10744 		      amt = (bfd_size_type) (c + 1) * sizeof (Elf32_gptab);
10745 		      new_tab = bfd_realloc (tab, amt);
10746 		      if (new_tab == NULL)
10747 			{
10748 			  free (tab);
10749 			  return FALSE;
10750 			}
10751 		      tab = new_tab;
10752 		      tab[c].gt_entry.gt_g_value = val;
10753 		      tab[c].gt_entry.gt_bytes = add;
10754 
10755 		      /* Merge in the size for the next smallest -G
10756 			 value, since that will be implied by this new
10757 			 value.  */
10758 		      max = 0;
10759 		      for (look = 1; look < c; look++)
10760 			{
10761 			  if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value < val
10762 			      && (max == 0
10763 				  || (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value
10764 				      > tab[max].gt_entry.gt_g_value)))
10765 			    max = look;
10766 			}
10767 		      if (max != 0)
10768 			tab[c].gt_entry.gt_bytes +=
10769 			  tab[max].gt_entry.gt_bytes;
10770 
10771 		      ++c;
10772 		    }
10773 
10774 		  last = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_bytes;
10775 		}
10776 
10777 	      /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
10778 		 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section.  */
10779 	      input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
10780 	    }
10781 
10782 	  /* The table must be sorted by -G value.  */
10783 	  if (c > 2)
10784 	    qsort (tab + 1, c - 1, sizeof (tab[0]), gptab_compare);
10785 
10786 	  /* Swap out the table.  */
10787 	  amt = (bfd_size_type) c * sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
10788 	  ext_tab = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
10789 	  if (ext_tab == NULL)
10790 	    {
10791 	      free (tab);
10792 	      return FALSE;
10793 	    }
10794 
10795 	  for (j = 0; j < c; j++)
10796 	    bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out (abfd, tab + j, ext_tab + j);
10797 	  free (tab);
10798 
10799 	  o->size = c * sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
10800 	  o->contents = (bfd_byte *) ext_tab;
10801 
10802 	  /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
10803 	     matters, but someday it might).  */
10804 	  o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
10805 	}
10806     }
10807 
10808   /* Invoke the regular ELF backend linker to do all the work.  */
10809   if (!bfd_elf_final_link (abfd, info))
10810     return FALSE;
10811 
10812   /* Now write out the computed sections.  */
10813 
10814   if (reginfo_sec != NULL)
10815     {
10816       Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
10817 
10818       bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out (abfd, &reginfo, &ext);
10819       if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, reginfo_sec, &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
10820 	return FALSE;
10821     }
10822 
10823   if (mdebug_sec != NULL)
10824     {
10825       BFD_ASSERT (abfd->output_has_begun);
10826       if (! bfd_ecoff_write_accumulated_debug (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug,
10827 					       swap, info,
10828 					       mdebug_sec->filepos))
10829 	return FALSE;
10830 
10831       bfd_ecoff_debug_free (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, swap, info);
10832     }
10833 
10834   if (gptab_data_sec != NULL)
10835     {
10836       if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, gptab_data_sec,
10837 				      gptab_data_sec->contents,
10838 				      0, gptab_data_sec->size))
10839 	return FALSE;
10840     }
10841 
10842   if (gptab_bss_sec != NULL)
10843     {
10844       if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, gptab_bss_sec,
10845 				      gptab_bss_sec->contents,
10846 				      0, gptab_bss_sec->size))
10847 	return FALSE;
10848     }
10849 
10850   if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
10851     {
10852       rtproc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
10853       if (rtproc_sec != NULL)
10854 	{
10855 	  if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, rtproc_sec,
10856 					  rtproc_sec->contents,
10857 					  0, rtproc_sec->size))
10858 	    return FALSE;
10859 	}
10860     }
10861 
10862   return TRUE;
10863 }
10864 
10865 /* Structure for saying that BFD machine EXTENSION extends BASE.  */
10866 
10867 struct mips_mach_extension {
10868   unsigned long extension, base;
10869 };
10870 
10871 
10872 /* An array describing how BFD machines relate to one another.  The entries
10873    are ordered topologically with MIPS I extensions listed last.  */
10874 
10875 static const struct mips_mach_extension mips_mach_extensions[] = {
10876   /* MIPS64r2 extensions.  */
10877   { bfd_mach_mips_octeon, bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2 },
10878 
10879   /* MIPS64 extensions.  */
10880   { bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
10881   { bfd_mach_mips_sb1, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
10882 
10883   /* MIPS V extensions.  */
10884   { bfd_mach_mipsisa64, bfd_mach_mips5 },
10885 
10886   /* R10000 extensions.  */
10887   { bfd_mach_mips12000, bfd_mach_mips10000 },
10888 
10889   /* R5000 extensions.  Note: the vr5500 ISA is an extension of the core
10890      vr5400 ISA, but doesn't include the multimedia stuff.  It seems
10891      better to allow vr5400 and vr5500 code to be merged anyway, since
10892      many libraries will just use the core ISA.  Perhaps we could add
10893      some sort of ASE flag if this ever proves a problem.  */
10894   { bfd_mach_mips5500, bfd_mach_mips5400 },
10895   { bfd_mach_mips5400, bfd_mach_mips5000 },
10896 
10897   /* MIPS IV extensions.  */
10898   { bfd_mach_mips5, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
10899   { bfd_mach_mips10000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
10900   { bfd_mach_mips5000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
10901   { bfd_mach_mips7000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
10902   { bfd_mach_mips9000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
10903 
10904   /* VR4100 extensions.  */
10905   { bfd_mach_mips4120, bfd_mach_mips4100 },
10906   { bfd_mach_mips4111, bfd_mach_mips4100 },
10907 
10908   /* MIPS III extensions.  */
10909   { bfd_mach_mips8000, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
10910   { bfd_mach_mips4650, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
10911   { bfd_mach_mips4600, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
10912   { bfd_mach_mips4400, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
10913   { bfd_mach_mips4300, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
10914   { bfd_mach_mips4100, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
10915   { bfd_mach_mips4010, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
10916 
10917   /* MIPS32 extensions.  */
10918   { bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2, bfd_mach_mipsisa32 },
10919 
10920   /* MIPS II extensions.  */
10921   { bfd_mach_mips4000, bfd_mach_mips6000 },
10922   { bfd_mach_mipsisa32, bfd_mach_mips6000 },
10923 
10924   /* MIPS I extensions.  */
10925   { bfd_mach_mips6000, bfd_mach_mips3000 },
10926   { bfd_mach_mips3900, bfd_mach_mips3000 }
10927 };
10928 
10929 
10930 /* Return true if bfd machine EXTENSION is an extension of machine BASE.  */
10931 
10932 static bfd_boolean
mips_mach_extends_p(unsigned long base,unsigned long extension)10933 mips_mach_extends_p (unsigned long base, unsigned long extension)
10934 {
10935   size_t i;
10936 
10937   if (extension == base)
10938     return TRUE;
10939 
10940   if (base == bfd_mach_mipsisa32
10941       && mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_mach_mipsisa64, extension))
10942     return TRUE;
10943 
10944   if (base == bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2
10945       && mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2, extension))
10946     return TRUE;
10947 
10948   for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (mips_mach_extensions); i++)
10949     if (extension == mips_mach_extensions[i].extension)
10950       {
10951 	extension = mips_mach_extensions[i].base;
10952 	if (extension == base)
10953 	  return TRUE;
10954       }
10955 
10956   return FALSE;
10957 }
10958 
10959 
10960 /* Return true if the given ELF header flags describe a 32-bit binary.  */
10961 
10962 static bfd_boolean
mips_32bit_flags_p(flagword flags)10963 mips_32bit_flags_p (flagword flags)
10964 {
10965   return ((flags & EF_MIPS_32BITMODE) != 0
10966 	  || (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32
10967 	  || (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32
10968 	  || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_1
10969 	  || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_2
10970 	  || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32
10971 	  || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2);
10972 }
10973 
10974 
10975 /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD.  Raise an error if
10976    there are conflicting attributes.  */
10977 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_merge_obj_attributes(bfd * ibfd,bfd * obfd)10978 mips_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
10979 {
10980   obj_attribute *in_attr;
10981   obj_attribute *out_attr;
10982 
10983   if (!elf_known_obj_attributes_proc (obfd)[0].i)
10984     {
10985       /* This is the first object.  Copy the attributes.  */
10986       _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
10987 
10988       /* Use the Tag_null value to indicate the attributes have been
10989 	 initialized.  */
10990       elf_known_obj_attributes_proc (obfd)[0].i = 1;
10991 
10992       return TRUE;
10993     }
10994 
10995   /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP attributes and merge
10996      non-conflicting ones.  */
10997   in_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
10998   out_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
10999   if (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i != out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
11000     {
11001       out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].type = 1;
11002       if (out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i == 0)
11003 	out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i = in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i;
11004       else if (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i == 0)
11005 	;
11006       else if (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i > 3)
11007 	_bfd_error_handler
11008 	  (_("Warning: %B uses unknown floating point ABI %d"), ibfd,
11009 	   in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i);
11010       else if (out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i > 3)
11011 	_bfd_error_handler
11012 	  (_("Warning: %B uses unknown floating point ABI %d"), obfd,
11013 	   out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i);
11014       else
11015 	switch (out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
11016 	  {
11017 	  case 1:
11018 	    switch (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
11019 	      {
11020 	      case 2:
11021 		_bfd_error_handler
11022 		  (_("Warning: %B uses -msingle-float, %B uses -mdouble-float"),
11023 		   obfd, ibfd);
11024 
11025 	      case 3:
11026 		_bfd_error_handler
11027 		  (_("Warning: %B uses hard float, %B uses soft float"),
11028 		   obfd, ibfd);
11029 		break;
11030 
11031 	      default:
11032 		abort ();
11033 	      }
11034 	    break;
11035 
11036 	  case 2:
11037 	    switch (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
11038 	      {
11039 	      case 1:
11040 		_bfd_error_handler
11041 		  (_("Warning: %B uses -msingle-float, %B uses -mdouble-float"),
11042 		   ibfd, obfd);
11043 
11044 	      case 3:
11045 		_bfd_error_handler
11046 		  (_("Warning: %B uses hard float, %B uses soft float"),
11047 		   obfd, ibfd);
11048 		break;
11049 
11050 	      default:
11051 		abort ();
11052 	      }
11053 	    break;
11054 
11055 	  case 3:
11056 	    switch (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
11057 	      {
11058 	      case 1:
11059 	      case 2:
11060 		_bfd_error_handler
11061 		  (_("Warning: %B uses hard float, %B uses soft float"),
11062 		   ibfd, obfd);
11063 		break;
11064 
11065 	      default:
11066 		abort ();
11067 	      }
11068 	    break;
11069 
11070 	  default:
11071 	    abort ();
11072 	  }
11073     }
11074 
11075   /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones.  */
11076   _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
11077 
11078   return TRUE;
11079 }
11080 
11081 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
11082    object file when linking.  */
11083 
11084 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_merge_private_bfd_data(bfd * ibfd,bfd * obfd)11085 _bfd_mips_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
11086 {
11087   flagword old_flags;
11088   flagword new_flags;
11089   bfd_boolean ok;
11090   bfd_boolean null_input_bfd = TRUE;
11091   asection *sec;
11092 
11093   /* Check if we have the same endianess */
11094   if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, obfd))
11095     {
11096       (*_bfd_error_handler)
11097 	(_("%B: endianness incompatible with that of the selected emulation"),
11098 	 ibfd);
11099       return FALSE;
11100     }
11101 
11102   if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
11103       || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
11104     return TRUE;
11105 
11106   if (strcmp (bfd_get_target (ibfd), bfd_get_target (obfd)) != 0)
11107     {
11108       (*_bfd_error_handler)
11109 	(_("%B: ABI is incompatible with that of the selected emulation"),
11110 	 ibfd);
11111       return FALSE;
11112     }
11113 
11114   if (!mips_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd))
11115     return FALSE;
11116 
11117   new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
11118   elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
11119   old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
11120 
11121   if (! elf_flags_init (obfd))
11122     {
11123       elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
11124       elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
11125       elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
11126 	= elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS];
11127 
11128       if (bfd_get_arch (obfd) == bfd_get_arch (ibfd)
11129 	  && (bfd_get_arch_info (obfd)->the_default
11130 	      || mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (obfd),
11131 				      bfd_get_mach (ibfd))))
11132 	{
11133 	  if (! bfd_set_arch_mach (obfd, bfd_get_arch (ibfd),
11134 				   bfd_get_mach (ibfd)))
11135 	    return FALSE;
11136 	}
11137 
11138       return TRUE;
11139     }
11140 
11141   /* Check flag compatibility.  */
11142 
11143   new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
11144   old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
11145 
11146   /* Some IRIX 6 BSD-compatibility objects have this bit set.  It
11147      doesn't seem to matter.  */
11148   new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_XGOT;
11149   old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_XGOT;
11150 
11151   /* MIPSpro generates ucode info in n64 objects.  Again, we should
11152      just be able to ignore this.  */
11153   new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_UCODE;
11154   old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_UCODE;
11155 
11156   /* Don't care about the PIC flags from dynamic objects; they are
11157      PIC by design.  */
11158   if ((new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0
11159       && (ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
11160     new_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
11161 
11162   if (new_flags == old_flags)
11163     return TRUE;
11164 
11165   /* Check to see if the input BFD actually contains any sections.
11166      If not, its flags may not have been initialised either, but it cannot
11167      actually cause any incompatibility.  */
11168   for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
11169     {
11170       /* Ignore synthetic sections and empty .text, .data and .bss sections
11171 	  which are automatically generated by gas.  */
11172       if (strcmp (sec->name, ".reginfo")
11173 	  && strcmp (sec->name, ".mdebug")
11174 	  && (sec->size != 0
11175 	      || (strcmp (sec->name, ".text")
11176 		  && strcmp (sec->name, ".data")
11177 		  && strcmp (sec->name, ".bss"))))
11178 	{
11179 	  null_input_bfd = FALSE;
11180 	  break;
11181 	}
11182     }
11183   if (null_input_bfd)
11184     return TRUE;
11185 
11186   ok = TRUE;
11187 
11188   if (((new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0)
11189       != ((old_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0))
11190     {
11191       (*_bfd_error_handler)
11192 	(_("%B: warning: linking PIC files with non-PIC files"),
11193 	 ibfd);
11194       ok = TRUE;
11195     }
11196 
11197   if (new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC))
11198     elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_MIPS_CPIC;
11199   if (! (new_flags & EF_MIPS_PIC))
11200     elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_PIC;
11201 
11202   new_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
11203   old_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
11204 
11205   /* Compare the ISAs.  */
11206   if (mips_32bit_flags_p (old_flags) != mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags))
11207     {
11208       (*_bfd_error_handler)
11209 	(_("%B: linking 32-bit code with 64-bit code"),
11210 	 ibfd);
11211       ok = FALSE;
11212     }
11213   else if (!mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (ibfd), bfd_get_mach (obfd)))
11214     {
11215       /* OBFD's ISA isn't the same as, or an extension of, IBFD's.  */
11216       if (mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (obfd), bfd_get_mach (ibfd)))
11217 	{
11218 	  /* Copy the architecture info from IBFD to OBFD.  Also copy
11219 	     the 32-bit flag (if set) so that we continue to recognise
11220 	     OBFD as a 32-bit binary.  */
11221 	  bfd_set_arch_info (obfd, bfd_get_arch_info (ibfd));
11222 	  elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH);
11223 	  elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags
11224 	    |= new_flags & (EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
11225 
11226 	  /* Copy across the ABI flags if OBFD doesn't use them
11227 	     and if that was what caused us to treat IBFD as 32-bit.  */
11228 	  if ((old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == 0
11229 	      && mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags)
11230 	      && !mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags & ~EF_MIPS_ABI))
11231 	    elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI;
11232 	}
11233       else
11234 	{
11235 	  /* The ISAs aren't compatible.  */
11236 	  (*_bfd_error_handler)
11237 	    (_("%B: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
11238 	     ibfd,
11239 	     bfd_printable_name (ibfd),
11240 	     bfd_printable_name (obfd));
11241 	  ok = FALSE;
11242 	}
11243     }
11244 
11245   new_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
11246   old_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
11247 
11248   /* Compare ABIs.  The 64-bit ABI does not use EF_MIPS_ABI.  But, it
11249      does set EI_CLASS differently from any 32-bit ABI.  */
11250   if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI)
11251       || (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
11252 	  != elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]))
11253     {
11254       /* Only error if both are set (to different values).  */
11255       if (((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) && (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI))
11256 	  || (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
11257 	      != elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]))
11258 	{
11259 	  (*_bfd_error_handler)
11260 	    (_("%B: ABI mismatch: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
11261 	     ibfd,
11262 	     elf_mips_abi_name (ibfd),
11263 	     elf_mips_abi_name (obfd));
11264 	  ok = FALSE;
11265 	}
11266       new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_ABI;
11267       old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_ABI;
11268     }
11269 
11270   /* For now, allow arbitrary mixing of ASEs (retain the union).  */
11271   if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE))
11272     {
11273       elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
11274 
11275       new_flags &= ~ EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
11276       old_flags &= ~ EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
11277     }
11278 
11279   /* Warn about any other mismatches */
11280   if (new_flags != old_flags)
11281     {
11282       (*_bfd_error_handler)
11283 	(_("%B: uses different e_flags (0x%lx) fields than previous modules (0x%lx)"),
11284 	 ibfd, (unsigned long) new_flags,
11285 	 (unsigned long) old_flags);
11286       ok = FALSE;
11287     }
11288 
11289   if (! ok)
11290     {
11291       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
11292       return FALSE;
11293     }
11294 
11295   return TRUE;
11296 }
11297 
11298 /* Function to keep MIPS specific file flags like as EF_MIPS_PIC.  */
11299 
11300 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_set_private_flags(bfd * abfd,flagword flags)11301 _bfd_mips_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
11302 {
11303   BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
11304 	      || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
11305 
11306   elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
11307   elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
11308   return TRUE;
11309 }
11310 
11311 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_print_private_bfd_data(bfd * abfd,void * ptr)11312 _bfd_mips_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *ptr)
11313 {
11314   FILE *file = ptr;
11315 
11316   BFD_ASSERT (abfd != NULL && ptr != NULL);
11317 
11318   /* Print normal ELF private data.  */
11319   _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (abfd, ptr);
11320 
11321   /* xgettext:c-format */
11322   fprintf (file, _("private flags = %lx:"), elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags);
11323 
11324   if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32)
11325     fprintf (file, _(" [abi=O32]"));
11326   else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O64)
11327     fprintf (file, _(" [abi=O64]"));
11328   else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32)
11329     fprintf (file, _(" [abi=EABI32]"));
11330   else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64)
11331     fprintf (file, _(" [abi=EABI64]"));
11332   else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI))
11333     fprintf (file, _(" [abi unknown]"));
11334   else if (ABI_N32_P (abfd))
11335     fprintf (file, _(" [abi=N32]"));
11336   else if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
11337     fprintf (file, _(" [abi=64]"));
11338   else
11339     fprintf (file, _(" [no abi set]"));
11340 
11341   if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_1)
11342     fprintf (file, " [mips1]");
11343   else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_2)
11344     fprintf (file, " [mips2]");
11345   else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_3)
11346     fprintf (file, " [mips3]");
11347   else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_4)
11348     fprintf (file, " [mips4]");
11349   else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_5)
11350     fprintf (file, " [mips5]");
11351   else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32)
11352     fprintf (file, " [mips32]");
11353   else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64)
11354     fprintf (file, " [mips64]");
11355   else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2)
11356     fprintf (file, " [mips32r2]");
11357   else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2)
11358     fprintf (file, " [mips64r2]");
11359   else
11360     fprintf (file, _(" [unknown ISA]"));
11361 
11362   if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MDMX)
11363     fprintf (file, " [mdmx]");
11364 
11365   if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_M16)
11366     fprintf (file, " [mips16]");
11367 
11368   if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_32BITMODE)
11369     fprintf (file, " [32bitmode]");
11370   else
11371     fprintf (file, _(" [not 32bitmode]"));
11372 
11373   if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_NOREORDER)
11374     fprintf (file, " [noreorder]");
11375 
11376   if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_PIC)
11377     fprintf (file, " [PIC]");
11378 
11379   if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_CPIC)
11380     fprintf (file, " [CPIC]");
11381 
11382   if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_XGOT)
11383     fprintf (file, " [XGOT]");
11384 
11385   if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_UCODE)
11386     fprintf (file, " [UCODE]");
11387 
11388   fputc ('\n', file);
11389 
11390   return TRUE;
11391 }
11392 
11393 const struct bfd_elf_special_section _bfd_mips_elf_special_sections[] =
11394 {
11395   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".lit4"),   0, SHT_PROGBITS,   SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
11396   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".lit8"),   0, SHT_PROGBITS,   SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
11397   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".mdebug"), 0, SHT_MIPS_DEBUG, 0 },
11398   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"),  -2, SHT_NOBITS,     SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
11399   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS,   SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
11400   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".ucode"),  0, SHT_MIPS_UCODE, 0 },
11401   { NULL,                     0,  0, 0,              0 }
11402 };
11403 
11404 /* Merge non visibility st_other attributes.  Ensure that the
11405    STO_OPTIONAL flag is copied into h->other, even if this is not a
11406    definiton of the symbol.  */
11407 void
_bfd_mips_elf_merge_symbol_attribute(struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,const Elf_Internal_Sym * isym,bfd_boolean definition,bfd_boolean dynamic ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)11408 _bfd_mips_elf_merge_symbol_attribute (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
11409 				      const Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
11410 				      bfd_boolean definition,
11411 				      bfd_boolean dynamic ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11412 {
11413   if ((isym->st_other & ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1)) != 0)
11414     {
11415       unsigned char other;
11416 
11417       other = (definition ? isym->st_other : h->other);
11418       other &= ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1);
11419       h->other = other | ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other);
11420     }
11421 
11422   if (!definition
11423       && ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (isym->st_other))
11424     h->other |= STO_OPTIONAL;
11425 }
11426 
11427 /* Decide whether an undefined symbol is special and can be ignored.
11428    This is the case for OPTIONAL symbols on IRIX.  */
11429 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_ignore_undef_symbol(struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)11430 _bfd_mips_elf_ignore_undef_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
11431 {
11432   return ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (h->other) ? TRUE : FALSE;
11433 }
11434 
11435 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_common_definition(Elf_Internal_Sym * sym)11436 _bfd_mips_elf_common_definition (Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
11437 {
11438   return (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
11439 	  || sym->st_shndx == SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON
11440 	  || sym->st_shndx == SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON);
11441 }
11442